Aprilia - RST Mille Futura - English

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 346

RST mille

INTRODUCTION

INTRODUCTION 0
GENERAL INFORMATION 1
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND
ADJUSTMENTS 2
ENGINE 3
FUEL SYSTEM 4
COOLING SYSTEM 5
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 6
CHASSIS 7
REPAIR INFORMATION 8
INDEX
i

Release 00/2001 - 11 0 - 1 - 00
INTRODUCTION RST mille

INTRODUCTION

CONTENTS
0.1 RELEASE 00/2001-11 UPDATE ....... 0-3-00

0
0.1.1 MANUAL UPDATES.............................. 0-3-00
0.1.2 LIST OF MANUAL PAGES AND UPDATE
NUMBERS ............................................. 0-3-00
0.2 REFERENCE GUIDE ........................ 0-6-00

1
0.3 FOREWORD ..................................... 0-7-00
0.4 REFERENCE MANUALS .................. 0-7-00
0.4.1 ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS ........ 0-7-00
0.4.2 PARTS CATALOGUES ......................... 0-7-00

2
0.4.3 SPECIAL TOOLS CATALOGUES ........ 0-7-00
0.4.4 OWNER'S MANUALS ........................... 0-7-00
0.5 SAFETY INFORMATION .................. 0-8-00
0.5.1 GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION ...................................... 0-8-00
3 0.5.2 BEFORE DISASSEMBLING ANY
COMPONENTS...................................... 0-8-00
0.5.3 DISASSEMBLING THE COMPONENTS .. 0-8-
00

4
0.5.4 REASSEMBLING THE COMPONENTS 0-8-00
0.6 SAFETY INFORMATION .................. 0-9-00
0.6.1 CONVENTIONS USED IN THE MANUAL 0-9-00
0.7 ABBREVIATIONS/SYMBOLS/

5 CONVENTIONS.............................. 0-10-00

0 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
INTRODUCTION

0.1 RELEASE 00/2001-11 UPDATE page# Release page# Release


Issue date of original release (Release 00) and
2-5 -00 ........................ 00 2-49 -00 ...................... 00
subsequent releases:
2-6 -00 ........................ 00 2-50 -00 ...................... 00
Original release (Release 00)..................November 2001
2-7 -00 ........................ 00 2-51 -00 ...................... 00
0.1.1 MANUAL UPDATES
2-8 -00 ........................ 00 2-52 -00 ...................... 00
Always keep manual updated to the latest release you
have received. 2-9 -00 ........................ 00 2-53 -00 ...................... 00
2-10 -00 ...................... 00 2-54 -00 ...................... 00
Add the latest release pages to the manual and 2-11 -00 ...................... 00 2-55 -00 ...................... 00
destroy all superseded pages (even if they belong
to the release before last). 2-12 -00 ...................... 00 2-56 -00 ...................... 00
2-13 -00 ...................... 00 2-57 -00 ...................... 00
CAUTION
Failure to keep the manual up-to-date or to 2-14 -00 ...................... 00 2-58 -00 ...................... 00
eliminate superseded pages will make the manual 2-15 -00 ...................... 00 2-59 -00 ...................... 00
more difficult to consult and creates a risk of
improper servicing. 2-16 -00 ...................... 00 2-60 -00 ...................... 00
2-17 -00 ...................... 00 2-61 -00 ...................... 00
This manual is made up of 10 sections for a total of 376
pages (listed below). 2-18 -00 ...................... 00 2-62 -00 ...................... 00
NOTE Please see 0.2 (REFERENCE GUIDE) for 2-19 -00 ...................... 00 2-63 -00 ...................... 00
details of standard page nomenclature and page num-
bering. 2-20 -00 ...................... 00 2-64 -00 ...................... 00
2-21 -00 ...................... 00 2-65 -00 ...................... 00
0.1.2 LIST OF MANUAL PAGES AND UPDATE
NUMBERS 2-22 -00 ...................... 00 2-66 -00 ...................... 00
2-23 -00 ...................... 00 2-67 -00 ...................... 00
2-24 -00 ...................... 00 2-68 -00 ...................... 00

page# Release page# Release 2-25 -00 ...................... 00 3-1 -00 ........................ 00

0-1 -00 ........................ 00 1-8 -00 .........................00 2-26 -00 ...................... 00 3-2 -00 ........................ 00

0-2 -00 ........................ 00 1-9 -00 .........................00 2-27 -00 ...................... 00 3-3 -00 ........................ 00

0-3 -00 ........................ 00 1-10 -00 .......................00 2-28 -00 ...................... 00 3-4 -00 ........................ 00

0-4 -00 ........................ 00 1-11 -00 .......................00 2-29 -00 ...................... 00 3-5 -00 ........................ 00

0-5 -00 ........................ 00 1-12 -00 .......................00 2-30 -00 ...................... 00 3-6 -00 ........................ 00

0-6 -00 ........................ 00 1-13 -00 .......................00 2-31 -00 ...................... 00 3-7 -00 ........................ 00

0-7 -00 ........................ 00 1-14 -00 .......................00 2-32 -00 ...................... 00 3-8 -00 ........................ 00

0-8 -00 ........................ 00 1-15 -00 .......................00 2-33 -00 ...................... 00 3-9 -00 ........................ 00

0-9 -00 ........................ 00 1-16 -00 .......................00 2-34 -00 ...................... 00 3-10 -00 ...................... 00

0-10 -00 ...................... 00 1-17 -00 .......................00 2-38 -00 ...................... 00 3-11 -00 ...................... 00

0-11 -00 ...................... 00 1-18 -00 .......................00 2-39 -00 ...................... 00 3-12 -00 ...................... 00

0-12 -00 ...................... 00 1-19 -00 .......................00 2-40 -00 ...................... 00 3-13 -00 ...................... 00

1-1 -00 ........................ 00 1-20 -00 .......................00 2-41 -00 ...................... 00 3-14 -00 ...................... 00

1-2 -00 ........................ 00 1-21 -00 .......................00 2-42 -00 ...................... 00 3-15 -00 ...................... 00

1-3 -00 ........................ 00 1-22 -00 .......................00 2-43 -00 ...................... 00 3-16 -00 ...................... 00

1-4 -00 ........................ 00 2-1 -00 .........................00 2-44 -00 ...................... 00 3-17 -00 ...................... 00

1-5 -00 ........................ 00 2-2 -00 .........................00 2-46 -00 ...................... 00 3-18 -00 ...................... 00

1-6 -00 ........................ 00 2-3 -00 .........................00 2-47 -00 ...................... 00 4-1 -00 ........................ 00

1-7 -00 ........................ 00 2-4 -00 .........................00 2-48 -00 ...................... 00 4-2 -00 ........................ 00

CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 0 - 3 - 00
INTRODUCTION RST mille

CONTINUED ➤

page# Release page# Release page# Release page# Release


4-3 -00 ........................ 00 6-11 -00 ...................... 00 6-52 -00 ...................... 00 7-40 -00 ...................... 00
4-4 -00 ........................ 00 6-12 -00 ...................... 00 7-1 -00 ........................ 00 7-41 -00 ...................... 00
4-5 -00 ........................ 00 6-13 -00 ...................... 00 7-2 -00 ........................ 00 7-42 -00 ...................... 00
4-6 -00 ........................ 00 6-14 -00 ...................... 00 7-3 -00 ........................ 00 7-43 -00 ...................... 00
4-7 -00 ........................ 00 6-15 -00 ...................... 00 7-4 -00 ........................ 00 7-44 -00 ...................... 00
4-8 -00 ........................ 00 6-16 -00 ...................... 00 7-5 -00 ........................ 00 7-45 -00 ...................... 00
4-9 -00 ........................ 00 6-17 -00 ...................... 00 7-6 -00 ........................ 00 7-46 -00 ...................... 00
4-10 -00 ...................... 00 6-18 -00 ...................... 00 7-7 -00 ........................ 00 7-47 -00 ...................... 00
4-11 -00 ...................... 00 6-19 -00 ...................... 00 7-8 -00 ........................ 00 7-48 -00 ...................... 00
4-12 -00 ...................... 00 6-20 -00 ...................... 00 7-9 -00 ........................ 00 7-49 -00 ...................... 00
4-13 -00 ...................... 00 6-21 -00 ...................... 00 7-10 -00 ...................... 00 7-50 -00 ...................... 00
4-14 -00 ...................... 00 6-22 -00 ...................... 00 7-11 -00 ...................... 00 7-51 -00 ...................... 00
4-15 -00 ...................... 00 6-23 -00 ...................... 00 7-12 -00 ...................... 00 7-52 -00 ...................... 00
4-16 -00 ...................... 00 6-24 -00 ...................... 00 7-13 -00 ...................... 00 7-53 -00 ...................... 00
4-17 -00 ...................... 00 6-25 -00 ...................... 00 7-14 -00 ...................... 00 7-54 -00 ...................... 00
4-18 -00 ...................... 00 6-26 -00 ...................... 00 7-15 -00 ...................... 00 7-55 -00 ...................... 00
4-19 -00 ...................... 00 6-27 -00 ...................... 00 7-16 -00 ...................... 00 7-56 -00 ...................... 00
4-20 -00 ...................... 00 6-28 -00 ...................... 00 7-17 -00 ...................... 00 7-57 -00 ...................... 00
4-21 -00 ...................... 00 6-29 -00 ...................... 00 7-18 -00 ...................... 00 7-58 -00 ...................... 00
4-22 -00 ...................... 00 6-30 -00 ...................... 00 7-19 -00 ...................... 00 7-59 -00 ...................... 00
5-1 -00 ........................ 00 6-31 -00 ...................... 00 7-20 -00 ...................... 00 7-60 -00 ...................... 00
5-2 -00 ........................ 00 6-32 -00 ...................... 00 7-21 -00 ...................... 00 7-61 -00 ...................... 00
5-3 -00 ........................ 00 6-33 -00 ...................... 00 7-22 -00 ...................... 00 7-62 -00 ...................... 00
5-4 -00 ........................ 00 6-34 -00 ...................... 00 7-23 -00 ...................... 00 7-63 -00 ...................... 00
5-5 -00 ........................ 00 6-35 -00 ...................... 00 7-24 -00 ...................... 00 7-64 -00 ...................... 00
5-6 -00 ........................ 00 6-36 -00 ...................... 00 7-25 -00 ...................... 00 7-65 -00 ...................... 00
5-7 -00 ........................ 00 6-37 -00 ...................... 00 7-26 -00 ...................... 00 7-66 -00 ...................... 00
5-8 -00 ........................ 00 6-38 -00 ...................... 00 7-27 -00 ...................... 00 7-67 -00 ...................... 00
5-9 -00 ........................ 00 6-39 -00 ...................... 00 7-28 -00 ...................... 00 7-68 -00 ...................... 00
5-10 -00 ...................... 00 6-40 -00 ...................... 00 7-29 -00 ...................... 00 7-69 -00 ...................... 00
6-1 -00 ........................ 00 6-41 -00 ...................... 00 7-30 -00 ...................... 00 7-70 -00 ...................... 00
6-2 -00 ........................ 00 6-42 -00 ...................... 00 7-31 -00 ...................... 00 7-71 -00 ...................... 00
6-3 -00 ........................ 00 6-43 -00 ...................... 00 7-32 -00 ...................... 00 7-72 -00 ...................... 00
6-4 -00 ........................ 00 6-44 -00 ...................... 00 7-33 -00 ...................... 00 7-73 -00 ...................... 00
6-5 -00 ........................ 00 6-45 -00 ...................... 00 7-34 -00 ...................... 00 7-74 -00 ...................... 00
6-6 -00 ........................ 00 6-46 -00 ...................... 00 7-35 -00 ...................... 00 7-75 -00 ...................... 00
6-7 -00 ........................ 00 6-47 -00 ...................... 00 7-36 -00 ...................... 00 7-76 -00 ...................... 00
6-8 -00 ........................ 00 6-48 -00 ...................... 00 7-37 -00 ...................... 00 7-77 -00 ...................... 00
6-9 -00 ........................ 00 6-49 -00 ...................... 00 7-38 -00 ...................... 00 7-78 -00 ...................... 00
6-10 -00 ...................... 00 6-51 -00 ...................... 00 7-39 -00 ...................... 00 7-79 -00 ...................... 00

CONTINUED ➤

0 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
INTRODUCTION

CONTINUED ➤
page# Release page# Release
7-80 -00 ...................... 00 8-16 -00 .......................00
7-81 -00 ...................... 00 8-17 -00 .......................00
7-82 -00 ...................... 00 8-18 -00 .......................00
7-83 -00 ...................... 00 8-19 -00 .......................00
7-84 -00 ...................... 00 8-20 -00 .......................00
7-85 -00 ...................... 00 8-21 -00 .......................00
7-86 -00 ...................... 00 8-22 -00 .......................00
7-87 -00 ...................... 00 8-23 -00 .......................00
7-88 -00 ...................... 00 8-24 -00 .......................00
7-89 -00 ...................... 00 8-25 -00 .......................00
7-90 -00 ...................... 00 8-26 -00 .......................00
7-91 -00 ...................... 00 i -1 -00 ......................00
7-92 -00 ...................... 00 i -2 -00 ......................00
7-93 -00 ...................... 00 i -3 -00 ......................00
7-94 -00 ...................... 00 i -3 -00 ......................00
7-95 -00 ...................... 00 i -5 -00 ......................00
7-96 -00 ...................... 00 i -6 -00 ......................00
7-97 -00 ...................... 00 i -7 -00 ......................00
7-98 -00 ...................... 00 i -8 -00 ......................00
7-99 -00 ...................... 00 i -9 -00 ......................00
7-100 -00 .................... 00 i -10 -00 ....................00
7-101 -00 .................... 00
7-102 -00 .................... 00
7-103 -00 .................... 00
7-104 -00 .................... 00
8-1 -00 ........................ 00
8-2 -00 ........................ 00
8-3 -00 ........................ 00
8-4 -00 ........................ 00
8-5 -00 ........................ 00
8-6 -00 ........................ 00
8-7 -00 ........................ 00
8-8 -00 ........................ 00
8-9 -00 ........................ 00
8-10 -00 ...................... 00
8-11 -00 ...................... 00
8-12 -00 ...................... 00
8-13 -00 ...................... 00
8-14 -00 ...................... 00
8-15 -00 ...................... 00

Release 00/2001 - 11 0 - 5 - 00
INTRODUCTION RST mille

0.2 REFERENCE GUIDE

RST mille
INFORMAZIONI GENERALI

1.9 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE


SERVICE STAND

1.9.1 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE FRONT


WHEEL STAND
1
2
Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Slide both pins (1) of the front wheel stand into the
holes (2) at front fork bottom end of the same time.
Put one foot on the front end of the stand (3). 3
Press down on stand (3) until it rests fully on the
ground.

1.9.2 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE


CENTRE STAND

Read paragraph 0.2.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS


AND INFORMATION) carefully. 2

Part no. 8140176 (complete stand).


Remove the lower fairing, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Place the motorcycle on the front wheel stand , see 7
1.9.1 (PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
FRONT WHEEL STAND).
Hold the nut (1) steady on the inside.
Release and remove the rear upper right-hand 1 6
engine mounting bolt (2).

Torque wrench setting for nut (1) / bolt (2):50


Nm (5,0 kgm). 5
3 4
NOTE The bolt (2) on the left-hand side is longer
Collect the nut (1).
Slide the upper right-hand mounting boss (3) into the
upper hole on the right-hand side.
Fit the stud bolt (4) into the upper hole on the left-hand
side and screw it fully into the mounting boss (3).
Screw the upper left-hand mounting boss (5) fully onto
stud bolt (4) and tighten.
Hold the nut (6) on the inside steady.
Release and remove the rear lower engine mounting
bolt (7).

Release 00/2001 - 07 1 - 17 - 00

1) Motorcycle model (or engine type) 7) Page update number (progressive number)
2) Section title 8) Subsection number (progressive number)
3) Release progressive number (“00” identifies the original 9) Paragraph number (progressive number)
release) 10) Description of operation (always preceded by the
4) Year and month of issue of relevant release lozenge symbol)
5) Section number 11) Description of operation: the star means that the
6) Page number (pages are numbered sequentially, operation must be repeated on the opposite side of the
numbering begins anew in each section) motorcycle

0 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
INTRODUCTION

0.3 FOREWORD 0.4 REFERENCE MANUALS


- This manual provides the information required for
normal servicing. 0.4.1 ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS
- The information and illustrations contained in this aprilia part# (description)
manual are updated through subsequent releases, see
0.1 (RELEASE 00/2001-11 UPDATE). 8140582 (1051-1) I
- This manual is intended for use by aprilia Dealers and 8140584 (1053-1) F
their qualified mechanics. Certain information has been
omitted intentionally, as this manual does not purport to 8140585 (1054-1) D
provide a comprehensive treatise on mechanics. The
8140583 (1052-1) E
persons who will use this manual must be fully
conversant with the basics of mechanics and with the 8140586 (1055-1) UK
basic procedures of motorcycle repair. Repairing or
inspecting a motorcycle when one does not possess 8140587 (1056-1) USA

such basic knowledge or training could result in


improper servicing and make the motorcycle unsafe to 0.4.2 PARTS CATALOGUES
ride. For the same reason, certain basic precautions aprilia part# (description)
have been omitted in the descriptions of repair and
inspection procedures. Take special care to avoid 390W ............... I UK
damage to motorcycle components or injury to
390Y ................ I UK
persons. aprilia s.p.a.'s mission is to constantly
enhance the riding pleasure of final users through the 3901 ................. I UK
on-going improvement of its products as well as of the RSV01
relevant technical literature. 0.4.3 SPECIAL TOOLS CATALOGUES
All aprilia Points of Sale and Subsidiaries worldwide
are kept updated on major engineering changes and aprilia part# (description)
modifications to repair procedures. Such changes and 8202278 I F D E UK
modifications are then reflected in the next release of
the relevant manual. When in doubt about an
0.4.4 OWNER'S MANUALS
inspection or repair procedure, please contact the
aprilia Consumer Service (A.C.S.) Department, who aprilia part# (description)
will be glad to provide full information on the procedure Model years 1998 -1999
in question as well as on any updates or engineering
changes affecting the motorcycle under consideration. 8102623 I F D

aprilia s.p.a. reserves the right to make changes to its 8102857 P E UK


products at any time, barring any such changes as may
8102858 NL DK SF
alter the essential features of a product as specified in
the relevant manual. 8102859 GR J UK
All rights of storage using electronic means, reproduction
and total or partial adaptation, whatever the means 8104128 AUS

adopted, are reserved in all countries. 8104099 USA


Any reference to products or services provided by
Model years 2000
outside suppliers is for information only and by no means
binding, and implies no warranties or responsibilities as 8104089 I F D
to the performance or use of any such products and/or
services. 8104142 P E UK

Please read 0.4 (REFERENCE MANUALS) for more 8104143 NL DK SF


detailed information. 8104141 GR J UK
Original release: November 2001
8104164 AUS
Produced and printed by:
DECA s.n.c. 8104171 USA
via Risorgimento, 23/1 - 48022 Lugo (RA) - Italia
Tel. +39 - 0545 35235
Fax +39 - 0545 32844 RSV01
E-mail: [email protected]
www.decaweb.it 8104152 I F D
for:
8104269 P E UK
aprilia Consumer Service s.p.a.
via Noalese, 156 - 30036 Santa Maria di Sala (VE) - Italia
Tel. +39 - 041 57 86 101 8104267 NL DK SF
Fax +39 - 041 57 86 100
www.aprilia.com 8104268 GR J UK

8104270 AUS

8104264 USA

Release 00/2001 - 11 0 - 7 - 00
INTRODUCTION RST mille

0.5 SAFETY INFORMATION Read 1.2 (WARNINGS CONCERNING FUEL,


LUBRICANTS, COOLANT AND OTHER COMPONENT
The following conventions are used to identify safety
PARTS) carefully.
information throughout the manual.
This symbol identifies safety-related information. 0.5.2 BEFORE DISASSEMBLING ANY
Whenever you see this symbol in the manual or COMPONENTS
attached to the motorcycle, use utmost care to avoid the - Clean off all dirt, mud, and dust and clear any foreign
risk of injury. Disregarding the instructions identified by objects from the vehicle before disassembling any
this symbol may put your safety, as well as that of other components.
persons or of the motorcycle at risk! - Use the model-specific special tools where specified.

CAUTION 0.5.3 DISASSEMBLING THE COMPONENTS


Disregarding these indications may lead to severe - Never use pliers or similar tools to slacken and/or
injury or death. tighten nuts and bolts. Always use a suitable spanner.
- Mark all connections (hoses, wiring, etc.) with their
WARNING positions before disconnecting them. Identify each
Disregarding these indications may lead to minor connection using a distinctive symbol or convention.
injury or motorcycle damage. - Mark each part clearly to avoid confusion when
refitting.
NOTE The term "NOTE" in this manual precedes - Thoroughly clean and wash any components you have
important information or instructions.
removed using a detergent with low flash point.
- Mated parts should always be refitted together. These
0.5.1 GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFORMATION
parts will have seated themselves against one another
Follow these instructions closely when repairing, in service as a result of normal wear and tear and
disassembling or reassembling the motorcycle or its should never be mixed up with other similar parts on
components. refitting.
- Certain components are matched-pair parts and
CAUTION should always be replaced as a set.
Using bare flames is strictly forbidden when working on the - Keep the motorcycle and its components well away
motorcycle. Before servicing or inspecting the motorcycle: from heat sources.
stop the engine and remove the key from the ignition
switch; allow for the engine and exhaust system to cool 0.5.4 REASSEMBLING THE COMPONENTS
down; where possible, lift the motorcycle using adequate
equipment placed on firm and level ground. Be careful of WARNING
any parts of the engine or exhaust system which may still Never reuse a circlip or snap ring. These parts must
be hot to the touch to avoid scalds or burns. always be renewed once they have been disturbed.
When fitting a new circlip or snap ring, take care to
CAUTION move the open ends apart just enough to allow fit-
ment to the shaft.
Never put any mechanical parts or other vehicle
Make a rule to check that a newly –fitted circlip or
components in your mouth when you have both hands
snap ring has located fully into its groove.
busy. None of the motorcycle components is edible.
Some components are harmful to the human body or Never clean a bearing with compressed air.
toxic.
NOTE All bearings must rotate freely with no hardness
Unless expressly specified otherwise, motorcycle or noise. Replace any bearings that do not meet these
assemblies are refitted or re-assembled by reversing the requirements.
removal or dismantling procedure. Where a procedure is - Use ORIGINAL aprilia SPARE PARTS only.
cross-referred to relevant sections in the manual, proceed - Use the specified lubricants and consumables.
sensibly to avoid disturbing any parts unless strictly - Where possible, lubricate a part before assembly.
necessary. Never attempt to polish matte-finished - When tightening nuts and bolts, start with the largest or
surfaces with lapping compounds. innermost nut/bolt and observe a cross pattern.
Tighten evenly in subsequent steps until achieving the
Never use fuel instead of solvent to clean the motorcycle.
specified torque.
Do not clean any rubber or plastic parts or the seat with - Replace any self-locking nuts, gaskets, seals, circlips
alcohol, petrol or solvents. Clean with water and neutral or snap rings, O-rings, split pins, bolts and screws
detergent. which have a damaged thread.
Always disconnect the battery negative (–) lead before - Clean all joint surfaces, oil seal edges and gaskets
soldering any electrical components. before assembly.
- Apply a light coat of lithium grease along the edges of
When two or more persons service the same motorcycle oil seals. Fit oil seals and bearings with the brand or
together, special care must be taken to avoid personal serial number facing outwards (in view).
injury. - Lubricate the bearings abundantly before assembly.
- Make a rule to check that all components you have
fitted are correctly in place.

0 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
INTRODUCTION

- After repairing the motorcycle and after each service 0.6 SAFETY INFORMATION
inspection, perform the preliminary checks, and then
operate the motorcycle in a private estate area or in a 0.6.1 CONVENTIONS USED IN THE MANUAL
safe area away from traffic - This manual is divided in sections and subsections,
each covering a set of the most significant
components.
For quick reference, see the summary of sections on
page 0-1.
- Unless expressly specified otherwise, assemblies are
reassembled by reversing the dismantling procedure.
- The terms “left” and “right” are referred to the
motorcycle when viewed from the riding position.
- Motorcycle operation and basic maintenance are
covered in the “OWNER'S MANUAL”.
 Any operations preceded by the star symbol must
be repeated on the opposite side of the
motorcycle.
In this manual any variants are identified with these
symbols:
Frame # ZD4DW......(STARTING FROM MODEL YEAR
2001).
ASD AUTOMATIC SWITCH-ON DEVICE

OPT Option

✿ Catalysed version

VERSION:

I Italy GR Greece Mal Malaysia

UK United
NL Netherlands RCH Chile
Kingdom

A Austria CH Switzerland HR Croatia

P Portugal DK Denmark AUS Australia

USA United
SF Finland J Japan States of
America

B Belgium SGP Singapore BR Brazil

RSA Republic of
D Germany SLO Slovenia South
Africa

NZ New
F France IL Israel Zealand

ROK South
E Spain CDN Canada
Korea

Release 00/2001 - 11 0 - 9 - 00
INTRODUCTION RST mille

0.7 ABBREVIATIONS/SYMBOLS/ T.C.E.I. = cheese-headed Allen screw


CONVENTIONS T.E. =hexagonal head
# = Number T.P. =flat head screw
< = is less than TDC = Top Dead Centre
> = is more than TEST = diagnostic check
< = is less than or equal to TSI = Twin Spark Ignition
> = is more than or equal to UPSIDE-
~ = approximately DOWN = inverted fork
∞ = infinite V = Volt
°C = degrees Celsius (centigrade) W = Watt
°F = degrees Fahrenheit
± = plus or minus
A = Ampere
AC =Alternated Current
Ah =Ampere per hour
API = American Petroleum Institute
AV/DC = Anti-Vibration Double Countershaft
bar = pressure measurement (1 bar =100 kPa)
BDC = Bottom Dead Centre
CO = carbon oxide
CPU = Central Processing Unit
cu cm = cubic centimetres
DC = Direct Current
DIN = German industrial standards
(Deutsche Industrie Norm)
DOHC = Double Overhead Camshaft
ECU = Electronic Control Unit
HC = unburnt hydrocarbons
HT = High Tension
ID = inner diameter
ISC = Idle Speed Control
ISO = International Standardization Organization
kg = kilograms
kgm = kilograms per metre (1 kgm =10 Nm)
km = kilometres
km/h = kilometres per hour
kPa = kiloPascal (1 kPa =0.01 bar)
KS = clutch side (from the German "Kupplung
seite")
kW = kiloWatt
kΩ = kiloOhm
l = litres
LAP = racetrack lap
LED = Light Emitting Diode
m/s = metres per second
max = maximum
mbar = millibar (1 mbar =0.1 kPa)
mi = miles
MIN = minimum
MPH = miles per hour
MS = flywheel side (from the German
"Magnetoseite")
MΩ = megaOhm
N.A. = Not Available
N.O.M.M. = Motor Octane Number
N.O.R.M. = Research Octane Number
Nm = Newton per metre (1 Nm =0.1 kgm)
Ø = Diameter
OD = outer diameter
Ω = ohm
PPC = Pneumatic Power Clutch
rpm = revolutions per minute
SAE = Society of Automotive Engineers
T.B.E.I. = crowned-head Allen screw

0 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
INTRODUCTION

NOTES

Release 00/2001 - 11 0 - 11 - 00
INTRODUCTION RST mille

NOTES

0 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

GENERAL INFORMATION 1

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 1 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

GENERAL INFORMATION

CONTENTS
1.1 LOCATION OF SERIAL NUMBERS .. 1-3-00

0
1.1.1 FRAME NUMBER.................................. 1-3-00
1.1.2 ENGINE NUMBER................................. 1-3-00
1.2 WARNINGS CONCERNING FUEL,
LUBRICANTS, COOLANT AND OTHER
COMPONENT PARTS ...................... 1-3-00

1 1.2.1 FUEL ...................................................... 1-3-00


1.2.2 ENGINE OIL........................................... 1-4-00
1.2.3 BRAKE FLUID ....................................... 1-4-00
1.2.4 COOLANT.............................................. 1-5-00

2
1.2.5 CLUTCH FLUID ..................................... 1-5-00
1.2.6 CARBON OXIDE ................................... 1-6-00
1.2.7 HOT COMPONENT PARTS .................. 1-6-00
1.3 RUNNING-IN RECOMMENDATIONS 1-6-00

3
1.4 SPARE PARTS ................................. 1-7-00
1.5 SPECIFICATIONS ............................ 1-7-00
1.6 LUBRICANT CHART ...................... 1-10-00

4
1.7 CONSUMABLES ............................ 1-11-00
1.7.1 PRODUCT FEATURES ....................... 1-11-00
1.7.2 PRODUCT APPLICATIONS ............... 1-12-00
1.8 SPECIAL TOOLS............................ 1-15-00
1.8.1 SUNDRY TOOLS ............................... 1-15-00
5 1.8.2 ENGINE TOOLS .................................. 1-16-00
1.9 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
SERVICE STANDS ......................... 1-17-00
1.9.1 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE

6 FRONT WHEEL STAND ..................... 1-17-00


1.9.2 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
CENTRE STAND ................................ 1-18-00
1.10 HOW TO APPLY THE DECALS ...... 1-19-00

7 1.11 TORQUE FIGURES ........................ 1-21-00

1 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.1 LOCATION OF SERIAL NUMBERS


These numbers are necessary for vehicle registration.
NOTE Altering the identification numbers of vehicle or
engine is a legal offence punishable by heavy fines and
penalties. In addition, altering the frame number (VIN)
results in immediate warranty invalidation.

1.1.1 FRAME NUMBER


The frame number (Vehicle Identification Number) is
etched on the right-hand side of the headstock.

1.1.2 ENGINE NUMBER


The engine number is etched at the rear end of engine, in
the area near the sprocket.

1.2 WARNINGS CONCERNING FUEL,


LUBRICANTS, COOLANT AND OTHER
COMPONENT PARTS

1.2.1 FUEL

CAUTION
The fuel used to operate engines is highly flammable
and becomes explosive under particular conditions.
Refuelling and engine service should take place in a
well-ventilated area with the engine stopped.
Do not smoke when refuelling or in the proximity of
sources of fuel vapours.
Avoid contact with bare flames, sources of sparks or
any other source which may ignite the fuel or lead to
explosion.
Take care not to spill fuel out of the filler, or it may
ignite when in contact with hot engine parts.
In the event of accidental fuel spillage, make sure the
affected area is fully dry before starting the engine.
Fuel expands from heat and when left under direct
sunlight. Never fill the fuel tank up to the rim.
Tighten the filler cap securely after each refuelling.
Avoid contact with skin. Do not inhale vapours. Do
not swallow fuel. Do not transfer fuel between
different containers using a hose.
DO NOT RELEASE FUEL INTO THE ENVIRONMENT.
KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN.
Use only premium-grade unleaded fuel with a minimum
octane rating of 95 (N.O.R.M.) and 85 (N.O.M.M.).

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 3 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

1.2.2 ENGINE OIL 1.2.3 BRAKE FLUID


NOTEThis vehicle is fitted with front and rear disc
CAUTION brakes. Each braking system is operated by an
Prolonged or repeated contact with engine oil may independent hydraulic circuit. The information provided
cause severe skin damage. Wash your hands below applies to both braking systems.
thoroughly after handling engine oil.
Do not release into the environment. CAUTION
Dispose of engine oil through the nearest waste oil
Brake fluid is an irritant. Avoid contact with eyes or
reclamation firm or through the supplier.
skin.
Wear latex gloves during servicing.
In the event of accidental contact, wash affected
Change engine oil after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and body parts thoroughly. In the event of accidental
every 7500 km (4687mi) (*), see 2.13 (ENGINE OIL AND contact with eyes, contact an eye specialist or seek
FILTER CHANGE) afterwards. medical advice.
(*) = On motorcycles used in competition trials, oil should DO NOT RELEASE BRAKE FLUID INTO THE
be changed every 3750 km (2343 mi). ENVIRONMENT.
(Recommended) engine oil, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN.
CHART)Front fork fluid
When handling brake fluid, take care not to spill it
onto plastic or paint-finished parts or they will
CAUTION damage.
Prolonged or repeated contact with front fork fluid Check brake fluid level every 7,500 km (4687 mi),
may cause severe skin damage. Wash your hands see 2.16 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP FRONT
thoroughly after handling front fork fluid. Dispose of BRAKE FLUID LEVEL). See also 2.17 (CHECKING
front fork fluid through the nearest waste oil AND TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).
reclamation firm or through the supplier. Change brake fluid every two years, see 2.21
Wear latex gloves during servicing. (CHANGING THE FRONT BRAKE FLUID) and 2.22
Front suspension response can be modified to a (CHANGING THE REAR BRAKE FLUID).
certain extent by changing damping settings and/or
selecting a particular grade of oil. Standard oil grade (Recommended) brake fluid, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT
is SAE 20 W. Different oil grades can be selected to CHART).
obtain a particular suspension response. (Choose
SAE 5W for a softer suspension, 20W for a stiffer CAUTION
suspension). The two grades can also be mixed in Do not use any brake fluids other than the specified
varying solutions to obtain the desired response. type. Never mix different types of fluids to top up
F.A. or Fork have special properties, level, as this will damage the braking system.
which enable them to retain virtually the same Do not use brake fluid from containers which have
viscosity regardless of temperature to give constant been kept open or in storage for long periods.
damping response. Any sudden changes in play or hardness in the brake
levers are warning signs of problems with the
(Recommended) front fork oil, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT
hydraulic circuits.
CHART).
Ensure that the brake discs and brake linings have
not become contaminated with oil or grease. This is
particularly important after servicing or inspections.
Make sure the brake lines are not twisted or worn.
Prevent accidental ingress of water or dust into the
circuit. Wear latex gloves when servicing the
hydraulic circuit.

1 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.2.4 COOLANT 1.2.5 CLUTCH FLUID


NOTE This vehicle is fitted with a hydraulically
CAUTION operated clutch.
Coolant is toxic when ingested and is an irritant,
contact with eyes or skin may cause irritation. CAUTION
In the event of contact with eyes, rinse repeatedly
Clutch fluid is an irritant. Avoid contact with eyes or
with abundant water and seek medical advice. In the
skin.
event of ingestion, induce vomiting, rinse mouth and
In the event of accidental contact, wash affected
throat with abundant water and seek medical advice
body parts thoroughly. In the event of accidental
immediately.
contact with eyes, contact an eye specialist or seek
DO NOT RELEASE INTO THE ENVIRONMENT. medical advice.
KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN. DO NOT RELEASE CLUTCH FLUID INTO THE
ENVIRONMENT.
CAUTION KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN.
Take care not to spill coolant onto hot engine parts. It
may ignite and produce invisible flames. Wear latex When handling clutch fluid, take care not to spill it
gloves when servicing. onto plastic or paint-finished parts or they will
Do not ride when coolant is below the minimum level. damage.
Check clutch fluid level every 7,500 km (4687 mi),
Check coolant level before each ride and every 15000 km see 2.18 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP CLUTCH
(9375 mi), see 2.14 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP FLUID LEVEL). Change clutch fluid every two years,
COOLANT LEVEL) as part of routine maintenance. see 2.23 (CHANGING THE CLUTCH FLUID).
Change coolant every two years, see 2.15 (COOLANT
CHANGE). (Recommended) clutch fluid, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT
Coolant mixture is a 50% solution of water and anti- CHART).
freeze. This is the ideal solution for most operating
temperatures and provides good corrosion protection.
This solution is also suited to the warm season, as it is
WARNING
less prone to evaporative loss and will reduce the need Do not use any clutch fluids other than the specified
for top-ups. In addition, less water evaporation means type. Never mix different types of fluids to top up
fewer minerals salts depositing in the radiator, which level, as this will damage the clutch system. Do not
helps preserve the efficiency of the cooling system. use clutch fluid from containers which have been
When temperature drops below zero degrees centigrade, open or kept in storage for long periods. Any sudden
check the cooling system frequently and add more anti- changes in play or hardness in the clutch lever are
freeze (up to 60% maximum) to the solution. warning signs of problems with the hydraulic circuit.
Use distilled water in the coolant mixture. Tap water will Make sure the clutch hose is not twisted or worn.
damage the engine. Avoid accidental ingress of water or dust into the
circuit.
(Recommended) engine anti-freeze, see 1.6 Wear latex gloves when servicing the hydraulic
(LUBRICANT CHART). circuit.
Refer to the chart given below and add water with the
quantity of anti-freeze to obtain a solution with the
desired freezing point:

Freezing point °C Coolant


% of volume
-20° 35
-30° 45
-40° 55

NOTE The different brands of anti-freeze available on


the market have varying specifications. Always read
product label to determine the degree of protection
afforded.

WARNING
Use only nitrite-free anti-freeze and corrosion
inhibitors with a freezing point of –35°C as a
minimum.

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 5 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

1.2.6 CARBON OXIDE 1.3 RUNNING-IN RECOMMENDATIONS


When an operation must be performed with the engine Proper engine running-in is essential to preserving
running, position the motorcycle out of doors or in a well- engine life and performance over time.
ventilated area. Never operate the engine in an enclosed Twisty roads and gradients are ideal to break in engine,
place. suspension and brakes effectively.
Use an exhaust emission extraction plant when working Varying speed frequently is also recommended. This will
indoors. vary the amount of stress placed on vehicle components
continuously, allowing engine parts to cool down when
CAUTION less stressed. While it is important to put a certain
Exhaust emissions contain carbon oxide, which is a amount of stress to engine components during the
poisonous gas and may lead to loss of conscience or running-in period, it is equally important to spare the
even death. engine at this stage in vehicle's life.
Operate the engine out of doors or, if working
indoors, use an exhaust emission extraction plant. WARNING
Top acceleration performance is only obtained after
1.2.7 HOT COMPONENT PARTS covering the first 1500 km (937 mi).
Observe the following instructions:
CAUTION
The engine and exhaust component parts become Š Avoid harsh accelerations and do not flip the throttle
hot when the engine is running and will stay hot for open abruptly when the engine is running at low speed,
some time after the engine has been stopped. both during and after the running-in period.
Wear heat gloves before handling these components Š Apply the brakes gently and avoid hard, prolonged
or allow for the engine and exhaust system to cool braking until covering the first 100 km (62 mi).
down before proceeding. Š This will allow the brake pad lining to wear in properly
rubbing on the brake discs.
Š Never exceed 6000 rpm (see chart) during the first
1000 km (625 mi).

WARNING
After covering the first 1000 km (625 mi), perform the
checks listed in the “post running-in” column of the
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART (see 2.1.1). Failure
to perform these checks may lead to personal injury
to yourself or third persons, or vehicle damage.
Š After the first 1000 km (625 mi) and until covering the
first 1500 km (937 mi), a somewhat brisker riding style
is acceptable. Vary your speed and use peak
acceleration for just a few instants, to allow the different
components to become properly seated against one
another.
Š Never exceed 7500-rpm engine speed (see table).
Š After 1500 km (937 mi), the engine will be ready for a
more demanding use. However, never exceed the
maximum engine speed allowed (10500 rpm).

Recommended maximum engine speed


Distance covered in
rpm
Km(mi)
0-1000 (0-625) 6000
1000-1500 (625-937) 7500
over 1500 (937) 10500

1 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.4 SPARE PARTS


Use original aprilia spare parts only to replace original
components. Original aprilia spare parts are high-quality
components designed and built expressly for aprilia
motorcycles.

WARNING
Using any parts OTHER THAN original aprilia parts
may lead to loss of performance and damage.
1.5 SPECIFICATIONS

DIMENSIONS
Overall length 2170 mm
Overall width 740 mm
Overall height (front fairing) 1240 mm
Seat height 820 mm
Wheelbase 1435 mm
Minimum ground clearance 135 mm
Weight in running order (including fuel, coolants and 235 kg
ENGINE
4-stroke longitudinal 60° V twin-cylinder engine fitted
Type
with 4 valves per cylinder and 2 overhead camshafts
Number of cylinders 2
Total displacement 997.6 2cm³
Max rated crankshaft power 86,5 kW (118 HP) at 9250 rpm
Max rated crankshaft power 77 kW (104 HP) at 9250 rpm
Max torque 96.5 Nm (9.78 kgm) at 7250 rpm
Max torque 90 Nm (9.17 kgm) at 7000 rpm
Bore/stroke 97 mm / 67.5 mm
Compression ratio 11.8 ± 0.5: 1
Average piston speed 22,5 m/s at 10000 rpm
Camshaft during intake stroke 262°, valve lift = 10.6 mm
Camshaft during exhaust stroke 259°, valve lift = 10.6 mm
Timing advance (with 1-mm valve clearance) intake valve opens 20° before TDC
intake valve closes 59°after BDC
exhaust valve opens 64° before TDC
exhaust valve closes 15° after BDC

Valve clearance, intake 0.12-0.17 mm


Valve clearance, exhaust 0.23-0.28 mm
# Idling rpm 1250 ± 100 rpm
# Top speed rpm 10500 ± 100 rpm
Ignition computer ignition management
Starter electric starter
5° before TDC upon starting, advance is further
Spark advance:
increased to suit specific consumption.
Starter motor 12 V / 0.9 kW
Transmission ratio of starter motor i= 49/9 * 30/11 * 64/30 = 31.677
hydraulically operated wet multi-plate clutch with control
lever on left-hand handlebar and PPC device
Clutch
- # 9 friction plates, 3.5 mm thick
- # 9 clutch plates, 1.5 mm thick
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 7 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

ENGINE
Mechanical 6-speed transmission with foot control on
Transmission
left-hand side of engine
Dry-sump lubrication system with remote oil tank, # 2
Lubrication system
trochoidal pumps and cooler
min 500 kPa (5 bar)
Lubrication pressure
80 °C (176 °F) max. and 6000 rpm
Air cleaner with dry filter cartridge
Cooling system liquid cooling
Transmission ratio of coolant pump i wp = 28/27 * 28/28 = 1.037
Coolant pump delivery rate (when thermal expansion valve
90 l/min at 9000 rpm
is open)
Thermal expansion valve starts to open at 65 ± 2 °C (149 ± 5 °F)
Dry engine weight ~ 67 kg
CAPACITIES
Fuel (including reserve) 20.5 l
Fuel reserve 4±1l
Engine oil oil change 3700 cu cm oil and filter change 3900 cu cm
Front fork oil (each leg) 553 ± 2,5 cu cm
Coolant 2.5 l (50% water + 50% ethylene glycol anti-freeze)
Seat twin-seat 2
Max carrying load (rider + pillion rider + luggage) 182 kg

DRIVE
Secondary drive
Gear Total drive ratio
ratio
1st 13.000
14/35 = 1: 2.500
2nd 9.102
Primary drive ratio 16/28 = 1: 1.750 Final drive ratio
DRIVE RATIOS 3rd 7.117
31/60 = 1: 1.935 19/26 = 1: 1.368 16/43 = 1: 2.687
4th 5.674
22/24 = 1: 1.091
5th 4.975
23/22 = 1: 1.957
6th 4.431
27/23 = 1: 0.852
# Sprocket 16 teeth
Chain drive Endless O-ring chain, type 525, size 5/8" x 5/16"

FUEL SYSTEM
Type Electronic fuel injection
Venturi Ø 51 mm
INDUCTION
Type Indirect (MULTIPOINT) injection
Premium-grade unleaded petrol, minimum octane rating
Fuel
95 (N.O.R.M.) and 85 (N.O.M.M.)
FRAME
Dual-beam design made from light alloy cast members
Type
and extruded members
Rake 25.7°
Trail 97 mm
SUSPENSION
Adjustable telescopic UPSIDE-DOWN hydraulic fork
Front
with Ø 43-mm legs
Travel 120 mm
CONTINUED ➤

1 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

Light-alloy single-sided swinging arm and adjustable oil/


Rear
air-sprung mono-shock absorber
Wheel travel 120 mm
BRAKES
Twin-disc brake with Ø 300-mm floating discs, four-
Front
piston calipers with Ø 30-mm/ Ø 34-mm diameter
Rear Disc brake - Ø 255 mm, dual-piston caliper - Ø 28
WHEELS
Type Light-alloy wheel rim
Front 3.50 x 17"
Rear 5.50 x 17"

TYRES
Pressure in kPa
(bar)
Wheel Brand Type Size Recommended
Œ
solo riding

Front (standard) METZELER ME Z4 B 120/70ZR17” Œ 250 (2.5)

Rear (standard) METZELER ME Z4 180/55ZR17” Œ 290 (2.8)

Front (standard) MICHELIN PILOT SPORT 120/70ZR17” ❖ 250 (2.5)


Rear (standard) MICHELIN PILOT SPORT 180/55ZR17” ❖ 290 (2.8)
Front (option) METZELER ME Z3 120/70ZR17” ❖ 250 (2.5)
Rear (option) METZELER ME Z3 180/55ZR17” ❖ 290 (2.8)

Front (option) PIRELLI MTR21A 120/70ZR17” Œ 250 (2.5)

Rear (option) PIRELLI MTR22 180/55ZR17” Œ 280 (2.8)

Œ = Road use ; ❖ = Competition

SPARK PLUGS
Standard NGK R DCPR9E
Electrode gap 0.6 -0.7 mm
Resistance 5KΩ
ELECTRIC SYSTEM
Battery rating 12 V - 12 Amps
Main fuses 30A
Auxiliary fuses 15A
Generator (permanent-wound magnet type) rating 12 V - 400 W
Starter motor rating 12 V / 0.9 kW
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 9 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

BULBS
Low beam (halogen lamp) 12 V - 55 / 55 W H4
High beam (halogen lamp) 12 V - 60 W H3
Front parking light 12 V - 5 W
Direction indicators 12 V - 10 W
Rear parking light / plate / stop light 12 V - 5/21 W
Rev. counter light LED
Right-hand multi-purpose display light LED
Left-hand multi-purpose display light LED
WARNING LIGHTS
Neutral light LED
Direction indicators LED
Low fuel LED
High beam LED
Stand light LED
Engine oil pressure LED
Red line LED

1.6 LUBRICANT CHART (Recommended) aerosol chain lubricant: CHAIN


(Recommended) engine oil: EXTRA RAID 4, SAE SPRAY or CHAIN LUBE.
15W - 50 or TEC 4T SAE 15W - 50. As an
alternative to recommended oils, top brand oils meeting CAUTION
or exceeding CCMC G-4, A.P.I. SG. specifications can be Use new brake fluid only.
used.
(Recommended) brake fluid: F.F., DOT 5 (DOT 4
(Recommended) fork oil: front fork oil F. A . 5 W or
F.A. 20W. compatible) or BRAKE 5.1, DOT 5 (DOT 4
As an alternative, use FORK 5W or FORK compatible).
20W. When you wish to obtain an intermediate response
between those offered by F.A. 5W and F.A. 20W CAUTION
Use new clutch fluid only.
oils or FORK 5W and FORK 20W oils,
you may mix the different products as follows: (Recommended) clutch fluid: F.F., DOT 5 (DOT 4
SAE 10W = F.A. 5W 67% of volume, + F.A. 20W
compatible) or BRAKE 5.1, DOT 5 (DOT 4
33% of volume, or
compatible).
FORK 5W 67% of volume, + FORK
20W 33% of volume.
CAUTION
SAE 15W = F.A. 5W 33% of volume, + F.A. 20W Use only nitrite-free anti-freeze and corrosion
67% of volume, or inhibitors with a freezing point of -35°C as a
FORK 5W 33% of volume, + FORK minimum.
20W 67% of volume.
(Recommended) engine coolant: ECO-BLU -
Bearings and other lubrication points
40°C or COOL.
(recommended):
AUTOGREASE MP or GREASE 30.
As an alternative to recommended grease, use top brand
rolling bearing grease that will resist a temperature range
of -30°C…+140°C, with dropping point 150°C…230°C,
high corrosion protection, good resistance to water and
oxidisation.
Battery lead protection: use neutral grease or vaseline.

1 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.7 CONSUMABLES
Use only the products specified below for motorcycle
maintenance.
These products have demonstrated suitability for all
usage conditions specified by the manufacturer after
long-.time testing.
NOTE The products for which a part number is given
are available at request, see 1.7.2 (PRODUCT
APPLICATIONS).

1.7.1 PRODUCT FEATURES

Product Usage and features


Blue LOCTITE® 243 Threadlocking adhesive for nuts and bolts up to M36, provides
medium-strength fit.
Suitable for use on less than perfectly degreased parts.
Cure time varies with temperature and substrate up to one hour
maximum.
Withstands temperatures in the – 55 to 150 °C range (– 99 to
302 °F).
High-strength retaining compound for bolts.
Green LOCTITE® 648 Cure time varies with temperature and substrate up to twelve
hours maximum.
Withstands temperatures in the – 55 to 175 °C range (– 99 to
347 °F).
Mated parts must be heated up to 250 °C (482 °F) before they
can be disassembled.
Solvent-free sealant. Eliminates the need for gaskets in joints
Orange LOCTITE® 574
exposed to high friction and where a specified gap needs to be
maintained between parts.
Liquid sealant, cures within a few hours after assembly when in
contact with metal to form a gasket whose surface structure
matches mating surfaces.
Resists temperatures from – 55 to 200 °C ( – 99 to 392 °F),
inhibits corrosion of sealed surfaces.

LOCTITE® 8150

High-temperature assembly paste.

LOCTITE® Anti Seize 15378


Lubricant and corrosion inhibitor, resists high temperatures.
When sprayed on both parts, provides long-term maintenance-
free operation of contact surfaces.
Inhibits corrosion.

MOLYKOTE® G-n
Lubricating compound for use on heavy-duty stressed parts, for
base lubrication and on fits under pressure to avoid corrosion
and sticking.
Apply on both contact surfaces.

SILASTIC 732 RTV

Sealant, prevents ingress of water into flywheel casing.

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 11 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

1.7.2 PRODUCT APPLICATIONS

Product Part number Applications

- Swinging arm rivets, instrument panel/front fairing mount, seat


subframe and frame (on assembly).
- Frame-to-engine and frame-to-swinging arm adjusting bushes
(on assembly).
- Cable guide screws to frame (on assembly).
- Headstock bearings.
- Headstock top bush.
- Roller bearings of timing idler gear.
Engine oil (*) 8116050 - Thrust washer of lower balancing shaft.
- Clutch disengagement shaft.
- Valve stems and buckets.
- Valve guide seals.
- Casing location of camshafts.
- Timing chain tensioner.
- Compound starter gear and idler gear pins.
- Freewheeling clutch-to-gear contact surfaces.
- Inner contact surface of freewheeling clutch.

- Steering retaining bush.


- Rear brake caliper detent.
- Front sprocket.
- Rear brake pedal spindle.
- Cooling fans to support.
- Fuel return line fitting.
- Fuel filler cap.
- Throttle cable pulley nut.
- Throttle cable bracket screws.
- Throttle valve spindle nut.
LOCTITE® 243 (**) 0897651 - Throttle position sensor screws.
- Coolant pump central screw.
- Cylinder connecting bracket screws.
- Engine casing bearing screws.
- Cylinder stud bolts.
- Crankshaft position sensor screws.
- Index lever and plate screws.
- Crankshaft nut.
- Timing gear screws.
- Nut securing counterweight to upper balancing shaft.
- Lower screw of timing idler gear bearing mount.
- Coolant pump idler gear shaft.
- Engine oil pump plug.
- Clutch gear metal plate screws.
- Freewheeling clutch to magnet wheel (on assembly).
- Freewheeling clutch screws.
LOCTITE® 648 (**) 0899788
- Clutch housing nut.
- Screw securing counterweight to lower balancing shaft.
- Flywheel rotor inner cone.
- Flywheel retaining screw.

1 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

Product Part number Applications


- Coolant thermal switch.
- Coolant thermistors.
Orange LOCTITE ® 574
0899784 - Contact screw of neutral switch.
(**)
- Outer surface of engine oil pump motor.
- Cylinder footprint on crankcase.
- Transmission primary and secondary shaft.
- Crankcase locations of transmission primary and secondary
LOCTITE Anti Seize
®
0297434 shafts.
15378 (**)
- Crankshaft and balancing shaft.
- Crankcase location and spline of transmission primary shaft.
- Crankcase locations of main bearing sleeves.
- Main bearing sleeves.
- Crankcase bearing locations.
- Coolant pump shaft.
- Valve guide seats in cylinder head.
- Valve guide edges.
MOLYKOTE® G-n (**) 0297433
- Crankcase locations of crankshaft and balancing shaft bearing
sleeves.
- Crankcase locations of crankshaft and balancing shaft.
- Bores accommodating piston pins.
- Camshaft cams.
- Starter motor mount.
- Cable bracket on flywheel cover.
SILASTIC 732 RTV (**) 0297386
- Camshaft sensor cable.
- Front and rear wheel seals (on assembly).
- Swinging arm shaft bearings (on assembly).
- Clutch master cylinder actuating rod (on assembly).
- Rear wheel shaft thread.
- Steering head bearings.
Bimol Grease 481 8116053
- Rear brake master cylinder actuating rod (on assembly).
- Rear brake pedal spindle.
- Thrust washer of timing idler gear.
- Upper balancing shaft seal.
- Starter motor gear.
LUBERING Grease ST 8116038 - Choke control (on assembly).
- Handlebar counterweight rubber (on assembly).
- Throttle cable adjuster rubbers (on assembly).
- Gearshift lever rubber (on assembly).
- Lower retaining pins of radiators to rubber mounts (on
AP-LUBE temporary
- assembly).
lubricant
- Breather hose to radiator and three-way manifold (on assembly).
- Coolant hose couplings to radiators (on assembly).
- Water and fuel drain hoses to fuel flange (on assembly).
- Throttle body torsion springs (on assembly).
DID CHAIN LUBE - Drive chain.
Grease
“Biosolvent” frame
8116031 - For washing the engine oil tank.
detergent
Cyanoacrilic paste
8116945 - Airbox gasket (on assembly).
“ACRILON 28”

MOTUL MOTOWASH
- - For cleaning frame and swinging arm.
Degreaser

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 13 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

Product Part number Applications

Anti-seize compound
ANTI-SEIZE 8116043 - Plugs of exhaust take-up points.
MOTAGEPASTE AS 1800

- For cleaning left-hand handlebar before fitting twistgrip.


- Radiator breather hoses into T union.
- Ignition coil mount rubber (on assembly).
- Side body panel rubbers (on assembly).
- For cleaning bottom part of engine.
- Starter relay rubber (on assembly).
- Cush drive to rear wheel sprocket (on assembly).
- Engine oil cooler rubbers (on assembly).
Alcohol -
- Hose coupling to coolant filler cap (on assembly).
- For cleaning engine oil tank before decal application.
- Instrument panel/front fairing rubbers (on assembly).
- Rear brake pedal rubber (on assembly).
- Hoses to fuel filter (inside fuel tank) (on assembly).
- Coupling connecting coolant radiators (on assembly).
- Fuel lines to fuel tank (on assembly).
- For cleaning fuel tank before decal application.

(*) = see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).


(**) =see 1.7.1 (PRODUCT FEATURES).

1 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.8 SPECIAL TOOLS


Special tools have been developed to ensure proper
disassembly, re-assembly and adjustment without the
risk of damaging any components. Using inadequate
tools and/or improvised procedures may lead to
irreparable damage. Model-specific special tools for this
vehicle are listed below. If needed, order the brand-
specific special tools (see Special Tools Catalogue).

WARNING
Always read the instructions supplied with the
special tools before use.

1.8.1 SUNDRY TOOLS


Ref. Tool designation and application Part number
Full frame kit including:
– split sleeve for fork seal fitment
1 8140203
– socket for steering adjustment
– socket for swinging arm spindle – engine mount adjustment
2 Tool for chain removal/fitment 8140192
3 Centre stand 8140176
4 Axone 2000 8140595
5 Front wheel stand 8140195
6 Exhaust emission tester 8140196
7 Emission tester tube kit 8140202
8 Tool board 8140199
9 Bearing extractor kit 10 - 30 mm Ø 8140180

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 15 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

1.8.2 ENGINE TOOLS

Ref. Tool designation and application Part number


1 Full engine tool kit 8140175
2 Drift to fit transmission secondary shaft seal 0277680
3 Drift to fit seal into secondary balancing shaft location 0277660
4 Drift to fit seal into coolant pump shaft location 0277670
5 Drift to fit sliding ring into coolant pump shaft location 0877257
6 Valve guide extractor 0277510
7 Drift for valve guide seal fitment 0277695
8 Drift for valve guide fitment 0277210
9 Drift to fit transmission shaft and clutch shaft seals 8140155
10 Drift to fit main balancing shaft bearing sleeves 0277729
11 Crankshaft bearing sleeve extractor 0277720
12-14 Drifts to fit crankshaft bearing sleeves 0277725
13 Drift to fit clutch cover – crankshaft bearing sleeves 0277727
15 Spark plug tool 8140177
16 Flywheel cover puller 0277252
17 Hexagon nut for flywheel removal 0277780
18 Threaded rod to hold crankshaft in TDC position 0240880
19 Transmission secondary shaft guide sleeve 0277308
20 Vacuum gauge 8140256
21 Fuel/oil pressure gauge 8140181
22 Rotor bolt extractor 8140182
23 Clutch anti-rotation tool 0277881
8140156 + 8140157 +
24 Extractors for clutch cover bearing sleeves
0276377
25 Tool to compress valve springs 0276479
26 Tool for valve removal/fitment 8140179
27 Adhesive template for tool board 8157143
28 Engine lifting eyebolt 8140183
29 Primary drive nut extractor 8140184
30 Clutch plate extractors 8140185
31 Engine stand 8140188
32 Engine stand pedestal 8140187
33 Tool to compress piston rings 8140186

1 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.9 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE


SERVICE STANDS

1.9.1 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE FRONT


WHEEL STAND 1
2
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Slide both pins (1) of the front wheel stand (3) into the
holes (2) at front fork bottom end at the same time.
Š Put one foot on the front end of the stand (3). 3
Š Press down on stand (3) until it rests fully on the
ground.

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 17 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

1.9.2 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE


CENTRE STAND
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 2
Part no. 8140176 (complete stand).
Š Remove the lower fairing, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Place the motorcycle on the front wheel stand , 7
see 1.9.1 (PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
FRONT WHEEL STAND).
ŠHold the nut (1) steady on the inside.
ŠRelease and remove the rear upper right-hand 1 6
engine mounting bolt (2).

Torque wrench setting for nut (1) / bolt (2):


50 Nm (5.0 kgm). 5 19
3 4
NOTE The bolt (2) on the left-hand side is longer. 12
17
ŠCollect the nut (1).
Š Slide the upper right-hand mounting boss (3) into the
upper hole on the right-hand side.
Š Fit the stud bolt (4) into the upper hole on the left-hand
side and screw it fully into the mounting boss (3). 14
Š Screw the upper left-hand mounting boss (5) fully onto
stud bolt (4) and tighten.
ŠHold the nut (6) on the inside steady. 11 16
ŠRelease and remove the rear lower engine mounting
bolt (7).

Torque wrench setting for nut (6) / bolt (7):


50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
20
NOTE The bolt (7) on the right-hand side is longer. 10
Š Slide the lower right-hand mounting boss (8) into the 9
lower hole on the right-hand side. 8
Š Fit the stud bolt (9) into the lower hole on the left-hand 13 18
side and screw it fully into the mounting boss (8).
Š Screw the lower left-hand mounting boss (10) fully onto
stud bolt (9) and tighten.
Š Fit the bracket (11) onto the mounting bosses (3-8).
The longer portion of the bracket base must be facing 15 16
11
forward.
Š Snug the two washers (12 - 13) and nuts (14 - 15)
finger-tight.
Š Tighten both nuts (14 - 15).
Š Fit the bracket (16) onto the mounting bosses (5-10)
with the longer portion of the base facing forward.
Š Snug the two washers (17 - 18) and nuts (19 - 20)
finger-tight.
Š Tighten both nuts (19 - 20).
Š Remove the wheel stands.

1 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.10 HOW TO APPLY THE DECALS


Whenever you remove any body parts:

WARNING 4
2
Handle plastic and paint-finished parts with care to
avoid scratching or damage. 3
Proceed carefully.
Do not damage the snap-on tabs and matching
recesses.
Strictly follow the instructions below.
We recommend using:
- a medium spatula (1); 1
NOTE Soft spatulas – such as those commonly used
on windscreen wipers - will leave excess water under the
decal.
- a sponge or spray dispenser (2) and water.
NOTE Add water with 1-3% detergent and shake to
obtain frothing.
3
Apply the decals as follows:
Š Place a decal (3) on a bench with the adhesive face up.
Š Keep the decal well stretched on the bench and
remove the protective film (4).
NOTE A spray dispenser (2) will work best.
If you are using a sponge, dab the decal surface lightly or
the adhesive will deteriorate.
Š Wet the adhesive face with soap water.
Š Place the decal (3) in the proper position on the part
you wish to decorate.
NOTE Always apply the spatula to the decal centre and
move it towards the edges with regular movements.
Š Rub the spatula (1) across the decal surface pressing
moderately until removing excess soap and water from
under the decal.
NOTE Take care not to lift the decal corners and edges
in the process.
Š Dry up the decal with an absorbent cloth. Apply cloth in 1
the centre and move outwards.
Š Rub the decal using the spatula with firm, regular
strokes. Apply the spatula in the centre and move
outwards. Take special care with corners and edges to
ensure proper adhesion across the whole surface.

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 19 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

NOTE Where decals come with application tape (5)*,


remove tape 20-30 minutes after decal application.
Š Peel off the application tape (5) from decal surface. 5
Š Pass the spatula across the decal again – particularly
over corners and edges – to ensure proper adhesion.
NOTE Decals applied using water will take about 48
hours to stick to part permanently.
Š Once you have removed the application tape, check for
any air trapped underneath the decal.
If there are any air bubbles:
Š Prick a hole on the edge (7) of the air bubble using a
pin or a cutter (6).
Š Apply the spatula (1) at the opposite end and move it
across the bubble to squeeze air out.

* Application tape is used to facilitate the application of


brands and lettering in the proper position and keeps
the sticker stiffer during application.

1 - 20 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

1.11 TORQUE FIGURES


The table below reports the standard torque figures for C B
metric size screws and bolts in accordance with ISO A
standards. D

Screw or Tightening torque


bolt Spanner
thread Nm kgm

M6 10 6 0.6
M8 12 15 1.5
M 10 14 30 3.0
M 12 17 55 5.5
M 14 19 85 8.5
M 16 22 130 13.0

For model-specific torque figures, see 2.41 (FASTENERS).


Unless otherwise specified, torque figures are intended
for application to clean, dry threads at room temperature.
NOTE Follow the instructions below to avoid distortion
and/or improper fit:
Š Screw all fasteners finger-tight.
Š Tighten fasteners in a cross pattern - (A) and (B); (C)
and (D) - to half the specified torque.
Š Repeat sequence tightening to specified torque.
NOTE This way, the load generated by the fasteners is
applied evenly across joint surface.

Release 00/2001 - 11 1 - 21 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION RST mille

NOTES

1 - 22 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS

PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND


ADJUSTMENTS 2

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 1 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

PERIODIC MAINTENANCE 2.17 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP REAR


AND ADJUSTMENTS BRAKE FLUID LEVEL .................... 2-30-00

2.18 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP CLUTCH


CONTENTS FLUID LEVEL................................. 2-32-00

2.19 BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS 2-34-00


2.1 PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART . 2-4-00

0
2.1.1 PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART..... 2-5-00 2.20 BLEEDING THE CLUTCH............... 2-38-00

2.2 LUBRICATION POINTS .................. 2-7-00 2.21 CHANGING THE FRONT BRAKE
FLUID ............................................ 2-39-00
2.3 MULTIFUNCTION COMPUTER ........ 2-8-00
2.3.1 KEY ........................................................ 2-8-00 2.22 CHANGING THE REAR BRAKE

1 2.3.2 PROGRAMMING BUTTONS................. 2-8-00


2.3.3 INSTRUMENT PANEL LIGHT
FLUID ............................................ 2-40-00

2.23 CHANGING THE CLUTCH FLUID .. 2-41-00


INTENSITY............................................. 2-8-00
2.3.4 HOW TO TOGGLE BETWEEN ODOMETER/ 2.24 ADJUSTING THE FRONT BRAKE LEVER

2 TRIP METER.......................................... 2-9-00 AND CLUTCH LEVER .................... 2-41-00


2.3.5 MEASUREMENT UNITS (KM/MI, L /GAL, 2.25 ADJUSTING REAR BRAKE LEVER
°C/°F) ..................................................... 2-9-00 PLAY.............................................. 2-42-00
2.3.6 HOW TO TOGGLE BETWEEN FUEL LEVEL/
AIR TEMPERATURE INDICATION....... 2-9-00 2.26 ADJUSTING THE GEAR SHIFT

3 2.3.7 SETTING THE CLOCK (HOURS AND


MINUTES) ............................................ 2-10-00
LEVER ........................................... 2-42-00

2.27 CHECKING BRAKE PADS FOR


2.3.8 INSTRUMENT AND INDICATOR WEAR............................................. 2-43-00
CHART................................................. 2-10-00

4
2.28 STEERING ..................................... 2-44-00
2.4 BATTERY....................................... 2-13-00
2.28.1 CHECKING PLAY IN THE BEARINGS. 2-44-00
2.4.1 CLEANING AND CHECKING BATTERY 2.28.2 ADJUSTING PLAY IN THE BEARINGS 2-45-00
TERMINALS AND LEAD
CONNECTIONS................................... 2-14-00 2.29 INSPECTING THE FRONT

5 2.4.2 CHARGING THE BATTERY................ 2-15-00


2.4.3 LONG INACTIVITY .............................. 2-15-00
SUSPENSION ................................ 2-47-00
2.29.1 FRONT SUSPENSION ....................... 2-47-00
2.29.2 FRONT FORK ADJUSTMENT ........... 2-48-00
2.5 ELECTRIC COMPONENTS ............. 2-15-00
2.30 REAR SWINGING ARM ................. 2-49-00

6
2.6 JUMP-STARTING .......................... 2-16-00
2.30.1 SWINGING ARM ADJUSTMENT ....... 2-49-00
2.7 SPARK PLUGS............................... 2-17-00
2.31 REAR SUSPENSION INSPECTION 2-50-00
2.8 LIFTING THE FUEL TANK ............. 2-19-00 2.31.1 REAR SUSPENSION.......................... 2-50-00
2.31.2 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER

7
2.9 DRAINING THE FUEL TANK ......... 2-20-00
ADJUSTMENT..................................... 2-50-00
2.10 AIR CLEANER................................ 2-21-00 2.31.3 INSPECTING THE REAR SUSPENSION
2.11 THROTTLE ................................... 2-22-00 LINKAGE SYSTEM ............................. 2-51-00
2.11.1 CHECKING FOR THROTTLE PROPER 2.32 FRONT WHEEL .............................. 2-52-00

8 OPERATION........................................ 2-22-00
2.11.2 IDLING ADJUSTMENT........................ 2-22-00
2.33 REAR WHEEL ................................ 2-52-00
2.11.3 THROTTLE CABLE PLAY 2.34 EXHAUST MANIFOLD NUTS ......... 2-53-00
ADJUSTMENT..................................... 2-23-00
2.35 DRIVE CHAIN ................................ 2-54-00
9 2.12 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP ENGINE
OIL LEVEL ..................................... 2-24-00
2.35.1 CHAIN SLACK INSPECTION.............. 2-54-00
2.35.2 CHECKING CHAIN AND SPROCKETS
2.13 ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE . 2-25-00 FOR WEAR.......................................... 2-55-00
2.35.3 CHAIN SLACK ADJUSTMENT .......... 2-55-00
2.14 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP COOLANT 2.35.4 DRIVE CHAIN GUIDE PLATE
LEVEL............................................ 2-27-00 INSPECTION ....................................... 2-56-00
2.15 COOLANT CHANGE....................... 2-28-00 2.35.5 CHAIN SLIDER INSPECTION ............. 2-56-00

2.16 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP FRONT 2.36 TYRES .......................................... 2-57-00


BRAKE FLUID LEVEL .................... 2-29-00

2 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.37 FUEL LINES ................................. 2-58-00

2.38 BRAKE AND CLUTCH LINES ........ 2-58-00

2.39 COOLANT PIPES........................... 2-58-00

2.40 MAINTAINING FASTENERS AT THE


CORRECT TIGHTENING TORQUE 2-59-00

2.41 FASTENERS ................................. 2-60-00


2.41.1 CLEANING AND LUBRICATION......... 2-66-00

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 3 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Outlined in this section are the recommended procedures


for the periodic maintenance of the key components of
the motorcycle.

CAUTION
Before proceeding to maintain or inspect the
motorcycle, stop the engine and remove the ignition
switch key. Ensure that the engine and exhaust
system have cooled down. Wherever possible, place
the motorcycle on firm and level ground and lift it
using suitable equipment.
Be careful of any parts of the engine or exhaust
system which may still be hot. Contact with hot
engine or exhaust parts may cause severe burns.
All component parts of the vehicle are inedible.
Do not bite, suck, chew or swallow any vehicle parts.
Unless expressly specified otherwise, reassembly is
carried out by reversing the disassembly procedure.

2.1 PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART


In order to preserve the motorcycle in sleek running
order, aprilia recommends that you strictly observe the
periodic maintenance intervals recommended for the
different component parts.
1
WARNING
Upon reaching the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every
7500 km (4687 mi) afterwards, a wording "SERVICE"
(1) will appear on the right-hand display.
When this occurs, look up the periodic maintenance
chart and perform the required maintenance. Note
that motorcycles used in competition trials need to
be maintained more frequently, see 2.1.1 (PERIODIC
MAINTENANCE CHART).

2 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.1.1 PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART

Post running-in Every 7500 km Every 15000 km


Component checks (4687 mi) or 12 (9375 mi) or 24
[1000 km (625 mi)] months months
Spark plugs c(*) e(*)
Stand
Throttle cables c c
Connecting rod and rear suspension
bearings
c

Steering bearings and steering c c


Wheel hub bearings c
Air cleaner c e
Engine oil filter e(*) e(*)
Engine oil filter (in fuel tank) d d
Front fork c c
Lights operation / setting c
Valve clearance R f
Throttle body shaft, grease c c
Brake system c c
Cooling system c
Lighting system c c
Safety switches c c
c
Clutch fluid
every 2 years: e
c
Brake fluid
every 2 years: e
c
Coolant
every 2 years:e
Front fork oil After the first 7500 km (4687 mi) and every 22500 km (14000 mi): e
Engine oil e e(*)
Brake pads If worn: e
Pistons every 5000 Km (3125 mi): c(**)
Tyres c c
Tyre pressures f every 15 days:c
Engine idling speed f f
Torque of nuts and bolts c c
Cylinder synchronisation c c
Suspension and suspension adjustments c c
Engine oil pressure LED each time engine is started: c
Brake fluid bleeding c
Clutch fluid bleeding c
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 5 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Post running-in Every 7500 km Every 15000 km


Component checks (4687 mi) or 12 (9375 mi) or 24
[1000 km (625 mi)] months months
Drive chain tension and lubrication every 1000 km (625 mi):c
Battery leads and terminals c c
Fuel lines c every 4 years: e
Final drive (chain, front and rear sprocket) c
Brake and clutch lines c every 4 years: e
Cooling system hoses c
Clutch wear c(*)
Brake pad wear before each ride and every 2000 km(1250 mi):c
c = inspect and clean, set or adjust, lubricate or replace as required; d = clean; e = replace; f= set or adjust.
Service the motorcycle more frequently when you ride in the rain, on dusty or bumpy roads, or in competition
trials.
( ) = THESE OPERATIONS CAN BE CARRIED OUT BY THE OWNER
(*) = If motorcycle is used in competition trials, change every 3750 km (2343 mi).
(**) = Only applies to motorcycles: - used on the racetrack – used in competitions.

2 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.2 LUBRICATION POINTS KEY TO THE LAYOUT OF LUBRICATION POINTS


Proper lubrication is critical to ensuring smooth operation 1) Steering bearings
and preserving vehicle life. 2) Clutch lever spindle
3) Rider right-hand footpeg
NOTE Before lubricating any part, clean off any 4) Rider left-hand footpeg
oxidation deposits, grease, dirt or dust. 5) Passenger left-hand footpeg
Parts subject to oxidation must be lubricated with engine 6) Rear wheel spindle and hub bearings
oil or grease, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART). 7) Drive chain
Lubrication points are shown in the “LAYOUT OF 8) Rear suspension levers
LUBRICATION POINTS”. 9) Side stand spindle
10) Passenger right-hand footpeg
11) Front wheel spindle and hub bearings
12) Swinging arm spindle
■ = Grease
▲ = Oil

2 ▲
5 ■
4 ■
■ 1

7 ■

8 ■
■ 9 6 ■

10 ■

11 ■ ■ 12
■ 3

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 7 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.3 MULTIFUNCTION COMPUTER

2.3.1 KEY B
A Left-hand digital display (odometer, shows total km/
miles covered)
B Right-hand multifunction digital display (fuel level/air
temperature – coolant temperature – clock/injection
diagnostics)
C SET and MODE programming buttons.

A
C

2.3.2 PROGRAMMING BUTTONS


Perform these operations when the motorcycle is at 1 2
standstill.
4
Performing these operations while riding may lead to an
accident.
5
NOTE The instructions given below are referred to the
motorcycle with the engine stopped.

Rotate the ignition switch key (1) to position . The


following instrument panel lights will come on within the
next three seconds:
- all warning LED lights;
- all backlighting LEDs; 6
- all segments of the left-hand display; 3
- all segments and messages of the right-hand
multifunction display.
This is part of an auto-test routine of LED, message,
segment and instrument operation.
After three seconds, all lights except the oil pressure LED
(2) (which stays on until engine is started up) will go
out and the display will show:
- total distance covered in kilometres (3);
- fuel level (4);
- coolant temperature (5) [characters "---" are displayed
until coolant warms up to 35° C (95° F)];
- time (hours and minutes format) (6).

2.3.3 INSTRUMENT PANEL LIGHT INTENSITY


There are three different settings available for instrument
panel light intensity: 100%; 60%; 25%.
2
How to set:

Set the light switch (1) to " ";


Set the light dip switch " "-" " (2) to " ".
NOTE Three seconds after the last selection, the SET
button will revert to odometer/trip meter toggle mode.

2 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

Š Set the ignition switch to " " and press the SET
button (3) repeatedly within the next three seconds to
try out the three light settings.
Š Select the desired lighting intensity.

2.3.4 HOW TO TOGGLE BETWEEN ODOMETER/


TRIP METER
Left-hand display
Š Press and release the Set button (1). The display will
toggle between odometer and trip meter mode, that is,
show the motorcycle's total mileage (in kilometres or
miles) or the distance covered since the trip meter was
last reset.
NOTE Whenever the ignition switch is set to " ", the
display will revert to odometer mode (total mileage).
The trip meter is reset to zero as follows:
Š Set display to trip meter mode. 2 1
Š Hold down the SET button (1) for over three seconds
and all segments (2) will be reset to zero.
NOTE The trip meter will reset automatically each time
the battery is removed from the vehicle.

2.3.5 MEASUREMENT UNITS (KM/MI, L /GAL, °C/°F)

WARNING
Measurement units such as km/mi, l /gal, °C/°F are
set at the factory depending on country of
destination. Factory setting cannot be modified.

2.3.6 HOW TO TOGGLE BETWEEN FUEL LEVEL/


AIR TEMPERATURE INDICATION 2
3
Right-hand multifunction display
Š Press and release the MODE button (1). The display
will show the fuel level (2) or air temperature (3)
indication (in figures).
NOTE Whenever the ignition switch is set to " ", the
display will revert to fuel level indication (2).

1 1

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 9 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.3.7 SETTING THE CLOCK (HOURS AND MINUTES)


2
NOTE The clock can only be set when the motorcycle
is at standstill.
Š Hold down the MODE button (1) for over three
seconds. The hour segments (2) will start to flash.
4
NOTE Press and release the SET button (3) alternately
to change hours in one-unit increments. Hold down the
SET button (3) to cycle through hours quickly.
Š Press the SET button (3) and set hours. 3
Š Press and release the MODE button (1) to confirm. The
minute segments (4) will start to flash.
Š Press the SET button (3) and set minutes.
Š Press and release the MODE button (1) to confirm. 1
NOTE The clock will reset automatically whenever the
battery is removed from the vehicle.

2.3.8 INSTRUMENT AND INDICATOR CHART

Description Function

Direction indicator LED light Flashes when a direction indicator is operated.

Comes on when headlamp high beam is turned on or when the high beam
High beam LED light flasher is operated.
Gives engine speed in rpm.
Rev. meter (rpm) Never exceed maximum engine rpm.
WARNING
Comes on when fuel level in the tank drops to 4 ± 1 l.
Fuel reserve LED light
Refuel as soon as possible when this light comes on.

Side stand LED light Comes on when the side stand is down.

Comes on whenever the ignition switch is set to “ ” and the engine is


stopped to test LED operation.
Oil pressure LED light If the oil pressure LED “ ” stays on
WARNING after engine has been started up, or
comes on while the engine is running, it means that pressure in the
engine oil circuit is too low.
Neutral LED N light Comes on when gearbox is in neutral.
Comes on and stays on for about three seconds whenever the ignition
switch is set to " ” to test LED operation.
The diagnostics LED “EFI” will flash to
WARNING indicate that the on-board computer has
Diagnostics LED light EFI detected some failure event. This may occur while the engine is
running or as soon as the ignition switch is operated. Normally, the
engine will keep running though performance may be somewhat
impaired. The wording “EFI” only lights up on the multifunction
digital display during service inspections by Aprilia Franchised
Dealers.
Speedometer (kph) Gives road speed.
CONTINUED ➤

2 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

Description Function
Digital
Odometer/trip meter Gives motorcycle's total mileage (in kilometres or miles)
display (left-
(km - mi) or distance covered since last resetting.
hand side)
Gives fuel level in the tank.
The display provides both an analogue (scale) and
numeric (litres or gallons) indication of fuel quantity.
When the tank is full, the total length of the scale is
highlighted and a letter "F" appears instead of figures.
As fuel level drops, an increasing portion of the scale will
go out and the figures (litres or gallons) will decrement. see 2.3.2
(PROGRAM-
Multifunction When all segments of the scale are off, flashing “--”
MING BUT-
digital characters are displayed instead of fuel quantity and the
TONS) for
display Fuel level indication low fuel LED will start to flash. This means that fuel level
instructions on
(right-hand has dropped below 4 ± 1 l.
Refuel as soon as possible. how to toggle
side)
When all segments of the between
WARNING indications.
scale are off, flashing
figures “8.8” appear instead of fuel quantity and the
low fuel LED starts to flash.
NOTE The digital sector can be toggled to air
temperature indication (T°AIR). The analogue scale is
turned off when air temperature is selected.
When temperature is 3 °C (37.4
CAUTION °F) or less, the digital display
indication will start to flash to warn against possible
black ice. When this is the case, drive at moderate
speed, apply the brakes gently and avoid any see 2.3.2
manoeuvres which may put the motorcycle into a skid. (PROGRAM-
Multifunction When temperature drops to or below 3 °C (37.4 °F), the MING BUT-
digital display Air temperature display will automatically switch to air temperature if TONS) for
(right-hand indication T°AIR currently set to fuel level indication. Air temperature instructions on
side) indication will flash for ten seconds (even if temperature how to toggle
has risen back above 3 °C (37.4 °F) in the meantime). between
If temperature stays below 3 °C (37.4 °F), automatic indications.
temperature indication will be repeated for three times at
five minutes' intervals.
NOTE After each flashing sequence, the display will
revert to current selection (fuel level or air temperature).
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 11 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Description Function
Shows engine coolant temperature, see 2.3.2
(PROGRAMMING BUTTONS).
The display provides both an analogue (scale) and
numeric (°C/°F) temperature indication.
Characters “---” are displayed until coolant heats up to 35
°C (97 °F).
The cooling fans operate
WARNING independently of the ignition
switch. Whether the engine is running or not, the
cooling fans will switch on and off automatically
whenever needed.
Exceeding the maximum temperature allowed (125 °C
Coolant temperature
or 257 °F) may lead to severe engine damage. see 2.3.2
indication (°C / °F)
If displayed temperature is 116 - 125 °C (241 - 257 °F) and (PROGRAM-
Multifunction the second last segment of the indicator scale is flashing, MING BUT-
digital display stop the engine. Wait for the cooling fans to switch off and TONS) for
(right-hand check coolant level, see 2.15 (COOLANT CHANGE). instructions on
side) When temperature reading is 126 - 135 °C (259 - 275 °F) how to toggle
and the last two segments of the indicator scale are between
flashing, stop the motorcycle and let the engine idle for a indications.
couple of minutes. This will allow coolant to circulate
throughout the cooling system. Set the engine kill switch to
“ ” and check coolant level, see 2.15 (COOLANT
CHANGE). Do not ride if coolant temperature indication
has not gone back to normal after checking level.
A wording "SERVICE" is displayed after the first 1000 km
(625 mi) and then every 7500 km (4600 ml).
“SERVICE” prompt Perform maintenance as specified in the periodic
maintenance chart, see 2.1.1 (PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
CHART).
Displays time in hours and minutes as pre-set, see 2.3.2
Clock
(PROGRAMMING BUTTONS).

2 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.4 BATTERY
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully .
There are two types of batteries available in the market:
- batteries that require maintenance, fitted with cell
plugs;
- maintenance-free batteries, which have no cell plugs
as they do not need inspecting or topping-up.
NOTE This motorcycle is fitted with a maintenance-free
battery which seldom needs inspecting and may need
charging from time to time.
If necessary, replace with a battery of the same type.
See 6.14 (BATTERY) for more details.

WARNING
Be sure to connect each battery lead to the matching
terminal.
Set the ignition switch to " " before connecting or
disconnecting the battery.
Connect the positive (+) lead first, and then the
negative (-) lead.
Disconnect in the reverse order.
NOTE Check battery voltage using a hand-held tester.
The battery needs charging when voltage is less than
12V.
When voltage drops below 8V, the on-board computer
will not work and will inhibit engine operation.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 13 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.4.1 CLEANING AND CHECKING BATTERY


TERMINALS AND LEAD CONNECTIONS 3
Read 2.4 (BATTERY) carefully.
Š Ensure the ignition switch is in the " " position.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Slide the red protective cap (1) aside.
Š Check that battery lead connections (2) and battery
terminals (3) are: 2
- in good condition (free from corrosion or any deposits);
- coated with neutral grease or vaseline.
If needed:
Š Disconnect the negative (-) and positive (+) leads in the
order. 2 1
Š Clean off corrosion deposits using a wire brush.
Š Reconnect the positive (+) and negative (-) leads in the
order.
Š Coat battery lead connections and terminals with
neutral grease or vaseline.
Š Refit the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).

2 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.4.2 CHARGING THE BATTERY 2.5 ELECTRIC COMPONENTS


Read 2.4 (BATTERY) carefully. Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
NOTE You can tell that the battery is nearly flat when
you hear a rattling sound from the starter relay when Inspect after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every 7500
pressing the starter button . km (4687 mi) or 8 months afterwards.
Do not remove the battery plugs or the battery may Š Put the motorcycle on the stand.
damage. Š Check all lights for proper operation.
Š Remove the battery, see 7.1.9 (BATTERY REMOVAL). Š Check for proper beam setting, see 6.17 (BEAM
Š Be sure to have a suitable battery charger ready at HEIGHT SETTING) and 6.18 (BEAM CENTRING).
hand. Š Ensure all connectors are fitted securely in place.
Š Set the battery charger to the desired charge rate (see Š Ensure switches are properly fastened and check for
chart below). proper operation:
Š Connect the battery to the battery charger. - see 6.8.5 (SIDE STAND SWITCH TEST);
- see 6.8.7 (TESTING THE SAFETY LOCKOUT
CAUTION SYSTEM SWITCHES)).
Charge or use the battery in a well-ventilated place. Š Ensure the air and speedometer sensors are properly
Do not inhale the gases produced by the battery fastened and check for proper operation.
under charging.
WARNING
Š Switch on the battery charger. The sensing area of the sensors must be kept clean.
Any mud, dirt deposits, etc. will lead to misreading.
Charge rate Amperes Time (hrs)
Regular 1.2 8 - 10
Fast 12 0.5

CAUTION
The battery keeps producing gases for some time
after the battery charger has been switched off. Allow
5-10 minutes before proceeding to refit the battery.

2.4.3 LONG INACTIVITY


Read 2.4 (BATTERY) carefully.

WARNING
When the motorcycle is to be left unused for over
twenty days, disconnect the 30-Amp fuses, otherwise
the multifunction computer will keep drawing current
and the battery will deteriorate.
Disconnecting the 30-Amp fuses will reset the digital
clock and red line setting.
See 2.3 (MULTIFUNCTION COMPUTER) for
instructions on how to set these functions again.
When the vehicle is left unused for over a fortnight,
charge the battery to avoid sulphation, see 2.4.2
(CHARGING THE BATTERY).
Š Remove the battery, see 7.1.9 (BATTERY REMOVAL)
and store it in a cool, dry place.
To avoid degradation in the wintertime or while the
motorcycle is stored away, check battery charge at
regular intervals (monthly).
Š Charge the battery fully at normal charge rate,
see 2.4.2 (CHARGING THE BATTERY).
NOTE If you are leaving the battery fitted in the
motorcycle, disconnect the leads from the terminals.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 15 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.6 JUMP-STARTING
Read 2.4 (BATTERY) carefully.

CAUTION
Jump-starting should be the last resort when the
battery is low or dead and cannot be recharged.
Do not attempt to start the engine by pushing or
towing the motorcycle.
The battery of the vehicle that is providing the jump-
start must have the same rating as the dead vehicle
battery (12V - 12 A, see rating data on battery).
Observe the instructions provided below closely or
the battery may explode, causing personal injury or
damage to property (the electric components of both
vehicles might damage).
Š Ensure that the ignition switch is set to " ". 1
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
NOTE Do not disconnect the battery leads of the
vehicle that is being jump-started.

WARNING
Never touch the connectors of the different leads or
cables together.
A
Š Slide the red protective cap (1) aside.
Š Attach one jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of
the battery in the starting vehicle (A). Attach the other
end of the jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of B
the dead vehicle battery (B).
Š Attach the other jumper cable to the negative (-)
terminal of the battery in the starting vehicle (A). Attach
the other end of the jumper cable to the frame of the
vehicle that is being jump-started (B) to provide a
ground connection. Select a location well away from
the battery.
DO NOT CONNECT ANY CABLES TO THE NEGATIVE
(-) TERMINAL.

CAUTION
Route the jumper cables well away from any moving
parts of either vehicles.
NOTE It is not necessary to stop the engine of the
starting vehicle during the jump-starting procedure.
Š Jump-start the dead vehicle.
NOTE If the engine of the dead vehicle does not start
right away, stop trying after 10 seconds and wait about
one minute before trying again.
When the engine starts, keep both vehicles' engines
running for about two minutes.
Š Stop both engines and disconnect the jumper cables in
reverse order.

2 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.7 SPARK PLUGS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check the spark plugs every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8
months. Change them every 15000 Km (9375 mi) or 16
months. 1
At regular intervals, remove the spark plugs and clean off
any carbon deposits or replace them as required.
If the motorcycle is used in competition trials, change
spark plugs every 7500 Km (4687 mi).
2
In order to gain access to the spark plugs:

CAUTION
Allow the engine to cool down completely before
proceeding.
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
NOTE The motorcycle is fitted with two spark plugs per
cylinder.
The procedure outlined below applies to all spark plugs.
Removal and cleaning.

CAUTION
Never remove a spark plug cap while the engine is
running. Shock hazard: the ignition system produces
high voltages.
Š Pull the spark plug cap (1) off the spark plug (2).
Š Remove any traces of dirt from the spark plug base.
Š Fit the suitable spark plug tool (supplied with the tool
kit) to the spark plug.
Š Fit the 13-mm fork key (supplied with the tool kit) to the
hexagon of the spark plug tool.
Š Unscrew and extract the spark plug. Ensure that no
dust or foreign matter fall into the cylinder. 3
WARNING
This motorcycle uses spark plugs with platinum
electrodes.
Do not clean with wire brushes and/or abrasive
compounds. Clean with compressed air only.
- central electrode (3);
- insulator (4); 5
- side electrode (5).
4
Š Check electrodes and insulating material for carbon
deposits or corrosion. Blow with an air line if needed.
A spark plug must be changed when: the insulator is
cracked; the electrodes show traces of corrosion or
exceeding deposits; the tip of the central electrode (3) is
3
worn away and has achieved a radiused contour (see
diagram).
Replace with recommended spark plugs only.
Recommended spark plugs:
NGK R DCPR9E

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 17 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

WARNING
Ensure that the replacement spark plug is the
suitable length and thread.
A short thread will cause carbon to build up on the
thread in the head. When you fit a proper spark plug
at a later time, the engine will damage.
Use recommended spark plugs only. A spark plug of
the wrong grade may shorten engine life and cause
loss of performance.
Use a wire feeler gauge (see diagram) to check air
gap between electrodes. Any other tool will damage
the platinum coating of the electrodes.
Š Check the electrode gap with a wire feeler gauge.
Electrode gap should be 0.6 – 0.7 mm. If it needs
adjusting, bend the earth electrode carefully.
Š Make sure the washer is in good condition. Fit the
washer and screw the spark plug finger-tight to avoid
damaging the thread.
Š Tighten using the supplied tool. Screw in each spark
plug by one half turn to compress the washer.

1
Torque wrench setting for spark plugs: 20 Nm
(2.0 kgm).

WARNING
It is essential to tighten the spark plugs properly. A 2
loose spark plug will cause engine overheating and
result in severe damage.
NOTE When reassembling, take care to route the leads
of the rear cylinder spark plugs inboard of oil breather
hose.
Š Refitthe spark plug cap (1) securely onto the spark
plug (2), so that it will not work itself loose when
exposed to engine vibration.

CAUTION
Ensure the spark plug cap (1) is properly in place on
the spark plug (2).
Š Lower the fuel tank.

2 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.8 LIFTING THE FUEL TANK


4
Read 1.2.1 (FUEL) carefully.

1 3
CAUTION
Fire hazard.
Allow the engine and exhaust silencer to cool down
completely.
Š Release and remove both screws (1).
2
1
Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 3 Nm 3
(0.3 kgm)
Š Remove the guard (2).
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the two front retaining screws (3)
of the fuel tank (4). Collect the bushes and washers.

5
Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 8 Nm
(0.8 kgm)
Š Release the service rod (5) of the fuel tank from its 4
retainers on the underside of the seat.
NOTE Fit the rubber-coated end of the service rod (5)
into the centre hole in the steering stem.
Š Pull the front end of the fuel tank (4) upwards to lift and
insert the service rod (5) as shown in the figure.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 19 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.9 DRAINING THE FUEL TANK


Read 1.2.1 (FUEL) carefully.

CAUTION
Fire hazard.
Allow the engine and exhaust silencers to cool down
completely. 1
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure that the area is properly ventilated before 2
proceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Do not smoke or use bare flames.
Do not release fuel into the environment.
Š Stop the engine and allow it to cool down.
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
Š Prepare a container of more than adequate capacity to
contain the amount of fuel in the tank. Place the
container on the floor on the left-hand side of the
motorcycle.
NOTE Place a cloth underneath the male quick-
disconnect fitting (1) to collect any fuel spillage.
Š Press the release button to disconnect male fitting (1)
from the female fitting (2).
NOTE Before proceeding, be sure to have a hose
equipped with a male quick-disconnect fitting ready at
hand.
Š Place the free end of the hose into the container you
have prepared previously.
Š Fit the male quick-disconnect fitting to the female
quick-disconnect fitting (2). The fuel will start to flow out
right away.
Š Open the filler cap.
Š Wait until all fuel has drained out of the fuel tank.
Once the fuel tank is empty:
Š Disconnect the hose male fitting from the female fitting
(2) by pressing the release button.
Š Fit the male quick-disconnect fitting (1) of the vehicle to
the female fitting (2).
NOTE Check that the male quick-disconnect fitting (1)
is securely in place on the female fitting (2).
Š Lower the fuel tank.
Š Refit the filler cap.

2 - 20 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.10 AIR CLEANER


1 1
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION)carefully.
Check the air cleaner every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months.
Change it every 15000 km (9375 mi) or 16 months or more 2
frequently when you ride on dusty or wet roads.
In this case, clean the air cleaner after each ride following
the procedure described below.

WARNING 1
Cleaning the filter does not eliminate the need to
change the filter at the specified intervals. Do not
start the engine when the air cleaner is not in place.
Do not clean the filter element with petrol or solvents.
These products may cause the fuel to ignite in the
fuel system, leading to personal injury and vehicle
damage.
REMOVAL 5
Š Lift the fuel tank, Read 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK)
Š Release and remove the seven retaining screws (1) of
the air box cover (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 2 Nm


(0.2 kgm)
Š Take off the air box cover (2).
Š Extract the air cleaner (3). 3
WARNING
Clean the air cleaner housing thoroughly, taking care
to remove any foreign matter. Block off the intake
funnels of the throttle body and the air cleaner
housing with clean cloths to prevent the ingress of
dirt.
Š Inspect the seal (5) and change it if damaged.
CLEANING THE FILTER ELEMENT

WARNING
Do not press or hit the air cleaner meshing (3).
Do not use a screwdriver or any other tools on the air
cleaner.
Š Hold the air cleaner (3) in a vertical position and tap it
repeatedly on a clean bench.
Š If needed, blow the air cleaner (3) with an air line. Aim 4
the gun from the inside of the meshing outwards.
Š Clean the outer surface of the meshing (3) with a clean
cloth.
REPLACEMENT
Š Replace the air cleaner (3) with a new air cleaner of the
same type.
Š Every 7500 km (4687 mi), remove the plug (4) and let
any dirt trapped inside the airbox drain out.

WARNING
When cleaning the air cleaner, ensure the meshing is
not torn. Always change a damaged air cleaner. Make
sure the air cleaner is properly in place or it will let
unfiltered air into the system. Note that early wear of
piston rings and cylinder is frequently due to a
defective or badly positioned air cleaner. Clean the
air cleaner more frequently when you ride on dusty
roads. Using the motorcycle without an air cleaner or
with a damaged air cleaner notably increases engine
wear. Ensure the air cleaner is in perfect condition at
all times; engine life largely depends on this
component.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 21 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.11 THROTTLE
Inspect after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every 7500
km (4687 mi) or 8 months afterwards.

2.11.1 CHECKING FOR THROTTLE PROPER


OPERATION

CAUTION 1
Throttle operation may be impaired when the throttle
cables are damaged, bent in tight turns or twisted.
Using the motorcycle in this condition may lead to
loss of control while riding.
Turn the handlebars and ensure that idling speed is
unaffected by handlebar movement. Open the throttle
and ensure that the twistgrip snaps closed smoothly
when released.
If needed: 5
2
Š Make sure the components listed below are in the
proper position and well lubricated:
- cable housing;
- twistgrip adjuster (1);
- throttle body adjusters (2); 2
- throttle body axle (3);
- cable end-caps;
- throttle control. 3
Š Check idling speed (rpm), see 2.11.2 (IDLING
ADJUSTMENT).
Š Check Throttle cable play adjustment, see 2.11.3
(THROTTLE CABLE PLAY ADJUSTMENT).

2.11.2 IDLING ADJUSTMENT


Manual adjustment for idling speed is not provided.
Idling is adjusted automatically through a stepper motor
(1) that operates a small piston inside an air passage.
The position of the piston inside the air passage is
determined by the on-board computer according to three 1
parameters:
- throttle position;
- engine rpm;
- coolant temperature.

2 - 22 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.11.3 THROTTLE CABLE PLAY ADJUSTMENT


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Inspect after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every 7500
km (4687 mi) afterwards.
Periodically inspect the throttle cables.
There should be 2–3 mm free play in the throttle twistgrip
cable (measured at twistgrip edge).
If not so:
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand. 1
Š Take off the rubber gaiter (1).
Š Loosen the locknut (2).
Š Rotate the adjuster (3) until setting the specified free
play.
Š After adjusting, tighten the locknut (2) and check free
play again.
Š Refit the rubber gaiter (1).
WARNING
Turn the handlebars and ensure that idling speed is
unaffected by handlebar movement. Open the throttle
and ensure that the twistgrip springs back to the
closed position smoothly when released. 2

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 23 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.12 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP ENGINE


OIL LEVEL
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.2 (ENGINE OIL) carefully.
Check engine oil level at regular intervals. Change oil
after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every 7500 km (4687
mi) or 8 months afterwards, see 2.13 (ENGINE OIL AND
FILTER CHANGE).
Check oil level as follows:
NOTE Place the motorcycle on firm and level ground
and put it on the centre stand.

WARNING
Check engine oil level when the engine is hot.
Oil level is lower in a cold engine than in operation
and may temporarily drop below "MIN".
This is acceptable, unless the oil pressure LED
" " is on. 1
Š Start the engine.
Š Let the engine idle for 15-20 minutes or ride outside
town covering about 15 km (9.5 mi).
Š Stop the engine.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Keep the motorcycle upright with both wheels on the
ground.
Š Look through the slot in the left-hand fairing to check oil
level in the oil sight glass (1).
MAX = maximum level;
MIN = minimum level.
Š The difference between the "MIN" and "MAX" levels is
about 500 cu cm. 3
Š Correct level is just below the "MAX" mark.
WARNING
Do not overfill (beyond the "MAX" mark) or let level 2
drop below the "MIN" mark, as this will cause severe 4
engine damage.
Do not add any additives or other products.
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure that it
is perfectly clean.
If needed, top up oil level as follows:
Š Release and remove the screw (2).
Š Take off the guard (3).
Š Release and remove the filler cap (4).
Š Adjust to correct level, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
WARNING
Do not add any additives or other products.
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure that it
is perfectly clean.

2 - 24 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.13 ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.2 (ENGINE OIL) carefully.
Check engine oil level at regular intervals. Change oil
after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every 7500 km (4687
mi) or 8 months afterwards, see 2.13 (ENGINE OIL AND
FILTER CHANGE).

WARNING
Oil should be changed more frequently when riding
in dusty conditions.
On motorcycles used for competition trials, change
oil every 3750 km (2343 mi).

OIL AND FILTER CHANGE


NOTE Oil flows more easily when warm. Let the engine
warm up for about twenty minutes to facilitate total 3
drainage.

CAUTION
In order to avoid burns, allow the engine and silencer
to cool down completely before proceeding to
2
change oil and filter.
NOTE Place the motorcycle on firm and level ground
and put it on the centre stand. 1
Š Remove the left-hand side fairing, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Remove the left-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Place a container (1) under the drain plug (2) located
on the tank (3). Container capacity should be greater
than 4000 cu cm.
Š Undo and remove the drain plug (2) located on the tank 4
(3).
Š Undo and remove the filler cap (4).
Š Drain the oil into the container (1). Let the last of the oil
drip out for several minutes.
Š Inspect the sealing washer of the drain plug (2) located
on the tank (3) and replace it if needed.
Š Refit and tighten the drain plug (2).

Torque wrench setting for drain plug (2): 15 Nm


(1.5 kgm).
Š Place the container (1) under the crankcase, under the
engine drain plug (5).
Š Undo and remove the engine drain plug (5).
Š Drain the oil into the container (1). Let the last of the oil
drip out for several minutes.

WARNING
Do not release oil into the environment.
Dispose of oil through a waste oil reclamation firm.
Š Clean off any metal debris sticking to the drain plug (5)
magnet. Refit and tighten the plug.
5 1

Torque wrench setting for drain plug (5): 12 Nm


(1.2 kgm).
Š Clean all parts contaminated with oil using a cloth.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 25 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

ENGINE OIL FILTER CHANGE


Change the engine oil filter after the first 1000 km (625
mi) and every 7500 km (4687 mi) afterwards (or at each
oil change).
Š Release the two screws (6) and remove the guard (7). 9
Š Remove the engine oil filter (8).
7
WARNING
Never reuse an oil filter. 8
Š Spread a film of oil on the seal (9) of the new engine oil
filter.
Š Insert the new oil filter. 6
Š Refit the guard (7). Refit and tighten the two screws (6).
CLEANING THE ENGINE OIL FILTER LOCATED ON
THE TANK
Clean the engine oil filter (10) located on the tank every
15000 km (9375 mi) (or every two oil changes).
NOTE Make sure you have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. Change all clips when
reassembling (use clips of the same type as the original).
Š Slacken the clip (12) and disconnect the hose (13). 12
Š Release and remove the engine oil filter (10) located on 13
the tank and clean with an air line.
NOTE You will need to remove the engine oil tank (3) 10
fixings before you can extract the engine oil filter.
Š Release and remove the two screws (14).
Š Ease the engine oil tank (3) outwards.
Š Extract the engine oil filter (10) and clean with an air
line.

WARNING
When reassembling, ensure the fitting (15) of the oil 4
filter (10) is pointing outwards. The hose (13) must
not touch the expansion reservoir. 11
Š Inspect the seal of the engine oil filter (10) located on 3
the tank. Screw in the oil filter and tighten.

Torque wrench setting for engine oil filter (10)


located on the tank: 30 Nm (3.0 kgm).
Š Tighten the two screws (14). 14
Š Connect the hose (13). Fit a new clip and tighten. 14
WARNING
Do not add any additives or other products.
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure that it
is perfectly clean.
Š Pour about 3500 cu cm of engine oil through the filler
opening (11), see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
Š Refit and tighten the filler cap (4).
Š Start the engine and keep it idling for about one minute
to let oil fill all points of the circuit.
Š Check oil level and top up if needed, see 2.12
13
(CHECKING AND TOPPING UP ENGINE OIL LEVEL).
15

10

2 - 26 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.14 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP COOLANT


LEVEL
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT)carefully.
Check coolant level before each ride. Change coolant
every 2 years.

WARNING
Check and top up coolant level when the engine is
cold. 1
Š The engine should be off and completely cold.
NOTE Place the motorcycle on firm and level ground
and put it on the centre stand.
Š Keep the motorcycle upright with both wheels on the
ground.
Š Look through the slot in the right-hand fairing to ensure 4
that coolant level in the expansion reservoir (1) is
between the "FULL" and "LOW" marks.
FULL = maximum level
LOW = minimum level
2 1
If not so:
Š Release and remove the screw (2). 3
Š Remove the guard (3).
Š Release and remove the filler cap (4).
CAUTION
Coolant is toxic when ingested; contact with eyes or
skin may cause irritation.
Do not put your fingers or any tools into the filler
opening to check coolant level.

WARNING
Do not add any additives or other products.
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure that it
is perfectly clean.
Š Add coolant mixture until bringing level just below the
"FULL" mark. see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART) for
coolant specifications.
Š Never overfill (top up beyond the "Full" mark), or
coolant will leak out when the engine is running.
Š Refit the filler cap (4).
WARNING
In the event the motorcycle is using up exceeding
coolant or the expansion reservoir (1) is empty,
check the circuit for leaks.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 27 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.15 COOLANT CHANGE


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION), 1.2.4 (COOLANT) and Sect. 5
(COOLING SYSTEM) carefully.
Change coolant every 2 years.
Š Remove the right-hand air scoop, see 7.1.31
(REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND AIR SCOOP).
Š Remove the lower fairing, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Remove the front splashguard, see 7.1.32 2
(REMOVING THE FRONT BOTTOM PANEL). 1
Š Remove the expansion reservoir, see 5.8 (REMOVING
THE EXPANSION RESERVOIR).
Š Place a container (2) with capacity greater than 2.5 l
under the drain plug (1) of the right-hand radiator to
collect the coolant.
Š Release and remove the drain plug (1). Collect the
aluminium washer.

WARNING 3
The coolant in the circuit is under pressure when hot.
Do not remove the filler cap (3) while the engine is
hot.
Š Remove the filler cap (3) to facilitate drainage. 4
Š When all coolant has drained out, proceed to drain the
left-hand radiator.
DO NOT RELEASE COOLANT INTO THE ENVIRONMENT.
NOTE When refitting, smear some LOCTITE® 572 on
the threads of the drain plugs of both radiators.

ŠRefit the drain plug (1) and renew the aluminium


washer.

Torque wrench setting for drain plug (1): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
Š Refit the expansion reservoir.
Š Fill up with coolant mixture through the filler opening
(4).
Š Squeeze and release the couplings (5-6) repeatedly 5
with your hands. This will create a small amount of
pressure to help push coolant into the ducts.
Š Top up again until filling up.
NOTE Correct level is achieved when coolant has
settled just below the filler opening (4).
Š Refit the filler cap (3).
Š Top up coolant level in the expansion reservoir,
see 2.14 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP COOLANT
LEVEL). 6
Š Start the engine and keep it running until the cooling
fans switch on. Allow engine to cool down and check
coolant level in the expansion reservoir again.
Š Top up if needed, see 2.14 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP COOLANT LEVEL).
Total quantity:
2.5 litres (including expansion reservoir).
NOTE The cooling system of this motorcycle requires
no bleeding.

2 - 28 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.16 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP FRONT


BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) carefully.
Check brake fluid every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months,
change it every two years.

WARNING
Bleed the circuit when the brake lever has exceeding
travel or feels soft or whenever you suspect that
there might be air trapped in the circuit; see 2.19
(BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS).
Plastic or paint-finished parts will damage if brake
fluid is spilt on them.
Before each ride, ensure that the brake lines are not
twisted or cracked and check the fittings for leaks.
Never top up with or mix different types of silicone or
petroleum-based fluids.
Never use brake fluid from containers which have
been open or kept in storage for long periods.
Take care to avoid accidental ingress of water or dust
into the circuit.
INSPECTION
NOTE Place the motorcycle on firm and level ground
and put it on the centre stand.
Š Rotate the handlebars to right full lock.
Š Check that fluid level in the reservoir is above the
"MIN" mark.
MIN = minimum level.
MAX = maximum level.
Š Top up when level is below the "MIN" mark.
TOP-UP

WARNING
Danger: brake fluid could leak out.
Never operate the front brake lever when the screw
(1) has been loosened or when the reservoir cover is
not in place.
Š Release the screw (1) of the brake fluid reservoir (3)
using a short Phillips screwdriver.

WARNING
Do not loosen the screw (2) when the handlebar is
rotated to the right or brake fluid will leak out.
Š Rotate the handlebar to left full lock.
Š Unscrew the screw (2). 2
WARNING
Avoid long exposure of brake fluid to air. 3
Brake fluid is hygroscopic and will absorb moisture
from the air. 1
Keep the brake fluid reservoir open JUST LONG MIN
ENOUGH to top up level.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 29 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Š Lift and remove the cover (4) with the screws (1-2) in
place. 4
Š Collect the guide cover (5).
Š Remove the seal (6).
NOTE Do not rock the motorcycle from side to side
when topping up or brake fluid will spill out. 2 1

WARNING
Do not add any additives or other products. 6
5
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure it is
perfectly clean.
7
NOTE The “MAX" level is achieved when the sight 3
glass (7) is full. Note that actual level is indicated when
the brake fluid reservoir is level (parallel to the ground).
Š Top up the reservoir (3) with brake fluid, see 1.6
(LUBRICANT CHART) until bringing level between the
"MIN" and "MAX" marks.

WARNING
Do not overfill (top up beyond the "MAX" level).
Brake fluid level decreases gradually as brake pads
wear down. To achieve the correct level, always
renew the brake pads before topping up to "MAX"
level.
Š Reverse the disassembly procedure to reassemble.

2.17 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP REAR


BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) carefully.
Check brake fluid every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months,
change it every two years.

WARNING
Bleed the circuit when the brake lever has exceeding
travel or feels spongy or whenever you suspect that
there might be air trapped in the circuit; see 2.19
(BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS).
Plastic or paint-finished parts will damage if brake
fluid is spilt on them.
Before each ride, ensure that the brake lines are not
twisted or cracked and check the fittings for leaks.
Never top up with or mix different types of silicone or
petroleum-based fluids.
Never use brake fluid from containers which have
been open or kept in storage for long periods.
Take care to avoid accidental ingress of water or dust
into the circuit.

2 - 30 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

INSPECTION
NOTE Place the motorcycle on firm and level ground 3
and put it on the centre stand.
Š Check that fluid level in the reservoir is above the
"MIN" mark.
MAX
MIN = minimum level.
MAX = maximum level.
MIN
Š Top up when level is below the "MIN" mark.
TOP-UP

WARNING
Danger: brake fluid could leak out.
Never operate the rear brake lever when the brake
fluid reservoir cap has been loosened or is not in
place.

CAUTION 1 1
Avoid long exposure of brake fluid to air.
Brake fluid is hygroscopic and will absorb moisture
from the air. 4
Keep the brake fluid reservoir open JUST LONG
ENOUGH to top up level.
Š Release the two screws (1) of the brake fluid reservoir
(2) using a short Phillips screwdriver.
Š Lift and remove the cover (3) complete with screws (1)
and seal (4). 2
NOTE Ensure that the fluid level is parallel with
reservoir edge (in a horizontal position) to avoid spillage.

WARNING
Do not add any additives or other products.
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure it is
perfectly clean.
Š Top up the reservoir (1) with brake fluid, see 1.6
(LUBRICANT CHART) until bringing level between the
"MIN" and "MAX" marks.

WARNING
Do not overfill (top up beyond the "MAX" level).
Brake fluid level decreases gradually as brake pads
wear down. To achieve the correct level, always
renew the brake pads before topping up to "MAX"
level.
Š Reverse the disassembly procedure to reassemble.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 31 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.18 CHECKING AND TOPPING UP CLUTCH


FLUID LEVEL
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and see 1.2.5 (CLUTCH FLUID)
carefully.
Check clutch fluid every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months;
change it every two years.
MAX
MIN
WARNING
Bleed the circuit when the clutch lever has exceeding
travel or feels soft or whenever you suspect that
there might be air trapped in the circuit; see 2.20
(BLEEDING THE CLUTCH).
Plastic or paint-finished parts will damage if clutch
fluid is spilt on them.
Before each ride, ensure that the clutch lines are not
twisted or cracked and check the fittings for leaks.
Never top up with or mix different types of silicone or
petroleum-based fluids.
Never use clutch fluid from containers which have
been kept open or in storage for long periods.
Take care to avoid accidental ingress of water or dust
into the circuit.
INSPECTION
NOTE Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Rotate the handlebars to left full lock.
Š Check that fluid level in the reservoir is above the
"MIN" mark.
MIN = minimum level.
MAX = maximum level.
Š Top up when level is below the "MIN" mark.

2 - 32 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

TOP-UP

WARNING
3
Danger: clutch fluid could leak out. 2
1
Never operate the clutch lever when the clutch fluid
reservoir cap has been loosened or is not in place.

CAUTION
Avoid long exposure of clutch fluid to air. 5
Clutch fluid is hygroscopic and will absorb moisture 4
from the air.
Keep the clutch fluid reservoir open JUST LONG
ENOUGH to top up level.

WARNING
Place a cloth under the clutch fluid reservoir to
collect any spillage
Š Rotate the handlebar to left full lock.
Š Release the screw (1) using a short Phillips
screwdriver.

WARNING
Do not loosen the screw (2) when the handlebar is
rotated to the left or clutch fluid will leak out.
Š Rotate the handlebar to right full lock.
Š Unscrew the screw (2).
WARNING
Do not rock the motorcycle from side to side when
topping up or clutch fluid will spill out.
Do not add any additives or other products.
If you are using a funnel or other tool, ensure it is
perfectly clean.
Š Lift and remove the cover (3) complete with screws (1-
2).
Š Remove the seal (4)
Š Top up the reservoir(5) with clutch fluid, see 1.6
(LUBRICANT CHART) until bringing level between the
"MIN" and "MAX" marks.
Do not overfill (top up beyond the "MAX" level).
Š Reverse the disassembly procedure to reassemble.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 33 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.19 BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID).
1
See 2.1.1 (PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART) for
service intervals.
Any air trapped in the hydraulic circuit will act as a
cushion and take up most of the pressure applied by the
master cylinder. This will hamper the operation of the
brake calipers and reduce braking efficiency.
A spongy feel of the brake lever and loss of braking mean
that there is air in the circuit.

CAUTION
This is a dangerous condition that makes the vehicle
unsafe to ride. Each time the brakes are removed, it
is indispensable to bleed the hydraulic circuit once
the brakes have been refitted and the braking system
is back to normal operating conditions.
Brake fluid is an irritant. Avoid contact with eyes or
skin. 1
In the event of accidental contact, wash the affected
area thoroughly. In the event of contact with eyes,
contact an eye specialist or seek medical advice.
DO NOT RELEASE BRAKE FLUID INTO THE
ENVIRONMENT.
KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN.

WARNING
Handle with care: contact with brake fluid will alter
the chemical properties of paintwork, plastic and
rubber parts, etc.
Wear latex gloves during servicing.
Do not spill brake fluid on plastic or paint-finished
parts or they will damage. 2

NOTE This motorcycle is fitted with two (front and rear)


braking systems operated by two independent hydraulic
circuits.
The front twin-disc brake is fitted with one disc on either
side of the wheel.
The rear single-disc brake is fitted with one disc on the
right-hand side of the wheel.
FRONT BRAKING SYSTEM
The front braking system is fitted with two bleed nipples
(1), one for each of the front brake calipers.
Repeat the BLEEDING PROCESS for each bleed nipple
(1).
REAR BRAKING SYSTEM
The rear braking system is fitted with one bleed nipple (2)
located on the rear brake caliper.

2 - 34 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

HOW TO BLEED THE BRAKING SYSTEM


A
There are three bleeding procedures to be performed
strictly in the order given:

1st – BLEED THE HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT D


NOTE Read the description of the hydraulic circuit
bleeding procedure for instructions on how to determine
whether the brake caliper and the master cylinder need
bleeding, too.

2nd – BLEED THE BRAKE CALIPER


3rd – BLEED THE MASTER CYLINDER.

WARNING C C
The three bleeding procedures must always be
performed in the specified order.
REQUIREMENTS
Before proceeding, ensure the following requirements are
met:
NOTE Place the motorcycle on firm and level ground
and put it on the centre stand. B
A the master cylinder is above the oil tube (meaning the
total length of the hose) and the brake caliper (C);
B the brake fluid reservoir is above the master cylinder
(A); C
C the caliper bleed nipple (1-2) is on top of the caliper;
A
D the oil tube is routed smoothly with no upside-down U-
turns.
NOTE In order to bleed the rear braking system, you
will first have to remove the rear brake caliper. See 7.6.2
(REAR BRAKE CALIPER REMOVAL).
Š Top up brake fluid level in the reservoir, see 2.16
(CHECKING AND TOPPING UP FRONT BRAKE
FLUID LEVEL) and see 2.17 (CHECKING AND 1
TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID LEVEL). 1
Š Remove the rubber cap.
Š Attach a clear plastic hose to the caliper bleed nipples
(1-2). Insert the other end of the hose into a container.
Š Pump the brake lever quickly. Repeat several times,
then keep the lever pulled in.
Š Slacken the bleed nipple by one quarter of a turn to let
the brake fluid drain into the container. This will remove
any tension from the lever and help it travel fully home.
Š Tighten the bleed nipple. Pump the lever repeatedly,
then hold in the lever and slacken the bleed nipple
C C
again.
Š Repeat process until the fluid draining into the
container is totally clear of air bubbles.
NOTE During the bleeding procedure, top up reservoir
with brake fluid up to Max level if needed. The reservoir
should not be empty during the bleeding procedure or air
will enter the system.
1
Š Tighten the bleed nipple and disconnect the hose.

Torque wrench setting for bleed nipples (1):


9 Nm (0.9 kgm).

Torque wrench setting for bleed nipple (2):


14 Nm (1.4 kgm).
C

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 35 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Š Add brake fluid to the reservoir until bringing fluid up to


correct level, see 2.16 (CHECKING AND TOPPING
UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL) and see 2.17
(CHECKING AND TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL).
Š Refit the rubber cap.
WARNING
The lever may still feel too soft even after the circuit
has been bled and all air expelled from the system.
When this is the case, you will have to:
- bleed the brake caliper, see BLEEDING THE
BRAKE CALIPER; and
- bleed the brake master cylinder, see BLEEDING
THE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER.
BLEEDING THE BRAKE CALIPER
NOTE Do not bleed both braking systems at the same
time. The procedure outlined below applies to both
braking systems. Any particular operations specific to
either one of the braking systems are described below.
When bleeding the front braking system, repeat the 1
process for both brake calipers.
Do not remove both front brake calipers at the same time.
Š Following instructions apply to the front braking
system only:
- remove the brake master cylinder, see 7.2.1 (WHEEL
REMOVAL) and leave it hanging on the brake line.
Arrange it so that the bleed nipple (1) is on top.
Š Following instructions apply to the rear braking
system only:
- the rear brake caliper has been removed previously
when bleeding the hydraulic circuit;
- release and remove the screw (3); collect the nut;
- an assistant will be required to keep the brake fluid 3
reservoir (4) above the master cylinder.
NOTE Be sure to have a shim (about 3-mm thick) ready
at hand. The shim will have to be placed between the
brake pads.
Š Place the shim between the brake pads and pump the
brake lever several times. 4
Š Use the shim or some other suitable tool to ease the
pistons apart.

WARNING
Do not push on the pistons directly. Push the pads
gently.
Š While pushing on the pads, open and close the bleed
nipple.
NOTE It is important that these operations – moving
the pistons apart, opening and then closing the bleed
nipple – be performed simultaneously.
Š Add brake fluid to the reservoir until bringing fluid up to
correct level, see 2.16 (CHECKING AND TOPPING
UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL) and see 2.17
(CHECKING AND TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID
LEVEL).
Š Work the lever again while placing the shim between
the brake pads.

2 - 36 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

Š Move the pistons apart again and loosen the bleed


nipple at the same time. Look for any air bubbles in the
fluid.
Š Repeat the process until the fluid is totally clear of air
bubbles.
NOTE Top up reservoir with brake fluid up to Max level
if needed, while bleeding the brake caliper. The reservoir
should not be empty during the bleeding procedure or air
will enter the system.
BLEEDING THE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
NOTE Repeat process for the brake master cylinder
(see procedure described for the brake calipers).
Š Place the shim between the brake pads and work the
lever several times to introduce pressure in the system.
Š Use the shim or some other suitable tool to ease the
pistons apart.

WARNING
Do not push on the pistons directly. Push the pads
gently.
Š Look for any air bubbles in the fluid.
Š Repeat the process until the fluid is totally free of air
bubbles.
NOTE Top up reservoir with brake fluid up to Max level
if needed, while bleeding the brake master cylinder. The
reservoir should not be empty during the bleeding
procedure or air will enter the system.
Š The master cylinder bleeding procedure is now
complete.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 37 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.20 BLEEDING THE CLUTCH


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.5 (CLUTCH FLUID) carefully.
Bleed the clutch system after the first 1000 km (625 mi) if
needed.
Any air trapped in the hydraulic circuit will act as a
cushion and take up most of the pressure applied by the
master cylinder. This will hamper the operation of the
clutch.
A spongy feel of the clutch lever and impaired clutch
operation mean that there is air in the circuit.

WARNING
Handle with care: contact with clutch fluid will alter
the chemical properties of paintwork, plastic and
rubber parts, etc.
DO NOT RELEASE CLUTCH FLUID INTO THE
ENVIRONMENT.
This is a dangerous condition that makes the vehicle
unsafe to ride. Each time the clutch master cylinder 1
is removed, it is indispensable to bleed the hydraulic
circuit after refitting the master cylinder, when the
clutch is back to normal operating conditions. Bleed
the clutch as follows:
Š Top up clutch fluid level in the reservoir, see 2.18
(CHECKING AND TOPPING UP CLUTCH FLUID
LEVEL).
Š Remove the left-hand fairing, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING
THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Remove the rubber cap.
Š Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleed nipple (1).
Insert the other end of the hose into a container.
Š Pump the clutch lever quickly. Repeat several times,
then keep the lever pulled in.
Š Slacken the bleed nipple by one quarter of a turn to let
the clutch fluid drain into the container. This will remove
any tension from the lever and help it travel fully home.
Š Tighten the bleed nipple (1). Pump the lever repeatedly,
then keep it squeezed in and slacken the bleed nipple
again.
Š Repeat process until the fluid draining into the
container is totally free from air bubbles.
NOTE During the bleeding procedure, top up reservoir
with clutch fluid up to Max level if needed. The reservoir
should not be empty during the bleeding procedure or air
will enter the system.
Š Tighten the bleed nipple (1) and disconnect the bleed
hose.

Torque wrench setting for bleed nipples (1):


9 Nm (0.9 kgm).
Š Add brake fluid to the reservoir until bringing fluid up to
correct level, see 2.18 (CHECKING AND TOPPING
UP CLUTCH FLUID LEVEL).
Š Refit the rubber cap.

2 - 38 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.21 CHANGING THE FRONT BRAKE FLUID


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) carefully.
1
Change the front brake fluid every two years.

WARNING
Handle with care: contact with brake fluid will alter
the chemical properties of paintwork, plastic and
rubber parts, etc.
DO NOT RELEASE BRAKE FLUID INTO THE
ENVIRONMENT.

ŠRemove the rubber cap.


ŠAttach a clear plastic hose to the bleed nipple (1).
Insert the other end of the hose into a container.
ŠLoosen the bleed nipple (1) by about one turn.
NOTE Ensure that there is fluid in the reservoir at all 2
times during the operation, or you will have to bleed the
system when finished, see 2.19 (BLEEDING THE
BRAKE CIRCUITS).
Š Keep an eye on the reservoir (2) while fluid drains off.
Tighten the bleed nipple (1) before fluid has drained off
completely.
Š Top up the reservoir (2), see 2.16 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).
ŠLoosen the bleed nipple (1) again by about half turn.
ŠLook at the fluid draining from the hose. When fluid
colour changes from dark to a lighter shade, tighten the
bleed nipple (1) and disconnect the bleed hose.

Torque wrench setting for bleed nipple (1): 9 Nm


(0.9 kgm).

ŠRefit the rubber cap.


Š Add fluid to the reservoir (2) until bringing
fluid to the
correct level, see 2.16 (CHECKING AND TOPPING
UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 39 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.22 CHANGING THE REAR BRAKE FLUID


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) carefully.
1
Change the rear brake fluid every two years.

WARNING
Handle with care: contact with brake fluid will alter
the chemical properties of paintwork, plastic and
rubber parts, etc.
DO NOT RELEASE BRAKE FLUID INTO THE
ENVIRONMENT.
Š Remove the rubber cap.
Š Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleed nipple (1).
Insert the other end of the hose into a container.
Š Loosen the bleed nipple (1) by about one turn.
NOTE Ensure that there is fluid in the reservoir (2) at all
times during the operation, or you will have to bleed the 2
system when finished, see 2.19 (BLEEDING THE
BRAKE CIRCUITS).
Š Keep an eye on the reservoir (2) while fluid drains off.
Tighten the bleed nipple (1) before fluid has drained off
completely.
Š Top up the reservoir (2), see 2.17 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).
Š Loosen the bleed nipple (1) again by about half turn.
Š Look at the fluid draining from the hose. When fluid
colour changes from dark to a lighter shade, tighten the
bleed nipple (1) and disconnect the bleed hose.

Torque wrench setting for bleed nipple (1):


14 Nm (1.4 kgm).
Š Refit the rubber cap.
Š Add fluid to the reservoir(2) until bringing fluid up to
correct level, see 2.17 (CHECKING AND TOPPING
UP REAR BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).

2 - 40 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.23 CHANGING THE CLUTCH FLUID


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.5 (CLUTCH FLUID) carefully.
Change the clutch fluid every two years.

WARNING 1
Handle with care: contact with clutch fluid will alter
the chemical properties of paintwork, plastic and
rubber parts, etc.
DO NOT RELEASE CLUTCH FLUID INTO THE
ENVIRONMENT.
Š Remove the rubber cap.
Š Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleed nipple (1).
Insert the other end of the hose into a container.
Š Loosen the bleed nipple (1) by about one turn.
NOTE Ensure that there is fluid in the reservoir (2) at all
times during the operation, or you will have to bleed the 2
system when finished, see 2.20 (BLEEDING THE
CLUTCH).
Š Keep an eye on the reservoir (2) while fluid drains off.
Tighten the bleed nipple (1) before fluid has drained off
completely.
Š Top up the reservoir (2), see 2.18 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP CLUTCH FLUID LEVEL).
Š Loosen the bleed nipple (1) again by about half turn.
Š Look at the fluid draining from the hose. When fluid
colour changes from dark to a lighter shade, tighten the
bleed nipple (1) and disconnect the bleed hose.

Torque wrench setting for bleed nipple (1): 20


Nm (2.0 kgm).
Š Refit the rubber cap.
Š Add fluid in the reservoir(2) until bringing fluid up to
correct level, see 2.18 (CHECKING AND TOPPING
UP CLUTCH FLUID LEVEL).

2.24 ADJUSTING THE FRONT BRAKE LEVER


AND CLUTCH LEVER 3
1
The position of the lever (1) relative to the twistgrip (2) is
adjusted by rotating the dial adjuster (3).
Setting “1” gives approximately 105-mm distance
between lever and twistgrip. Setting “4” gives about 85-
mm distance.
Settings “2” and “3” provide intermediate positions of
the lever.
Š Push the lever (1) forward and rotate the dial adjuster
(3) until aligning the desired setting mark with the
2
index.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 41 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.25 ADJUSTING REAR BRAKE LEVER PLAY


Rear brake pedal position is set at the factory so as to
afford maximum ease of operation.
However, the lever may be adjusted to suit rider's
preferences as follows:
2
Š Loosen the locknut (1).
Š Tighten the brake adjuster (2) all the way in. 1
Š Tighten the locknut (3) fully home onto the master
cylinder linkage (4).
Š Tighten the master cylinder linkage (4) fully, then 4
loosen it by 3-4 turns.
Š Loosen the brake adjuster (2) until setting the brake 3
lever at the desired height.
Š Lock out brake adjuster (2) movement by the locknut
(1).
Š Loosen the linkage (4) until it touches the master
cylinder piston.
Š Tighten the linkage allowing 0.5 –1 mm play between
master cylinder linkage (4) and master cylinder piston.

WARNING
Ensure that the brake lever (5) has some free play,
otherwise the brake will stay applied even when the
lever is released, leading to early wear of brake pads
and discs.
Free play of lever (5): 4 mm (measured at lever end).
Š Lock the master cylinder linkage by the locknut (3).
WARNING 5
When finished, apply brake and ensure the wheel
turns freely when brake is released.

2.26 ADJUSTING THE GEAR SHIFT LEVER


Gear shift lever position is controlled by a linkage (1).
Adjust as follows:
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand. 1
Š Lowering the side stand (2) will help.
Š Loosen the nuts (3) and (4).
Š Rotate the linkage until setting the lever at the desired
height. 3
Š Tighten the nuts (3) and (4).
4
2

2 - 42 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.27 CHECKING BRAKE PADS FOR WEAR


The rate at which brake pads will wear depends on
usage, riding style and road surface condition.
NOTE The following information applies to both braking
systems.
This is a quick inspection procedure to determine brake
pads wear:
Š Place the vehicle on the stand. 1
Š Visually inspect the area between brake disc and brake
pads proceeding as follows:
- from the bottom up at the front end to check the front
brake calipers (1);
- from the bottom up at the rear end to check the rear
brake caliper (2).

WARNING
If brake pads were allowed to wear down until
uncovering the metal substrate, metal-to-metal
2
contact with the brake disc would lead to rattle and
the brake caliper sparking. This will result in loss of
braking and brake disc damage, causing a
dangerous riding condition.
Š When the lining material of even just one of the brake
pads is worn down to nearly 1 mm, or when one of the
wear indicators is worn away, change both brake pads.
- Front brake pads (3), see 7.5.1 (REPLACING THE
BRAKE PADS).
- Rear brake pads (4), see 7.6.1 (REPLACING THE
BRAKE PADS).

3 4

1m
1m m
m

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 43 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.28 STEERING
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Inspect after the first 1500 km (937 mi) and every 7500
km (4687 mi) or 8 months afterwards.
The steering is fitted with rolling bearings to ensure
smooth handling.
Proper steering adjustment is vital to smooth steering
movement and safe riding.
Any hardness in the steering will impair handling,
whereas a soft steering will result in poor stability.

2.28.1 CHECKING PLAY IN THE BEARINGS


Š Put the vehicle on the centre stand.
Š Rock the forks back and forth in the direction of travel.
Š If you feel any play, adjust the bearings, see 2.28.2
(ADJUSTING PLAY IN THE BEARINGS).

2 - 44 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.28.2 ADJUSTING PLAY IN THE BEARINGS


2
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Adjusting play in the bearings will be easier when the 3
following components are remsee 7.1.11 (REMOVING
THE LEFT-HAND TWISTGRIP)oved:
- Remove both twistgrips, see 7.1.11 (REMOVING THE
LEFT-HAND TWISTGRIP) and see 7.1.14
(REMOVING THE THROTTLE CONTROL).
- Remove the electric control device located on the left-
hand handlebar, see 7.1.13 (REMOVING THE LEFT- 5
HAND HANDLEBAR SWITCHGEAR). 4 1
- Remove both hydraulic controls, see 7.1.12
(REMOVING THE CLUTCH CONTROL) and 7.1.15
(REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE CONTROL).
Š Slacken but do not remove the screw (4) securing the
handlebar (2) to the front fork (1).
Š Slacken but do not remove the screw (5) securing the
top yoke (3) to the front fork (1). 7
Š Release and remove the top bush (6) and collect the
shim (7).
Š Tap the underside of the top yoke (3) with a plastic
mallet to ease out the top yoke together with the
steering lock switch.
Š Lean the top yoke (3) forward. Place a cloth
underneath the top yoke to protect the instrument 6
panel.
Š Straighten the tabs (those bent upwards) of the safety
washer (9) using a small flat-blade screwdriver.
NOTE Make sure you have the special tool no.
8140203 (socket for steering adjustment) ready at hand.
Š Slacken and remove the nut (10) using the special
socket.
Š Remove the safety washer (9).
WARNING
Renew the safety washer (9) on assembly.
Š Screw in the adjuster nut (8) using the special socket to
take out play.

Torque wrench setting for adjuster nut (8): 9


40 Nm (4.0 kgm)
Š Fit the safety washer (9) so that the tabs are lined up
with the recesses in the nut (8).
Š Screw the locknut (10) and tighten using the special
socket.

Tightening procedure for locknut (10): screw in 10


manually until contact, and then tighten by one
quarter of a turn.
9
NOTE The tabs of the safety washer (9) should be bent
upwards.
8
Š Bend the four tabs of the safety washer (9) upwards
over the recesses of the locknut (10).
Š Replace the top yoke (3). Ensure that it becomes
properly seated in place.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 45 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Š Apply engine oil to the thread and underside of the


bush (6), see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
Š Screw in and tighten the top bush (6). Take care to refit
the shim (7) in the proper position.
7
Torque wrench setting for top bush (6): 120 Nm
(12 kgm).

ŠScrew in and tighten the screw (5).


6
Torque wrench setting for screw (5): 25 Nm (2.5 kgm).

WARNING
Lubricate the thread and the underside of screw head
of the screw (4).
2
ŠScrew in and tighten the screw (4).

Torque wrench setting for screw (4): 25 Nm (2.5 kgm). 3

WARNING
When finished, ensure that the handlebars turn
smoothly or the sliding surfaces will damage
resulting in poor handling.

5
4 1

2 - 46 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.29 INSPECTING THE FRONT SUSPENSION

2.29.1 FRONT SUSPENSION


1
The front suspension is managed by a hydraulic fork,
which is held to the steering stem by two yokes.
Each fork leg is fitted with top-mounted adjusters to
modIfy suspension response. An adjuster screw (1)
controls rebound damping, whereas an adjuster nut (2)
controls springs preload.
Vehicle response can be further modified by changing 2
front ride height.
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Change front fork oil after the first 7500 km (4687 mi) and
every 22500 km (14000 mi) afterwards.
The following inspections should be performed every
7500 km (4687 mi):
Š Keep the brake lever squeezed in and press down
repeatedly on the handlebars to compress the front
fork. The front fork should compress in a smooth
motion. Inspect the fork legs for any traces of oil.
If the front fork has a tendency to bottom out, it needs
adjusting, see 2.29.2 (FRONT FORK ADJUSTMENT).
An oil change may also be necessary, see 7.8.1
(CHANGING FRONT FORK OIL).
Check the front fork for oil leaks and inspect the surface
of the fork legs for cracks or scoring.
Any damaged components should be repaired or – where
repair is not feasible – renewed, see 7.8.3
(DISASSEMBLING THE STANCHION TUBES –
SLIDERS).
Š Ensure that all parts are properly tightened and test the
front suspension for proper operation.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 47 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.29.2 FRONT FORK ADJUSTMENT


Factory setting is designed to suit the broadest possible
range or riding conditions, meaning low and high speed,
whether riding solo or carrying a full load.
However, front suspension setting may be modified to
suit specific needs in accordance with vehicle usage. 1

NOTE Determine which kind of setting is needed


before disturbing the adjusters. The table below reports
2
available setting options.
SETTING OPTIONS:
Standard setting:
standard load conditions (for instance, rider and
luggage).
Mid-range setting:
heavy load conditions (rider, passenger and luggage).
Stiff setting:
sports-like riding style.
Full-load setting:
relaxed riding style (touring).

WARNING
Do not force the adjuster screw (1) beyond its limit
stops in either direction, or the thread may strip.
Set both fork legs to the same spring load and
rebound settings. A motorcycle whose fork legs are
set to different settings will be unstable.
When spring preload is increased, rebound damping
should be increased accordingly. Failure to do so
may result in the front end jerking unexpectedly
when riding.

WARNING
Before adjusting, first set the fork to the stiffest
setting [turn the screw (1) fully clockwise].
The notches on the adjuster screw (1) provide
convenient reference marks when setting rebound
damping.
Rotate the adjusting screw (1) gradually by one
eighth of a turn at a time.
Test ride the vehicle repeatedly until achieving the
ideal setting.

WARNING
Fork leg height over top yoke face (B) is not
adjustable.
Never attempt to modify steering geometry by raising
or lowering the fork legs in the yokes.
Fork leg height over top yoke face (B) is set at the
factory (standard setting is the first notch).
TABLE
Front suspension Standard setting Soft setting Stiff setting Full-load setting
screw in fully (*) screw in fully (*) screw in fully (*)
Rebound damping, screw in fully (*)
slacken (**) by 1.25 slacken (**) by 1.5 slacken (**) by 1.25
screw (1) slacken (**) by 1 turn
turn turn turn
Spring preload, nut
(2) [look at the
notches (A) for refer- 6th notch 7th notch 5th notch 7th notch
ence]

(*) = clockwise
(**) = anti-clockwise

2 - 48 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.30 REAR SWINGING ARM


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Periodically check that the nut-and-spindle assembly and
the needle roller bearings of the swinging arm are
properly tightened.
Inspection procedure:
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand.
Š Push and pull the rear wheel up and down, then rock it
from side to side (see figures).
If you feel any play, adjust the swinging arm,
see 2.30.1 (SWINGING ARM ADJUSTMENT).
If this fails to eliminate play, change the bearings,
see 7.9.2 (DISMANTLING THE SWINGING ARM).

2.30.1 SWINGING ARM ADJUSTMENT


3
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand. 1
Š Undo the nut (1) fully.
NOTE Make sure to have the special tool no.
8140203 (socket for swinging arm spindle – engine
mount adjustment). 2
Š Slacken the lockring (2) fully using the special socket.
Š Working from the right-hand side of the motorcycle,
rotate the swinging arm spindle (3) clockwise. The
adjusting bush (4) will rotate with the spindle and push
the swinging arm fully home.

Torque wrench setting for spindle (3): 12 Nm


(1.2 kgm). 2
Š Tighten the lockring (2) using the special socket.

Torque wrench setting for lockring (2): 60 Nm


(6 kgm).
Š Tighten the nut (1).
3

Torque wrench setting for nut (1): 90 Nm


(9.0 kgm).
4

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 49 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.31 REAR SUSPENSION INSPECTION

2.31.1 REAR SUSPENSION


3
The rear suspension is managed by a spring/damper unit
that is connected to the frame and to the rear swinging
arm through silent-blocks and a linkage system, 2
respectively.
To modify vehicle response, the rear shock absorber is
fitted with an adjuster screw (1) which controls rebound
damping and an adjuster knob (2) which controls spring 1
preload (3).
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check after the first 1000 km (625 ml) and every 15000
km (9375 ml) or 16 months afterwards.
Š Ensure that all parts are properly tightened and check
the joints of the rear suspension for proper operation.

2.31.2 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ADJUSTMENT


Factory setting is designed to suit the broadest possible
range or riding conditions, meaning low and high speed, 1
whether riding solo or carrying a full load.
However, rear suspension setting may be modified to suit
specific needs in accordance with vehicle usage.

WARNING
Before adjusting, set both adjusters to the stiffest
settings. This means that both adjuster screw (1) and
adjuster knob (2) should be turned fully clockwise.
Do not force the adjuster screw (1) beyond its limit
stop or you may strip the thread.
Ensure that the adjuster screw (1) is always set
precisely at a click position. It should never be in an
intermediate position (midway between subsequent
click positions).
Š Turn the adjuster screw (1) to set rebound damping
(see table).
Š Turn the adjuster knob (2) to set compression damping
(see table).

WARNING 2
Spring preload and rebound damping of the rear
shock absorber should be set to suit vehicle usage.
When spring preload is increased, rebound damping
should be increased accordingly to avoid
unexpected jerking when riding.
Rotate the adjuster screw (1) gradually by 2-3 click
positions at a time. Rotate the adjuster knob (2) by 5-
6 click positions at a time.

2 - 50 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

Test ride the vehicle on the road repeatedly until


achieving ideal setting.
Never remove the capscrew (4) or attempt to service
4
the valve located underneath. The shock absorber
contains nitrogen, which would leak out if capscrew
or valve were disturbed. This would impair shock
absorber operation and lead to an accident.

REAR SHOCK ABSORBER SETTING CHART

Rear suspension Standard setting Soft setting Stiff setting Mid-range setting

fully tightened (*) fully tightened (*) fully tightened (*) fully tightened (*)
Rebound damping
turn out (**) by 9 click turn out (**) by 10 turn out (**) by 8 click turn out (**) by 7 click
(1)
positions click positions positions positions
fully slackened (**) fully slackened (**) fully slackened (**) fully slackened (**)
Spring preload, knob
tighten (*) by 14 click tighten (*) by 4 click tighten (**) by 22 tighten (**) by 34
(2)
positions positions click positions click positions

(*) =clockwise
(**) =anti-clockwise

2.31.3 INSPECTING THE REAR SUSPENSION


LINKAGE SYSTEM
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check bearings every 30000 km (18750 mi).
NOTE An assistant will be required to keep the vehicle
upright during the procedure.
Š Hold the tail of the motorcycle firmly with your hand.
Press down and release repeatedly.
Š If you feel any hardness or play, or hear squeaking
noises, change the bearings of the rear suspension
linkage system, see 7.10.2 (REMOVING THE REAR
SUSPENSION LINKAGES).
Š Press down the vehicle tail. If the tail is slow to spring
back up when released, check rear suspension
adjustment, see 2.31.2 (REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
ADJUSTMENT).
If the problem persists, it means that the shock absorber
is depressurised. Charge the shock absorber.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 51 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.32 FRONT WHEEL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check every 7500 km (4687 mi).
Š Place the vehicle on the front wheel stand ,
see 1.9.1 (PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
FRONT WHEEL STAND).
Š Rotate the wheel manually in both directions.
Š The wheel should be spinning smoothly, with no
hardness or unusual noise. If not so, change the
bearings, see 7.2.2 (WHEEL HUB DISASSEMBLY).
Š If you detect any wobble, inspect wheel and tyre,
see 7.2.3 (WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION).
Š A spinning wheel that always stops in exactly the same
position needs balancing.

2.33 REAR WHEEL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check every 7500 km (4687 mi).
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand.
Š Rotate the wheel manually in both directions.
Š The wheel should be spinning smoothly, with no
hardness or unusual noise. If not so, change the
bearings, see 7.2.2 (WHEEL HUB DISASSEMBLY).
Š If you detect any wobble, inspect wheel and tyre,
see 7.2.3 (WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION).
Š A spinning wheel that always stops in exactly the same
position needs balancing.

2 - 52 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.34 EXHAUST MANIFOLD NUTS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
1
Tighten the exhaust manifold nuts after the first 1000 km
(625 mi) and every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months 1
afterwards.

CAUTION
Let the engine cool down completely.
Š Remove the side fairings, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING
THE SIDE FAIRINGS). 1
Š Remove the front spoiler, see 7.1.35 (REMOVING
THE RADIATOR SPOILER).
Š Tighten the three nuts (1) of the front cylinder exhaust
manifold to the specified torque.
Š Tighten the three nuts (2) of the rear cylinder exhaust
manifold to the specified torque.

2
Torque wrench setting for nuts (1-2): 25 Nm
2
(2.5 kgm).

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 53 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.35 DRIVE CHAIN


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Inspect and lubricate as required every 1000 km (625
mi). The vehicle is fitted with an endless chain that has
no master link.
Chain type: 525

WARNING
The drive chain links are fitted with O-rings that retain
the grease inside. Use the utmost care when
adjusting, lubricating, washing or replacing the chain.
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand.
Š Put the gearbox in neutral.
Š Rotate the rear wheel manually and slowly.
Š Visually inspect chain, front and rear sprockets looking
for:
- damaged chain rollers;
- loose chain link pins;
- dry, rusty, warped or seized links;
- exceeding wear;
- missing O-rings;
- exceedingly worn or damaged sprocket teeth.

WARNING
If chain rollers are damaged, chain link pins are loose
and/or any O-rings are missing or deteriorated,
renew the drive chain and the front and rear
sprockets as a set, see 7.4.1 (FINAL DRIVE
REMOVAL).

2.35.1 CHAIN SLACK INSPECTION


To check chain slack:
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand.
Š Put the gearbox in neutral.
Š Check chain slack in the lower straight portion of chain.
The vertical movement of the chain midway between
the sprockets should be approximately 25 mm.
Š Wheel the motorcycle forward to check slack at various
sections of the chain. Slack should be the same
throughout one full turn of the wheel. 25 mm
mm
WARNING
If slack is greater at particular positions of the chain,
it means that some links are warped or have seized.
To prevent seizure, lubricate the chain frequently,
see 2.41.1 (CLEANING AND LUBRICATION).
Chain slack must be adjusted whenever it differs from the
specified 25 mm, regardless of whether it is greater or
less than the 25-mm service limit, even when it is
consistent at all positions of the chain. See 2.35.3
(CHAIN SLACK ADJUSTMENT).

WARNING
Exceeding slack in the chain may cause the chain to
rattle or knock, resulting in a worn chain slider and
guide.
Improper maintenance may lead to early wear of the
chain and/or sprocket damage.
Service the final drive more frequently when the
motorcycle is used in demanding conditions or on
dusty/muddy roads.

2 - 54 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.35.2 CHECKING CHAIN AND SPROCKETS FOR


WEAR
Š Stretch the chain taut, see 2.35.3 (CHAIN SLACK
ADJUSTMENT).
Š Count 17 link pins (16 link-to-link sections) along one
portion of the chain and measure the distance between
the 1st and the 17th link.
Replace the chain if the length measured exceeds the
limit specified below, see 7.11 (DISMANTLING THE
DRIVE CHAIN).
Service limit: 255.5 mm (0.5% MAX).

2.35.3 CHAIN SLACK ADJUSTMENT


If the chain needs adjusting after the inspection, proceed
as follows:
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand. 1
Š Loosen the screws (1) completely.
NOTE Make sure you have the pin spanner (2)
supplied with the tool kit ready at hand.
To increase slack:
Š Apply the pin spanner (2) as shown in diagram (A).
To take out slack:
Š Apply the pin spanner (2) as shown in diagram (B).
When the pin spanner (2) is properly in place:
Š Hook the pin spanner (2) the lockring (3).
Š Fit the extension (4) to the pin spanner.
Š Rotate the pin spanner (2) to adjust chain slack.
Š Check chain slack, see 2.35.1 (CHAIN SLACK 1
INSPECTION).
1
Š Tighten the two screws (1). 4

Tighten the screws (1) to 35 Nm (3.5 kgm).


Lubricate the chain every 1000 km (625 mi) and
whenever it seems appropriate.
3 1
WARNING 2
Leave the chain to dry, then spray with aerosol
lubricant for O-ring chains, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT
CHART).
NOTE Do not ride when you have only just lubricated
the chain. Centrifugal force would cause the newly
applied lubricant to fly all over adjacent vehicle parts.
4
WARNING
The chain lubricants available on the market may
contain aggressive substances which will damage
the chain O-rings. 2
Standard chain type is 525.
Replace with a chain of the same type.

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 55 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.35.4 DRIVE CHAIN GUIDE PLATE INSPECTION


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
1
INFORMATION) carefully. 6
Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand. 7
Š Remove the left-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING). 4
Š Release and remove the two screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 10 Nm


(1.0 kgm). 3 2
5
Š Remove the rectifier (2) but leave it attached to the
main wiring harness.
Š Remove the guard (3).
Š Release and remove the three screws (4) securing the
rectifier mount (5).
10
Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 12 Nm
(1.2 kgm).
Š Collect the three bushings (6) and the three rubber
dampers (7).
8 9
Š Remove the rectifier mount (5) and collect the
bushings.
Š Slacken the screw (8) and withdraw the gear shift lever
clamp (9).
Š Remove the clutch slave cylinder, see 3.2.1 (CLUTCH
SLAVE CYLINDER REMOVAL).
NOTE Release the wire of the side stand switch from
its retainer.
Š Remove the sprocket cover (10).
Š Remove the guide plate (11).
Š Check the guide plate (11) for damage or wear.
Replace as required.
11

2.35.5 CHAIN SLIDER INSPECTION


Š Place the vehicle on the centre stand.
Š Check the chain slider (1) for damage or wear. Replace
as required, see 7.1.57 (REMOVING THE DRIVE
CHAIN SLIDER).

2 - 56 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.36 TYRES
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check tyre condition after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and
every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months afterwards.
Tyre inflation pressures should be checked monthly with
2
the tyres at room temperature.
This vehicle is fitted with tubeless tyres.
TREAD CONDITION
1
WARNING
Inspect tread surface and check for wear. Badly worn
tyres adversely affect traction and handling.
Always change a worn tyre. A tyre that becomes
punctured in the tread area should be changed when
the puncture is larger than 5 mm.
Some of the tyre types approved for this vehicle are
fitted with wear indicators.
There are various types of wear indicators.
Enquire about correct wear inspection procedure
with your supplier.
Never use tube tyres on tubeless tyre rims, or
viceversa.
Always check that the caps are in place on the valves A
(1), or the tyres may deflate suddenly.
Tyre replacement and repair, and wheel servicing and
balancing are delicate operations. They should be
carried out using adequate tools and are best left to
experienced mechanics.
MINIMUM RECOMMENDED TREAD DEPTH (A):
front and rear tyre ……………………2 mm ( USA 3 mm).
INFLATION PRESSURES
Check the tyre inflation pressures at regular intervals
when the tyres are cold.
Checking pressure on hot tyres will result in inaccurate
measurement.
Take care to check tyres pressures before and after a
long journey.
An overinflated tyre will provide a harsh ride, reduce
riding comfort and stability when cornering.
An underinflated tyre will extend the contact patch to
include a larger portion of the tyre wall (2). When this is
the case, the tyre may slip on or become separated from
the rim, leading to loss of control. The tyre may even
jump off the rim under hard braking.
Lastly, the vehicle may skid in a bend.
See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS)for inflation pressures.

WARNING
The wheel must be balanced after each tyre repair.
New tyres may be coated with an oily film. Drive
carefully until covering several kilometres.
Never apply non-specific products to the tyres.
Approved tyre sizes are reported in the registration
document. Installing non-approved tyres is a legal
offence.
Using tyres other than the specified sizes may
change vehicle behaviour, impair handling and make
the vehicle unsafe to ride.
Use only the first-equipment tyre types selected by
aprilia, see 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS).

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 57 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.37 FUEL LINES


Read 1.2.1 (FUEL) carefully.
Check the fuel lines every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8
months.
Renew every four years.
- Always change a worn, cracked or damaged fuel line.
- High-pressure delivery pipe (1) [~ 450 kpa (4,5 bar)].
- Return pipe (2).
NOTE Ensure that the male quick-disconnect fitting (3)
is properly seated in the female quick disconnect (4).
See Section 4 (FUEL SYSTEM) for more details.

2.38 BRAKE AND CLUTCH LINES


Read 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) and 1.2.5 (CLUTCH
FLUID) carefully.
Check the brake and clutch lines every 7500 km (4687 1
mi) or 8 months.
Renew every four years.
Always change a worn, cracked or damaged line. 2
4

2.39 COOLANT PIPES


Read 1.2.4 (COOLANT) carefully.
Check the coolant pipes every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8
months.
Always change a worn, cracked or damaged coolant
pipe.

2 - 58 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

2.40 MAINTAINING FASTENERS AT THE


CORRECT TIGHTENING TORQUE
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Check after the first 1000 km (625 mi) and every 7500
km (4687 mi) or 8 months afterwards.
Ensure that all fasteners are properly tightened. Take
special care with safety-related items, namely:
- handlebars;
- front brake lever;
- clutch lever;
- fuel delivery pipe;
- front fork to yoke;
- front fork to front wheel spindle clamps;
- front wheel;
- front brake line fittings;
- front brake discs;
- front brake calipers;
- engine;
- sprocket;
- rear brake lever;
- swinging arm;
- swinging arm linkage system;
- rear shock absorber;
- rear wheel;
- rear brake disc;
- rear brake caliper;
- rear brake line fittings.

WARNING
All fasteners must be tightened to the specified
torque. Use LOCTITE ONLY where specified, see 2.41
(FASTENERS).
Lubricate only those parts indicated in the relevant
chart, see 2.41 (FASTENERS).

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 59 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.41 FASTENERS
Check and tighten as required after the first 1000 km
(625 mi) and every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8 months
afterwards.

WARNING
The fasteners reported in the chart must be tightened
to the specified torque using a torque wrench and
applying LOCTITE® where specified.
Safety-related items ( ) are in brackets.

ENGINE
Engine to frame
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Front mounting bolts 2+2 M10 50 5.0
Upper and lower rear mounting bolts on left-hand side 2 M10 50 5.0
Upper and lower rear mounting bolts on right-hand side of
2 M20x1.5 12 1.2 lub
adjuster bush
Upper and lower rear mounting bolts on right -hand side of
2 M20x1.5 50 5.0
locknut
Upper and lower rear mounting bolts on right-hand side of screw 2 M10 50 5.0
Parts installed to engine
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Engine oil inlet flange 2 M6 12 1.2
Engine oil outlet flange 2 M6 12 1.2
Sprocket to transmission secondary shaft 1 M10 50 5.0 L243
Clutch slave cylinder fixing 3 M6 12 1.2
Sprocket cover fixing 3 M6 12 1.2
Fairing plate on clutch cover 2 M5 5 0.5
SWINGING ARM
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Swinging arm spindle adjuster bush 1 M30x1.5 12 1.2 lub
Swinging arm spindle lockring 1 M30x1.5 60 6.0
Swinging arm spindle nut 1 M20x1.5 90 9.0
Caliper carrier retaining pin 1 M14x1.5 60 6.0 L243
Chain slider to swinging arm 2 M5 4 0.4 L243
Upper and lower chain guard to swinging arm 7 M5 4 0.4 L243
Eccentric adjuster pinch bolt 2 M10 35 3.5
Brake line gaiter fixing 1 M5 4 0.4
Wheel spindle anti-rotation screw 1 M6 10 1.0 L243
SIDE STAND
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Stand bracket to frame 2 M10 40 4.0
Stand axle 1 M10x1.25 10 1.0
Switch retaining screw 1 M6 10 1.0 L243
CONTINUED ➤

2 - 60 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

Locknut 1 M10x1.25 30 3.0


CENTRE STAND
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Centre stand to frame 2 M10 50 5.0 L243
FRONT SUSPENSION
Front fork
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Top yoke to fork legs 1+1 M8 25 2.5
Bottom yoke to fork legs 2+2 M8 25 2.5
Headstock nut 1 M35x1 40 4.0
Headstock locknut 1 M35x1 man. +90°
Top yoke fixing cap 1 M29x1 120 12.0
Screws securing steering lock stopper to bottom yoke 1+1 M8 22 2.2
Fork / wheel spindle clamps 2-2 M8 22 2.2
Ignition switch assembly to top yoke 2 M8 25 2.5
REAR SUSPENSION
Shock absorber
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Shock absorber to frame 1 M10 45 4.5 lub
Linkage system
Single linkage to frame 1 M10 45 4.5 lub
Single / dual linkage to frame 1 M10 45 4.5 lub
Dual linkage to swinging arm 1 M10 45 4.5 lub
Dual linkage to shock absorber 1 M10 45 4.5 lub
ELECTRIC SYSTEM
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Battery closure bracket fixings 2 M5 5 0.5
Horn mount fixing 1 M8 25 2.5
Speed sensor fixing 1 M6 10 1.0 L243
Tail light to grab rail fixings 3 M6 7 0.7
Computer fixings 5 M6 10 1.0
Rectifier fixings 2 M6 12 1.2
2 M5 2 0.2
Headlamp to front fairing fixings
2 SWP 3.9 1 0.1
Coil mount to frame fixings 4 M6 10 1.0
Fuse box to dashboard/front fairing subframe 2 M5 2 0.2 L243
Relay cable to starter motor 1 M6 5 0.5
Ground connection to engine 1 M6 10 1.0
Cables to relay 2 M6 5 0.5
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 61 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

AIRBOX
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Airbox cover fixings 7 M5 2 0.2
Airbox to throttle body 6 M6 7 0.7 lub
Intake funnels to airbox 4 SWP3.9 1 0.1
Idling control stepper motor 2 M5 4 0.4 L243
Airbox to frame fixing plate 2 M6 5 0.5
Restriction diaphragm on airbox 1 SWP3.9 1 0.1
FRONT WHEEL
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Wheel spindle nut 1 M25x1,5 80 8.0 Gr.
REAR WHEEL
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Rear sprocket to flange 6 M8 25 2.5
Wheel spindle bolt 1 M40x1.5 170 17.0 Gr.
Cush drive axle bolt 1 M30x1.5 150 15.0 Gr.
Cush drive safety screws 3 M3 1.2 0.12
lub
Wheel bolt cap 1 M10 10 1.0
“OR”
COOLING SYSTEM
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Three-way manifold locking screw 1 M14x1.5 30 3.0 L572
Cooling fan mount fixings 2+2 M6 6 0.6
Cooling fan motor to mount 3+3 SWP3.9 1 0.1 L243
Radiator drain screw 1+1 M6 10 1.0 L572
Expansion reservoir to mount 2 M6 8 0.8
Expansion reservoir cap fixing 1 M28x3 man
Radiator fillet cap fixing 1 M6 10 1.0
Expansion reservoir rear to frame 1 M6 10 1.0
Radiator brackets to frame 6 M6 10 1.0
Oil cooler to mount 3 M6 10 1.0
Coolant radiator to mount 2 M6 10 1.0
BRAKING SYSTEMS
Front braking system
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Right-hand and left-hand brake caliper fixings 2+2 M10x1.25 50 5.0 lub
Brake disc fixings 6+6 M8 30 3.0 L243
Front brake line fixings 3 M10x1 20 2.0
Brake line triple bracket to yoke 1 M5 3 0.3
CONTINUED ➤

2 - 62 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

Rear braking system


Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Brake caliper fixing 1 M8 25 2.5
Brake lever to footpeg bracket 1 M8 15 1.5 L243
Brake lever rubber 1 M8 25 2.5 L270
Brake master cylinder fixings 2 M6 10 1.0
Brake rod locknut 1 M6 man
Brake disc fixings 6 M8 30 3.0 L243
Brake line fixings 2 M10x1 20 2.0
Brake light switch to rider foopeg bracket 1 M6 10 1.0
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Exhaust pipes to engine fixings 3+3 M8 25 2.5
Silencer fixing 1 M6 10 1.0
Compensator to frame 1 M8 25 2.5 L243
Stand rubber stop to compensator 1 M6 10 1.0
Grab rail heat guard to left-hand tube 2 M6 6 0.6
Hose clip to silencer coupling 2 M6 15 1.5 sil
FUEL TANK
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Fuel delivery pipe to pump mount 1 M12x1.5 22 2.2
Filler cap to fuel tank 7 M5 5 0.5
Fuel tank flange to fuel tank 8 M5 6 0.6 L518
Front tank to frame fixings 2 M6 8 0.8 lub
Tank cover 2 M5 3 0.3
Fuel rail to fuel line 2 M5 5 0.5
ENGINE OIL TANK AND COOLERS
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Oil reservoir to mounts 3 M6 10 1.0
Oil filter 1 M25x1.5 man.
Oil drain plug 1 M8 15 1.5
Oil level tube fittings 2 M10x1 20 2.0
FRONT BODYWORK
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Front mudguard 4 M5 5 0.5 lub
Left-hand and right-hand air scoops 6 M5 2 0.2
Rearview mirrors to bridge 4 M6 8 0.8
Air inlets to frame and bridge 6 M6 8 0.8
Fairing front bottom panel to front fairing 2 M5 4 0.4
Fairing front bottom panel to air inlet 2 SWP3.9 1 0.1
Air inlet closure 20 SWP3.9 1 0.1
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 63 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

Lower fairing to frame 4 M5 4 0.4


Lower fairing to upper fairing 8 M5 2 0.2
Windshield to front fairing 6 M5 2 0.2
Upper fairing to front fairing and air inlets 12 M5 3 0.3
Upper fairing to air inlet 6 M5 3 0.3
Cockpit facia panel to fairing 2 M5 3 0.3
Cockpit facia panel to protection moulding 2 SWP3.9 1 0.1
Rearview mirror protectors 4 M5 3 0.3
Cockpit to bridge 4 M6 4 0.4
Protection moulding to bridge 2 M6 4 0.4
Fairing stay to radiator mount 4 M6 5 0.5
Fairing stay to air inlets 2 M5 3 0.3
Lower fairing to fairing stay 6 M5 3 0.3
Fairing stay to air inlets 2 M5 3 0.3
Bottom yoke to plate 3 M6 5 0.5
FRAME
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Rider footpeg bracket to frame 4 M8 25 2.5
Passenger footpeg bracket to seat subframe 4 M8 25 2.5
Seat subframe to frame 4 M10 45 4.5
Fuel dampers to seat subframe 2 M8 man
Bridge to frame 2 M6 10 1.0
Centre stand spring retainer 1 M6 10 1.0
Oil tank mount to frame 2 M6 10 1.0
Throttle balancing tube cable stopper 1 M6 10 1.0
REAR BODYWORK
Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Number plate holder to mount 2 M5 4 0.4
Cat's eye nuts 2 M5 4 0.4
Number plate holder retaining screws 4 M5 5 0.5 L243
Exhaust heat guard screws 2 M5 4 0.4
Number plate light mount on number plate holder 2 M5 2 0.2
Number plate light to mount 1 M5 3 0.3
Front closure to seat subframe 6 M6 4 0.4
4 M6 4 0.4
Seat subframe rear closure
2 M5 3 0.3
Sidebag mounts to seat subframe 2 M8 15 1.5
Seat closure to seat subframe fixings 2 M6 10 1.0
Grab rail to seat subframe 3 M8 10 1.0
Passenger grab handles to grab rail 4 M8 15 1.5
CONTINUED ➤

2 - 64 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

HANDLEBARS AND CONTROLS


Description Qty. Screw/nut Nm kgm Notes
Vibration-damping weights 2 M6 10 1.0
Vibration-damping weight lockrings 2 M18x1.5 35 3.5
Handlebars to front fork 2 M8 30 3.0 Gr.
Handlebars safety screw 2 M6 12 1.2
Left-hand dimmer switch 2 M5 2 0.2
Right-hand dimmer switch 2 M5 2 0.2
Front brake control 2 M6 10 1.0
Clutch control 2 M6 10 1.0
Clutch line fitting to master cylinder 2 M10x1 20 2.0
Gear shift rod to gear shift lever and control 2 M6 12 1.2 L243
Gear shift lever to rider left-hand footpeg bracket 1 M8 15 1.5 L243
Control to gearbox shaft 1 M6 10 1.0
Gear shift lever pedal 1 M8 25 2.5 L270

Key: Steel / aluminium fastening screws with similar


L243 = apply LOCTITE® 243 coefficient of elasticity
L518 = apply LOCTITE® 518
L572 = apply LOCTITE® 572 SCREW Nm kgm
L574 = apply LOCTITE® 574
M4 3 0.3
L648 = apply LOCTITE® 648
man. = fix manually M5 6 0.6
gr. = grease underside of head
M6 12 1.2
lub = lubricate
sil = black silicone (part no. 8216005) M8 25 2.5
M10 50 5.0
M12 80 8.0

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 65 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

2.41.1 CLEANING AND LUBRICATION


Never wash the drive chain using steam cleaners, high-
pressure water nozzles or highly flammable solvents.
Š Wash the drive chain with fuel oil or kerosene.
If the chain tends to become rusty quickly, service more
frequently.

WARNING
Do not use trichlorethylene, petrol or similar
products: these products may be too aggressive for
this type of chain or, more important, they may
damage the O-rings that retain the grease in the gaps
between rollers and pins.

2 - 66 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS
RST mille

NOTES

Release 00/2001 - 11 2 - 67 - 00
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AND ADJUSTMENTS RST mille

NOTES

2 - 68 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

ENGINE
3

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 1 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

ENGINE

CONTENTS
3.1 SPECIFICATIONS AND TECHNICAL

0
INFORMATION ................................ 3-3-00
3.1.1 TECHNICAL DATA................................ 3-3-00
3.1.2 MAINTENANCE INTERVALS ............... 3-3-00
3.1.3 TROUBLESHOOTING........................... 3-3-00
3.1.4 SEALANTS ............................................ 3-3-00

1
3.1.5 LUBRICANTS ........................................ 3-3-00
3.1.6 SPECIAL TOOLS .................................. 3-3-00
3.1.7 TORQUE FIGURES ............................... 3-3-00
3.1.8 PRECONDITIONS FOR MAINTENANCE
AND REPAIR WORK............................. 3-3-00

3 3.1.9 GENERAL MAINTENANCE AND REPAIR


INSTRUCTIONS .................................... 3-3-00
3.2 ENGINE COMPONENTS THAT CAN BE
REMOVED WITH THE ENGINE INSTALLED

3
IN THE FRAME ................................ 3-4-00
3.2.1 CLUTCH SLAVE CYLINDER REMOVAL 3-6-00
3.3 TAKING THE ENGINE OUT OF THE
FRAME............................................. 3-7-00

4 3.4 FITTING THE ENGINE IN THE


FRAME........................................... 3-16-00

3 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

3.1 SPECIFICATIONS AND TECHNICAL


INFORMATION

3.1.1 TECHNICAL DATA


See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS).

3.1.2 MAINTENANCE INTERVALS


See 2.1.1 (PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART).

3.1.3 TROUBLESHOOTING
See 8.1 (TROUBLESHOOTING).

3.1.4 SEALANTS
See 1.7 (CONSUMABLES).

3.1.5 LUBRICANTS
See 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).

3.1.6 SPECIAL TOOLS


See 1.8 (SPECIAL TOOLS).

3.1.7 TORQUE FIGURES


See 2.41 (FASTENERS).

3.1.8 PRECONDITIONS FOR MAINTENANCE AND


REPAIR WORK

CAUTION
The engine weighs 65 kg approximately and must be
supported adequately upon installation. Handle
using lifting equipment of adequate weight capacity
and consider the centre of gravity of the engine.
Be careful of any projecting parts or sharp edges to
avoid injury from squeezing or cutting.

WARNING
In order to maintain the motorcycle engine and
systems, a thorough knowledge of the motorcycle is
required. In addition, always use the special tools
specified.
All maintenance and repair work must be undertaken
by a suitably trained technician.
NOTE Observe the manufacturer's instructions and
recommendations.

3.1.9 GENERAL MAINTENANCE AND REPAIR


INSTRUCTIONS
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-
MATION) carefully.

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 3 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

3.2 ENGINE COMPONENTS THAT CAN BE


REMOVED WITH THE ENGINE INSTALLED
IN THE FRAME
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-
MATION) carefully.
The parts listed below can be removed leaving the
engine in the frame.

WARNING
Necessary removal procedures are listed in the
proper sequence in this section.
Certain procedures include cross-references to rele-
vant sections of the manual. Some of the operations
described there may not be strictly required for the
job at hand. Proceed sensibly to avoid redundant
work, that is, always make sure you really need to
remove a particular component before proceeding.
Perform the minimum operations required to give
access to the component to be serviced.
TOP END
- Valve cover (1), see 0.4.1 (ENGINE WORKSHOP
MANUALS).
- Valve cover (2), cylinder head, rear cylinder and piston,
see 0.4.1 (ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS).
- Front (3) and rear (4) cylinder intake flanges.
- Camshaft position sensor and camshafts, see 0.4.1
(ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS).
- Timing chain, chain tensioner and front and rear
cylinder timing drive assembly, see 0.4.1 (ENGINE
WORKSHOP MANUALS).
- Valves, see 0.4.1 (ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS)).
FRONT END
- Front cylinder exhaust pipe, see 7.1.53 (REMOVING
THE EXHAUST MANIFOLDS).
- Starter motor (5), see 0.4.1 (ENGINE WORKSHOP
MANUALS).
REAR END
- Exhaust removal, see 7.1.53 (REMOVING THE
EXHAUST MANIFOLDS).

3 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

LEFT-HAND SIDE RIGHT-HAND SIDE


- Rear cylinder spark plugs (6-7), see 2.7 (SPARK - Front cylinder coolant thermistor (15), see 5.4
PLUGS). (REMOVING THE COOLANT THERMISTORS).
- Drive sprocket cover (8), see 2.35.4 (DRIVE CHAIN - Front cylinder spark plugs (16-17), see 2.7 (SPARK
GUIDE PLATE INSPECTION). PLUGS).
- Gear shift lever, see 7.1.48 (REMOVING THE GEAR - Coolant pump (18), see 0.4.1 (ENGINE WORKSHOP
SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY). MANUALS).
- Rear cylinder coolant thermistor (9), see 5.4 - Engine oil pressure sensor (19).
(REMOVING THE COOLANT THERMISTORS). - Clutch cover (20) and clutch assembly, see 0.4.1
- Engine oil filter (10), see 2.13 (ENGINE OIL AND (ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS).
FILTER CHANGE).
- Neutral switch (11).
- Clutch slave cylinder (12), see 3.2.1 (CLUTCH SLAVE
CYLINDER REMOVAL).
- Flywheel cover (13) and ignition system, see 0.4.1
(ENGINE WORKSHOP MANUALS).
- Engine oil tank (14), see 7.1.55 (REMOVING THE
ENGINE OIL TANK).

RIGHT SIDE LEFT SIDE


2 4 15 16
4 17 1 3 9 6 7

12
5

19
18

20 19 14 13 10 11 8

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 5 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

3.2.1 CLUTCH SLAVE CYLINDER REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-
3
MATION) AND 1.2.5 (CLUTCH FLUID) carefully.
Š Remove the left-hand side fairing, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Remove the rectifier frame, see 2.35.4 (DRIVE CHAIN
GUIDE PLATE INSPECTION).
Š Release and remove the screws (3). 3

Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 12 Nm


(1.2 kgm).
Š Withdraw the slave cylinder assembly (2).
WARNING
Pull gently, as the slave cylinder (2) is still connected
to the clutch line.
Never operate the clutch lever with the slave cylinder 2
(2) removed, or the piston may fall out leading to loss
of clutch fluid.
To be on the safe side, secure the piston with a plas-
tic clip (see picture).
Remove the flange (1) if needed.
3

3 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

3.3 TAKING THE ENGINE OUT OF THE


FRAME

WARNING
Engine removal must be undertaken at an Authorised
Service Centre or an Authorised Aprilia Dealer.
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-
MATION) carefully.

WARNING
Engine removal is a complex operation. Plan work
ahead and identify the locations of affected parts on
the vehicle before proceeding.
Necessary removal procedures are listed in the
proper sequence in this section.
Certain procedures include cross-references to rele-
vant sections of the manual. Some of the operations
described there may not be strictly required for the
job at hand. Proceed sensibly to avoid redundant
work, that is, always make sure you really need to
remove a particular component before proceeding.
Perform the minimum operations required to give
access to the component to be serviced.
The engine is removed by lowering it from the frame.
Make sure to have all necessary equipment ready at
hand and in place before proceeding.
Dry engine weight: approximately 65 Kg.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Disconnect the battery negative lead (–) first, then the
positive lead (+).

WARNING
Reverse the order when reconnecting the leads 2
(positive (+) lead first, then negative (–) lead).
Š Remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.6 (COMPLETE
REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK).
Š Remove both side fairings, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING
THE SIDE FAIRINGS). 1
Š Remove both lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Remove the radiator spoiler, see 7.1.35 (REMOVING
THE RADIATOR SPOILER).

WARNING
Mark all wires with their original positions to avoid
confusing them when refitting.
Š Disconnect the following electrical connectors in the 3 4
order:
– generator (1);
– crankshaft position sensor (2);
– front cylinder coolant thermistor (3);
– rear cylinder coolant thermistor (4).

WARNING
Make sure to fit each connector to the matching
connector on assembly.

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 7 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

Š Release and remove the screw (5). Disconnect the


lead of the neutral switch (6).
Š Disconnect the lead at the engine oil pressure sensor
(7).

WARNING
The brake fluid reservoir (9) must remain in a vertical
position at all times to avoid loss of brake fluid.
Š Remove the clutch slave cylinder, see 3.2.1 (CLUTCH
SLAVE CYLINDER REMOVAL).
Š Remove the drive sprocket, see 7.1.57 (REMOVING
THE DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER).
Š Remove the expansion reservoir, see 5.8 (REMOVING
THE EXPANSION RESERVOIR).

ŠPull the spark plug caps off the plugs (10).


WARNING
Clean the outer surface of engine with a degreasing
detergent, brushes and rags.
Ensure that no rubber or plastic parts come in
contact with detergents and corrosive or penetrating
solvents.
Should you need a steam cleaner, do not direct
water, steam or high-pressure air jets towards any of
the following parts: wheel hubs, controls on right
and left handlebars, brake master cylinders,
instruments and indicators, silencer outlets, glove
compartment, ignition switch/steering lock, electrical
components.

3 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

Š Clean the outer surface of the engine thoroughly.


Š Remove the exhaust pipes, see 7.1.53 (REMOVING
THE EXHAUST MANIFOLDS).
ŠDisconnect the cooling fan connector (11).
Š Disconnect the warning horn wiring.
WARNING
Take care to refit each connector to the matching
connector on assembly.

WARNING
Mark hose and pipes with their relative positions to
avoid confusing them when refitting.
11
Š Remove the engine oil tank (12) - see 7.1.55 (REMOV-
ING THE ENGINE OIL TANK), together with the
engine oil cooler (13) - see 7.1.56 (OIL COOLER
REMOVAL), by disconnecting the pipes (14 - 15) at
engine end.

12

14

15

13

Š Remove the radiators (16 - 17) as an assembly -


see 5.2 (REMOVING THE RADIATORS) - complete
with cooling fans, warning horn and mounts.

16 17

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 9 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

Š Remove the throttle body assembly (18), see 4.8


(THROTTLE BODY). 18

NOTE The following operations are best done with the


three-way manifold (19) removed. See 5.7 (REMOVING 19
THE THREE-WAY MANIFOLD).

NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part


no. 0277295) ready at hand. Renew all clips on assem-
bly. Use clips of the same type fitted originally. 24
Š Release the heads of the hose clips (20 - 21 - 22).
Š Remove the thermal expansion valve (23) assembly - 22
see 5.5 (REMOVING THE THERMAL EXPANSION
VALVE) - together with the three hose couplings.
Š Pull the hose coupling (24) off the coolant pump. 20
WARNING
Release all clips securing the wires and hoses, 23
tracing each wire or hose up to opposite end.
Make sure to have enough new clips ready at hand to
secure wires and hoses properly when refitting.
Block off all openings of engine and hoses to prevent
the ingress of dirt.
Š Collect all wires in a bundle and fasten with adhesive
tape at a safe location where they will not be disturbed
when you remove the engine.

21

3 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

Š Release and remove the screws (25). Collect the plate


(26). 26

Torque wrench setting for screws (25): 40 Nm


(4.0 kgm).

25

27

29
NOTE Make sure to have the special tool (27),
part no. 8140183 (engine lifting eyebolt), a hoist (28) and
suitable slings (29) ready at hand.
27

CAUTION
Hoist (28) and slings (29) must have adequate weight
29 28
capacity in order to lift and handle the engine safely.
The engine weighs approximately 65 kg.
Š Install the engine lifting eyebolt (27) (part no. 8140183)
and secure it in place using the screws (25). 27
Š Hook the slings (29) to the hoist (28) and the eyebolt
(27) as shown in the picture.

CAUTION
Ensure that eyebolt, slings and hoist are connected
securely and stable before proceeding to the next
operations. This is to ensure that the engine is lifted
and handled in full safety.
Š Raise the hoist arm (28) until stretching the slings (29)
taut.

WARNING
Raise the hoist arm (28) just enough to support the
engine during removal of the engine-to-frame fixings.

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 11 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

NOTE Engine-to-frame fixings must be removed in this


order:
LEFT-HAND SIDE: A ➠ B ➠ C ➠ D.
RIGHT-HAND SIDE: E ➠ F ➠ G ➠ H.

A-B C D
32
30
36

31
34 33 35

C
B F
B

A G

D E

E F G-H
37 45
47
42 41
43 44
40
38

46
39

3 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

Š Release and remove the two screws (30) and collect


the washers (31). 33

Torque wrench setting for screws (30): 40 Nm


(4.0 kgm).
Š Hold the check nut (32) steady. Release and remove
the screw (33).

Torque wrench setting for check nut (32) and


screw (33): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
30
Š Collect the spacer (34).
Š Hold the check nut (35) steady. Release and remove
36
the screw (36).

Torque wrench setting for check nut (35) and


screw (36): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
Š Hold the check nut (38) steady. Release and remove
the screw (37).

Torque wrench setting for check nut (38) and


screw (37): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
41 38

Š Hold the check nut (41) steady. Release and remove


the screw (42).

Torque wrench setting for check nut (41) and


screw (42): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).

41
42

Š Slacken and remove the locknuts (43 - 39) using the


special socket (48) (cod. 8140203).

43
Torque wrench setting for locknuts (43 - 39): 42
50 Nm (5.0 kgm).

37

39

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 13 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

Š Screw out the adjusting bushes (40 - 44) until bringing


them fully home in the frame.

Torque wrench setting for adjusting bushes (40 48


- 44): 10 Nm (1.0 kgm).

WARNING
On assembly, screw in the adjusting bushes (40 - 44)
manually until bringing them fully home in the engine
and then tighten to the specified torque.
43
Š Hold the check nut (38) steady. Release and remove
the screw (37).
Š Hold the check nut (41) steady. Release and remove
the screw (42).
Š Ensure that the slings (29) are taut.
Š Release and remove the two screws (45) and collect
the washers (46).

Torque wrench setting for screws (45): 40 Nm


(4.0 kgm). 39
Š Collect the two shims (47).

43

40
44

45

46 47
45 46

3 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

CAUTION
29
The engine is now supported on the hoist only. All
fixings have been removed.
Handle with care. Be careful to avoid injury to your
hands, arms and legs.
Clear all tools from the area. Thoroughly clean the
area of the floor where the engine is to be placed.
Š Raise the hoist arm by a few millimetres to ease the
engine off the frame.
Š Lower the hoist arm until placing the engine on the
floor.
Š Secure the engine to prevent it falling over.
Š Release the hoist slings (29).
Š Remove the slings (29) from the frame.
Š Move the engine aside from under the frame.
Š Fasten the slings (29) to the engine again.

NOTE If the engine needs servicing, place it in the spe-


cial stand (8) (part no. 8140187 + 8140188).

WARNING
Unless you need to service the engine, it will be safer
when left on the floor, still fastened to slings (29) and
hoist. 8

Š Clean the outer surface of the engine thoroughly.


WARNING
Clean the outer surface of the engine with a
degreasing detergent, brushes and rags.
Ensure that no rubber or plastic parts come in
contact with detergents and corrosive or penetrating
solvents.

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 15 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

3.4 FITTING THE ENGINE IN THE FRAME


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-
MATION) carefully.
NOTE To refit the engine in the frame, reverse the
removal procedure, see 3.3 (TAKING THE ENGINE OUT
OF THE FRAME).
Before proceeding, however, you will have to perform the
operations detailed below.

CAUTION
Handle with care.
Be careful to avoid injury to hands, arms and legs.
Š Ensure that the adjusting bushes (1 - 2) are fully home
in the frame.
Š Shift the engine gradually, with minimal movements,
until engine fixing holes align perfectly with those on
the frame (A - B - C - D). 2
Once the engine is back into frame, perform the following
operations.
1

Š Ensure that all engine mounting bolts and nuts are at


the correct torque.
Š Top up coolant level, see 2.14 (CHECKING AND TOP-
PING UP COOLANT LEVEL).
Š Top up engine oil level, see 2.12 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP ENGINE OIL LEVEL).
Š If you have overhauled the engine, bleed the engine oil
circuit and check oil pressure.
Š Check chain slack and adjust as required, see 2.35.1
(CHAIN SLACK INSPECTION) and 2.35.3 (CHAIN
SLACK ADJUSTMENT).

WARNING
Inspect any parts you have removed, paying special B
attention to these components:
- wiring must be properly fastened with wire ties.

WARNING
Wires and hoses must not be twisted and/or trapped
under other parts.
- electrical connectors must be fitted to the matching D
connectors;
- hoses, pipes and couplings must be securely in place
and fastened with suitable clips;
- throttle and cold-start cables must slide smoothly A C
inside their housings and must not bind when
handlebars are turned;
- gear shift lever must be properly positioned;
- rear brake lever must be properly positioned.

3 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ENGINE

NOTES

Release 00/2001 - 11 3 - 17 - 00
ENGINE RST mille

NOTES

3 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

FUEL SYSTEM
4

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 1 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

FUEL SYSTEM

CONTENTS
4.1 FUEL TANK ..................................... 4-3-00

0
4.1.1 MAINTENANCE..................................... 4-4-00
4.1.2 INSPECTING THE FUEL LINES ........... 4-4-00
4.2 DRAINING THE FUEL TANK ........... 4-5-00
4.3 REMOVING THE FUEL PUMP

1
ASSEMBLY ...................................... 4-5-00
4.4 REMOVING THE FUEL SENSOR...... 4-6-00
4.5 REMOVING THE FUEL DELIVERY
FILTER............................................. 4-6-00

2 4.6 4.6 FUEL PUMP REMOVAL ............. 4-7-00


4.7 ENGINE MANAGEMENT .................. 4-8-00
4.7.1 GENERAL INFORMATION ................... 4-8-00
4.7.2 SENSORS.............................................. 4-9-00
3 4.7.3 FUEL INJECTION LAYOUT ................ 4-11-00
4.7.4 ENGINE CONTROL UNIT CONNECTORS 4-12-00
4.7.5 AUTOMATIC OPERATION TEST ....... 4-13-00
4.7.6 ELECTRONIC SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING
BASED ON DISPLAY INFORMATION .. 4-13-00
4 4.8 THROTTLE BODY .......................... 4-14-00
4.8.1 THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL............ 4-14-00
4.8.2 REMOVING THE INJECTORS ............ 4-15-00

5 4.9 DISMANTLING THE THROTTLE


BODY ............................................. 4-16-00
4.10 THROTTLE BODY INSPECTION .... 4-17-00
4.10.1 TESTING INJECTOR OPERATION .... 4-17-00

6
4.10.2 THROTTLE BODY............................... 4-17-00
4.10.3 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR........ 4-17-00
4.10.4 CYLINDER SYNCHRONISATION....... 4-18-00
4.10.5 SETTING THE CO RATE .................... 4-19-00
4.10.6 SETTING THE THROTTLE POSITION

7
SENSOR .............................................. 4-21-00

4 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.1 FUEL TANK


The fuel tank is fitted with a top-mounted filler cap,
whereas the tank bottom accommodates the following
components:
Š the fuel pump assembly;
Š a drain hose to drain water from the filler cap when it
rains or after washing;
Š a drain hose to drain fuel from the tank for the event it is
overfilled.

3
4
6 9

Key
1) Fuel tank 6) Fuel sensor
2) Filler cap 7) Fuel delivery filter
3) Fuel pump assembly 8) Fuel pump
4) Drain hoses 9) Fuel delivery hose
5) Fuel return hose

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 3 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-


MATION) and 1.2.1 (FUEL) carefully.

CAUTION
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure that the area is well ventilated before pro-
ceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Avoid contact with skin.
Do not smoke or use bare flames.
Do not release fuel into the environment.

4.1.1 MAINTENANCE
4
Š Each time the fuel pump assembly is removed, see 4.3
(REMOVING THE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY), it is rec- 3
ommended that you inspect the hoses (1 - 2 - 3) and
test:
- fuel sensor (4), see 6.10.5 (FUEL SENSOR); and
- fuel pump (5), see 6.7.2 (FUEL PUMP TEST) for 5
proper operation.
Š Change the fuel delivery filter (6).
6
NOTE It is recommended that you also wash the fuel
tank thoroughly.
1

4.1.2 INSPECTING THE FUEL LINES


Check the fuel lines every 7500 km (4687 mi) or 8
months; renew every 4 years. 3 1
2
CAUTION
Pay special attention to the delivery (1) and return (2)
hoses and fittings. The operating pressure of the
delivery hose (1) is approximately 450 Kpa (4.5 bar).
Always renew a cracked or cut fuel hose.
If fuel leaks past the flange (3), it means that the O-ring
(4) might be damaged. When this is the case:
Š Remove the fuel pump assembly, see 4.3 (REMOV-
ING THE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY) Inspect the O-ring
and replace as required.
NOTE See 6.7.2 (FUEL PUMP TEST) for more details.

4 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.2 DRAINING THE FUEL TANK


See 2.9 (DRAINING THE FUEL TANK) for instructions
on how to drain the fuel tank.

4.3 REMOVING THE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR- 1
MATION), 1.2.1 (FUEL) and 4.1.1 (MAINTENANCE)
carefully.
Š Remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.6 (COMPLETE
REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK).

WARNING
Handle the fuel tank with care. Do not scratch or
damage the paintwork.
NOTE Place the fuel tank on a clean surface with the
fuel pump assembly pointing upwards.
Š Release and remove the screws (1).
NOTE On assembly, turn in all screws until finger tight,
and then tighten to the specified torque in a cross pat-
tern.
3
Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 6 Nm
(0.6 kgm).

WARNING
Take care not to damage the fuel lines and the fuel
sensor (3) when removing the fuel pump assembly
(2).
Š Remove the fuel pump assembly (2).
WARNING
2
On assembly, make sure the clip head (4) is pointing
away from the fuel sensor (5), or the clip (4) may con-
tact the fuel delivery hose in operation.
Apply Loctite® 518 to the O-ring (6) before refitting.

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 5 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

4.4 REMOVING THE FUEL SENSOR


Š Remove the fuel pump assembly, see 4.3 (REMOV-
ING THE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY).
Š Disconnect the connector (1).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Ease the fuel sensor (2) out of the mount (3) levering
with a screwdriver.

4.5 REMOVING THE FUEL DELIVERY FILTER


3
Š Remove the fuel pump assembly, see 4.3 (REMOV- 6
ING THE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY). 1
Š Release and remove the screw (6) to release the
ground cable.
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part 4
no. 0277295) ready at hand. Renew all clips on assem-
bly. Use clips of the same type fitted originally.
Š Release the head of the hose pressure clip (1-2).
Š Pull the hose (3) off the filter (4). 2
Š Detach the filter (4) from the hose (5). 5
WARNING
Never reuse a fuel filter.
Š Install a new filter (4) of the same type fitted originally.

4 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.6 4.6 FUEL PUMP REMOVAL


Š Remove the fuel pump assembly, see 4.3 (REMOV-
ING THE FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY). 4
Š Disconnect the connector (1).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching 1
connector on assembly.
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. Renew all clips on assem-
bly. Use clips of the same type fitted originally. 2

Š Release the clip head (2). 3


Š Detach the fuel hose (4) from the pump (3).
Š Release and remove the three screws (5).
WARNING
Take care not to pull or twist any electrical wires
when performing the operations described below.

Š Remove the circlip (6) from the mesh filter (7).


7
WARNING 6
Install a new circlip (6) of the same type on assembly.
Š Remove the mesh filter (7).
WARNING
Remove any residue or build-up from the meshing (7)
blowing with an air line.
Š Withdraw the fuel pump (3) from the opposite end 3
using a screwdriver.

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 7 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

4.7 ENGINE MANAGEMENT

4.7.1 GENERAL INFORMATION


Engine operation is managed by an on-board computer
(Engine Control Unit) to guarantee optimal ignition and
fuel injection.
Š Ignition is managed according to consumption.
Š The ECU determines the exact ignition timing accord-
ing to engine rpm and throttle position (the latter gives
a measure of intake air quantity).
Š The ECU determines injection timing (quantity of fuel)
according to rpm, throttle signal (quantity of air, pres-
sure in the intake duct) and to the correction factors
signalled by the various sensors.
Š At each start-up, the ECU tests sensors and ignition
coils for proper operation. Any fault detected at this
time will turn on a flashing “EFI” message on the dis-
play.
Š Safety devices built into the ECU shut down the ignition
and fuel injection systems whenever engine speed
rises beyond the maximum rpm allowed, that is 10,500
rpm, or when the motorcycle falls over. When the
motorcycle is on the side stand and a gear is engaged,
ignition is inhibited to prevent the rider moving off in a
dangerous condition.

WARNING
Any changes or modifications to the exhaust system,
intake system or Engine Control Unit may result in
severe engine damage. Installing, making changes to
or using any parts other than original parts makes all
warranty rights null and void. The Manufacturer shall
not be liable for any resulting damage to property or
injury to persons.

4 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.7.2 SENSORS
Camshaft position sensor (1) 1
Location: housed in flywheel cover (2).
This sensor detects the movement of a pre-determined
phonic wheel on the crankshaft. The phonic wheel is
characterised by an individual length, which is three 2
times the distance/air gap, to provide a reference point on
the wheel. This reference point is used to determine
crankshaft position.
In four-stroke engines, this individual reference point is
not sufficient to determine whether a cylinder that is
approaching the top dead centre (TDC) position is in the
combustion or exhaust stroke. Such accuracy requires
more details of the position, which are obtained through a
particular engine speed variation strategy.
Engine position information is used to determine engine
speed and to control those operations that need to be
synchronised with engine rotation, such as fuel injection.

Intake air pressure sensor


Location: built into Engine Control Unit (3).
3
This is a piezoelectric sensor. The sensor is connected to
the air space through a narrow tube and measures abso-
lute air pressure. The take-up point is located in a suita-
ble position where pressure variation due to engine
induction is at a minimum. Nominal pressure inside the
air space is equal to atmospheric pressure. The pressure
in the air space compensates for any load variations
within the fuel system.

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 9 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

Throttle position sensor (4)


Location: throttle body (5).
This sensor is a potentiometer. Throttle position is deter-
mined by comparing output voltage to supply voltage (rat-
ing is 5 V) for greater accuracy.
As the throttle opens, the sensor output voltage
increases in a linear pattern. The throttle provides the
most effective means to control engine operation, as it
determines how much air is let through for the engine to
take in. The position (or angle) of throttle is used to deter-
mine load and tells the system whether the rider is trying
to accelerate or slow down.

5 4

Engine temperature sensor (6)


The engine temperature sensor is a negative-resistance 6
thermistor. This means that sensor resistance decreases
as temperature increases. The sensor is conveniently
located to provide an accurate indication of engine oper-
ating temperature. The EMS compensates for the varying
engine characteristic in the different engine temperature
ranges. This is because an engine needs varying
amounts of fuel depending on whether it is started up
from cold or when already warm.

Intake air temperature sensor


Location: left-hand air scoop (7).
The density of intake air varies with air temperature. This
affects engine useful load and subsequently the amount
of fuel required. An additional adjustment is needed to
minimise the risk of knocking due to hot intake air.

4 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.7.3 FUEL INJECTION LAYOUT

Kill
Switch +
- +
M COOLING FAN 1
BATTERY -
+

M
M PWONLY
COOLING FAN 2
-
+

M FUEL PUMP

0.5 mm² -
Raychem 67

P1 H1
P2 F3
Vign P2 E1

Vbat P1H4
P2 G1
P2 G2
+VE
CAMSHAFT POSITION P1 A1 EXHAUST
SENSOR VALVE
P1 B1 P1G1
-VE

COOLANT P1 B2 FRONT CYLINDER


THERMISTOR INJECTOR
P1H3

P1 D1
MC 1000 REAR CYLINDER
AIR THERMISTOR
INJECTOR
ECM P1H2

+VE P1 B3
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR SIG P1 E3
+VE
P1 E4

Supply via
Engine position sensor ignition switch
(prototypes only)
P2 C1
+VE

SIG

-VE
INJECTOR NO. 1
AIR P2H1
PRESSURE
SENSOR
(IN ECU)
INJECTOR NO. 2
P2H4
P1 D2
Tilt switch

INJECTOR NO. 3
P2 H2

Supply via
Instrument
ignition switch INJECTOR NO. 4
Cluster
P2 H3
Diagnostics signal P1 D4
D
Engine rotation P2 A1 D
P1 F1 C
Test switch P1 F2 C
P2 D3
B STEPPER
P1 E2 B
A MOTOR
P1 E1 A
Test switch

3 CAN_H
Clutch, neutral Neutral P2 D2 11 CAN_L
and side stand DIAGNOSTIC LINE K Diagnostics
Side stand P2 A2 7 ISO 9141 K
SECTION 2.3 P2 C2 P2 B2 connectors
15 ISO 9141 L J1962
DIAGNOSTIC LINE L
16 12V Batt. + ve.
SECTION 3.1
4

Power ground pins


P1G4,P2G3,P2G4 P2 C4 Frame ground

- +

BATTERY

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 11 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

4.7.4 ENGINE CONTROL UNIT CONNECTORS


See 6.6 (HOOK-UP DIAGRAM OF ENGINE CONTROL
UNIT) for more details.

65 PINK-WHITE
80 BROWN
52 YELLOW-BLACK
55 BROWN-GREEN
53 YELLOW-BLACK 28 GREY-WHITE
H G F E D C B A
51 ORANGE-WHITE 47 BROWN-PINK
1 1
50 GREEN-LIGHT BLUE 27 BLUE-ORANGE
2 2
49 ORANGE-LIGHT BLUE
3 3
48 YELLOW-BLUE
4 4
H G F E D C B A

20 BLUE-GREEN 22 BLUE-GREEN
54 BLACK 62 GREY

21 BLUE-GREEN 23 BLUE-GREEN

30 BLUE-GREEN
SOLDERED TO SHIELDING OF THE
TWO WIRES, HEAT-SHRINK
PROTECTION

40 PINK 36 RED-BLACK

43 LIGHT BLUE 2 BLUE


41 PURPLE
35 PINK-BLACK
42 YELLOW

H G F E D C B A
44 BLUE-WHITE 1 RED
1 1
46 GREEN-GREY
2 2
45 GREY-RED
3 3
17 RED-BROWN
4 4
H G F E D C B A

37 BROWN-YELLOW

38 BROWN-WHITE

19 BLUE-GREEN
25 BLUE-BLACK
26 PURPLE-BROWN

31 BLUE-RED 39 WHITE-PURPLE

4 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.7.5 AUTOMATIC OPERATION TEST


See 6.5 (IGNITION/INJECTION SYSTEM).

4.7.6 ELECTRONIC SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING


BASED ON DISPLAY INFORMATION

CAUTION
Be careful: the ignition system is under high voltage.
Never disconnect the connectors while the engine is
running.
Unless expressly specified otherwise in the relevant
sections of the manual, always take the following
precautions before servicing the ignition system: set
the ignition switch to “ ” and disconnect the battery
(disconnect the battery negative lead “ ” first).

WARNING
All measurements must be taken with the compo-
nents at 20°C (68°F).
General troubleshooting advice: locate fault and
remove defective component.
Š When the “EFI” light comes on while riding, it means
that the engine control unit has detected a fault.
FAULT CODE TABLE:

Fault code Description of fault


12 Crankshaft position sensor (pick-up) fault
15 Throttle position sensor (TPS) fault
18 CALIFORNIA ONLY
21 Engine temperature sensor fault
22 Air temperature sensor fault
23 Atmospheric pressure sensor fault
33 Coil no. 1 fault
34 Coil no. 2 fault
35 Coil no. 3 fault
36 Coil no. 4 fault
41 Bank angle sensor signal fault
42 Injector no. 1 fault
43 Injector no. 2 fault

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 13 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

4.8 THROTTLE BODY

WARNING
The throttle body linkage cannot be adjusted or
removed individually. In the event of a malfunction,
replace the complete throttle body assembly,
see 4.8.1 (THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL).
The two screws M4x12 (4) securing the throttle posi-
tion sensor are coated with paint at the factory and
may only be removed when replacing the sensor.

4.8.1 THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR- 1
MATION) carefully. 2
Š Partially remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.5 (PARTIAL
REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK).
Š Remove the airbox, see 7.1.8 (AIRBOX REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the connectors of:
- - right-hand injector (1);
- - left-hand injector (2);
- - throttle position sensor (3).

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connectors to the matching
connectors on assembly.
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. Renew all clips on assem- 6
bly. Use clips of the same type fitted originally. 3

Š Release the heads of the clips (4-5).


Š Disconnect the hoses (7-8) from the throttle body (6).

5
7

Š Disconnect the two throttle cables (9-10).


9
WARNING
Ensure that the two cable adjusters are correctly fas-
tened to the matching connections on assembly.
Check for play and adjust as required, see 2.11.3
(THROTTLE CABLE PLAY ADJUSTMENT).

10

4 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

Š Disconnect the pressure regulator tube (11).


Š Slacken the two clips (14 - 15).
WARNING
The throttle body (6) is still connected to the fuel tank
(13) through the fuel line (12). Take care not to dam- 14
age the fuel line when removing the throttle body.
Clean the two intake flanges thoroughly before
removing the throttle body, or dirt may fall into the
15
cylinders.
Š Grasp the throttle body (6) firmly, ease it out in small
alternating motions and then lift clear of the intake
manifolds.
Š Place the throttle body assembly (6) and the fuel tank 11
(13), which are still connected to one another, on a
clean surface.
Š Block off the intake manifolds to prevent dirt entering
into the cylinders.

WARNING
On assembly:
- Ensure the fuel delivery hose (12) is not twisted
and is routed clear of any components that might
13
trap it underneath. Renew the hose if damaged or
deteriorated.
- Route the fuel delivery hose (12) between the two 6
intake flanges, then under the throttle body and up
to the opposite (right-hand) side of the throttle
body (6).
- The throttle body (6) must be properly seated on 12
the intake flanges.
- The clips (14 - 15) must be tightened securely.
In the event the throttle body (6) has been replaced, set
the throttle position sensor. See 4.10.6 (SETTING THE
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR).

4.8.2 REMOVING THE INJECTORS


See 4.8.1 (THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL).
See 6.6.1 (INJECTOR TEST) for inspection instruc-
tions.

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 15 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

4.9 DISMANTLING THE THROTTLE BODY


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR-
MATION) carefully.
Š Drain the fuel tank, see 2.9 (DRAINING THE FUEL
TANK). 2
Š Remove the throttle body assembly, see 4.8.1
(THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the two screws (1). 1

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 3.5 Nm


(0.35 kgm). 3
Š Remove the fuel pressure regulator (2) together with 4
5
O-ring (3), left-hand injector (4) and O-ring (5).
Š Release and remove the two screws (6).

Torque wrench setting for screws (6): 3.5 Nm 6


(0.35 kgm).
Š Remove the fuel duct (7) together with O-ring (8), right-
hand injector (9) and O-ring (10). 7

10

8
9

Š Release and remove the two screws (11).

Torque wrench setting for screws (11): 1.2 Nm


(0.12 kgm).
Š Remove the potentiometer (12). 11
NOTE Renew all seals on assembly. Spare seals are
included in the repair kit. 12
WARNING
The throttle body linkage cannot be adjusted or
removed individually. In the event of a malfunction,
replace the throttle body assembly, see 4.8.1
(THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL).

4 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.10 THROTTLE BODY INSPECTION

4.10.1 TESTING INJECTOR OPERATION

CAUTION
Fuel is explosive and highly flammable.
Keep fuel away from any sources of ignition, heat or
flames.
NOTE Injectors may also be inspected in the machine.
Check the following components:
- wiring and connections;
- injector or ECU injection signal, see 6.5 (IGNITION/
INJECTION SYSTEM).
Injector resistance test:
See 6.6.1 (INJECTOR TEST).

4.10.2 THROTTLE BODY

WARNING
Use only neutral detergents.
Clean with a sealing compound remover, a degreaser
or a detergent for cold cleaning.
Š Blowall openings and ducts of the throttle body with
compressed air.

4.10.3 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR

WARNING 1
The two socket-head screws securing the throttle 2
position sensor (potentiometer) (1) are coated with
paint at the factory and must not be disturbed. The
throttle position sensor can only be set when
installed from new, that is when it is replaced.
Š Position the throttle position sensor (1) to the throttle
spindle. Place the sensor in a horizontal position and
rotate downwards.
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the threads of the
screws (2). 2
Š Tighten the two screws M4x12 (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 3.5 Nm


(0.35 kgm).
Š To line up the throttle position sensor (1), see 4.10.6
(SETTING THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR).

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 17 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

4.10.4 CYLINDER SYNCHRONISATION


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND INFOR- 1
MATION) and 1.2.1 (FUEL) carefully.
Erratic idling is a sign of improper cylinder synchronisa-
tion.
The cylinders must be synchronised before setting the
CO rate, see 4.10.5 (SETTING THE CO RATE).
Š Take a short ride (allow a few kilometres’ riding dis-
tance) to warm engine up to normal operating tempera-
ture. 4

WARNING
The cylinders must be synchronised with a hot 5
engine:
Š Coolant temperature should be 75-90 °C (167-194 °F).
Š Room temperature should be 20-30 °C (68-86 °F).
NOTE Make sure to have a vacuum gauge (1) ready at
hand (part no. 8140256).
3
CAUTION
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure the room is well ventilated before proceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Avoid contact with skin.
Do not smoke or use bare flames.
Do not release fuel into the environment.
2
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
Š Extract the two service hoses (2) located under the
side panel on the left-hand side of the motorcycle.
Š Take off the blanking caps and connect the two service
hoses (2) to the vacuum gauge lines (1) using two 6-
mm fittings.
Š Turn the two air by-pass screws (3) of the throttle body
fully in.
Š Start the engine and use the vacuum gauge (1) to
measure vacuum in the front cylinder with the tap (4)
open and tap (5) closed.
Š Close the tap (4) and open the tap (5) of the vacuum
gauge (1). Measure vacuum in the rear cylinder.
Š When vacuum is not the same in both cylinders, the
cylinders must be synchronised. This is done by work-
ing the air by-pass screws (3).
Š Turn out the air by-pass screw (3) of the cylinder that
has greater vacuum until setting the same vacuum as
in the other cylinder. Allowed tolerance is ± 5 millibar.

4 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.10.5 SETTING THE CO RATE


Š Remove the radiator spoiler, see 7.1.35 (REMOV- 2
ING THE RADIATOR SPOILER).

WARNING
The CO rate must be set with a hot engine.
Š Coolant temperature should be 75-90 °C (167-194 °F). 1
NOTE Make sure to have the following special tools
ready at hand :
- exhaust emission analyser (1) (part no. 8140196);
- analyser tubing kit (2) (part no. 8140202).
- meter Axone 2000 (5) (part no. 8140595).
5 7
CAUTION
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure the room is well ventilated before proceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Avoid contact with skin.
Do not smoke or use bare flames.
Do not release fuel into the environment.
Š Release and remove the two capscrews (3-4) on the
front and rear exhaust pipes.
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® 8150 to the threads of the cap-
screws (3-4) before refitting. 3
Š Connect the analyser tubes supplied with the kit (2) as
follows:
- attach the two pipes to the take-up points on the 4
exhaust pipes;
- connect the other tube to the exhaust emission ana-
lyser (1).
Š Ensure that idling speed is 1250 ± 100 rpm. Adjust if
needed, see 2.11.2 (IDLING ADJUSTMENT)). 6
Š The analyser (1) should give the same CO reading for
both cylinders. In addition, the CO reading should com-
ply with the specified value.
Specified CO rate for both cylinders:
- 1.5 - 2% at 1250 ± 100 rpm.
Specified CO rate for both cylinders USA :
- 1 – 1.5% at 1250 ± 100 rpm.
Š Insert the “OBD” module (7) into the meter Axone
2000.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Connect the meter Axone 2000 (5) to the connector (6)
placed underneath the seat. To feed the meter Axone
2000 (5), connect to the motorcycle battery.
Š Begin with the rear cylinder.
Š Turn on the Axone 2000 (5) pressing the red on/off but-
ton. ARROW UP

Š Select the Auto-diagnosis icon on the display and press


the Enter key. BACK
ENTER
Š The screen that appears next holds a set of ECU LEFT ARROW RIGHT ARROW
parameters.
Š Press the + key or the – key and select the option “Idle ARROW DOWN
"+" KEY
fuelling adjustment” using the UP and DOWN arrow
keys. Press Enter to confirm. "-" KEY
ON / OFF

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 19 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

Š The top portion of the display shows a parameter given


in percentage. This is not the CO rate. Do not compare 2
this parameter with the CO reading displayed by the
exhaust emission analyser (1).
Š Press the UP and DOWN arrow keys to modify the
parameter on the Axone 2000 display as required.
Increase this parameter to extend injection duration.
This will enrich the fuel mixture and the CO rate will 1
increase accordingly. Conversely, decrease the param-
eter to decrease the CO rate.

WARNING
Adjust gradually. Press the key a couple of times
(two or three maximum), and then wait for the CO 5 7
reading on the analyser display (1) to stabilise.
Ensure that the tubing (2) used to connect motorcy-
cle exhaust to analyser is the adequate length (1.5 m
to 3 m).
Check the CO rate on the both exhaust pipes. The dif-
ference between the two readings should not exceed
1%.
NOTE If all attempts to set the CO rate to the specified
value fail, change the spark plugs, see 2.7 (SPARK
PLUGS).

4 - 20 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
FUEL SYSTEM

4.10.6 SETTING THE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR


1
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Connect the meter Axone 2000 (1) to the connec-
tor (2) placed underneath the seat. To feed the meter
Axone 2000 (1), connect to the motorcycle battery.
Š Start the engine.
Š Turn on the Axone 2000 (1) pressing the red on/off but-
ton.
Š Select the Auto-diagnosis icon on the display and press
the Enter key.
Š The screen that appears next holds a set of ECU
parameters.
Š Press the + key or the – key and select the option
“Closed Throttle Position” using the UP and DOWN
arrow keys. Press Enter to confirm.
Š A reference parameter for throttle alignment appears in
the top portion of the display. Use the UP arrow key to
increase the parameter until it stabilises. When this
occurs, the Engine Control Unit will recognise a steady
idling condition and switch to auto-adaptive mode.
Š Press the Enter key and exit the menu.

ARROW UP

BACK
ENTER
LEFT ARROW RIGHT ARROW

ARROW DOWN
"+" KEY

"-" KEY
ON / OFF

Release 00/2001 - 11 4 - 21 - 00
FUEL SYSTEM RST mille

NOTES

4 - 22 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
COOLING SYSTEM

COOLING SYSTEM 5

Release 00/2001 - 11 5 - 1 - 00
COOLING SYSTEM RST mille

COOLING SYSTEM

CONTENTS
5.1 DESCRIPTION ................................. 5-3-00

0 5.2 REMOVING THE RADIATORS ......... 5-5-00


5.3 REMOVING THE COOLING FANS.... 5-6-00
5.4 REMOVING THE COOLANT
THERMISTORS ................................ 5-7-00

1 5.5 REMOVING THE THERMAL EXPANSION


VALVE ............................................. 5-8-00
5.6 REMOVING THE FILLER ................. 5-8-00

2 5.7 REMOVING THE THREE-WAY


MANIFOLD....................................... 5-9-00
5.8 REMOVING THE EXPANSION
RESERVOIR ..................................... 5-9-00

5 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
COOLING SYSTEM

5.1 DESCRIPTION “LOW” and “FULL” level marks facilitate coolant level
inspection and top-up, see 2.14 (CHECKING AND
An engine-driven centrifugal pump accommodated in the
TOPPING UP COOLANT LEVEL).
engine circulates coolant through the system. The pump
See 1.2.4 (COOLANT) for more details on coolant.
takes in the coolant and directs it through the ducts into
the cylinders and cylinder heads to cool down engine
internals.
At engine outlet end, coolant is directed through different
routes depending on engine temperature.
When coolant expands from heat, the expansion
reservoir takes up excess coolant.

6
3
4

1 2

10
5

4
7
21
4 8

20
13 14 11
19 9

18
12
17

16
15

Key
1) Front cylinder thermistor 14) Left-hand radiator fan
2) Rear cylinder thermistor 15) Left-hand radiator (vertical flow)
3) Breather tube 16) Right-hand radiator (vertical flow)
4) Balance tubing 17) Right-hand radiator fan
5) Filler cap hose 18) Thermal expansion valve to pump hose
6) Filler cap 19) Right-hand radiator to thermal expansion valve hose
7) Engine to thermal expansion valve pipe (on right- 20) Three-way thermal expansion valve (heat-sensitive
hand side of engine) wax pellet type)
8) Rear cylinder pipe – three-way manifold 21) Centrifugal pump
9) Front cylinder pipe – three-way manifold = Coolant flows in this direction when
10) Expansion reservoir thermal expansion valve is open
11) Three-way manifold
12) Three-way manifold to left-hand radiator hose = Coolant flows in this direction when
13) Radiator union thermal expansion valve is closed

Release 00/2001 - 11 5 - 3 - 00
COOLING SYSTEM RST mille

Coolant circulation when coolant temperature is


below 75°C (167 °F).
The pump circulates coolant to the ducts (thermistors
detect temperature, temperature reading appears on
right-hand display of instrument panel) – coolant flows B
out of ducts (on right-hand side of engine) to thermal
expansion valve (valve is fully closed) and back to the
pump. A C

Coolant circulation when coolant temperature is


between 75°C (167 °F) and 80°C (176 °F).
The pump circulates coolant to the ducts (thermistors
detect temperature, temperature reading appears on
right-hand display of instrument panel) – coolant flows B C D
out of ducts (at the same time, coolant flows out of duct
on right-hand side of engine, and direct to thermal
expansion valve) to three-way manifold of left radiator – B1
through right radiator – to thermal expansion valve (valve
is opening gradually) and back to the pump. A E
G F

Coolant circulation when coolant temperature


exceeds 80°C (176 °F).
The pump circulates coolant to the ducts (thermistors
detect temperature, temperature reading appears on
right-hand display of instrument panel) – coolant flows A B C
out of ducts - three-way manifold (thermal switch detects
temperature; switch signals cooling fans to turn on when
temperature exceeds 100°C (212 °F)/to shut down when
temperature drops below 85°C (185 °F) – through left G
radiator – through right radiator – to thermal expansion D
valve (valve is fully open) and back to pump. F E
WARNING
When the ignition switch is set to “ ”, the cooling
fans switch off regardless of coolant temperature.

5 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
COOLING SYSTEM

5.2 REMOVING THE RADIATORS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT) carefully. 3
NOTE The instructions provided below apply to both
1
radiators.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Drain all coolant from the cooling circuit, see 2.15
(COOLANT CHANGE).
Š Disconnect the connector (1). 2

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Remove the radiator spoiler, see 7.1.35 (REMOVING
THE RADIATOR SPOILER).
Š Remove the lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING 6
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Remove both air scoops, see 7.1.30 (REMOVING THE
LEFT-HAND AIR SCOOP) and 7.1.31 (REMOVING 4
THE RIGHT-HAND AIR SCOOP).
Š Slacken the clip (2) and slide it out of the way.
Š Detach the hose (3) from the radiator (4).
Š Slacken the clip (5) and slide it out of the way.
Š Detach the hose (6) from the radiator (4). 8
7
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. On refitting, renew all clips
using the same type fitted originally. 5
Š Release the head of the hose clip (7).
Š Detach the tube (8) from the radiator (4).
Š Release and remove the screw (9). Collect the bush
and seal (10), where fitted. 10
NOTE Change the seal (10) if damaged.
WARNING
Handle the radiators carefully taking care not to
damage the fins.
Š Tilt the radiator (4) slightly forward and lift until the two
bottom mounting bosses (12-13) are clear of their
holes in the radiator bracket (11).
Š Remove the radiator (4) complete with cooling fan.
9
WARNING 4
Block off the openings of the hoses to prevent the
ingress of dirt.
NOTE Change the grommets (14) if damaged.
If necessary:
Š Remove the cooling fan, see 5.3 (REMOVING THE
COOLING FANS).

WARNING 12
Remove any build-up, dirt, etc. caught between the
radiator fins blowing with compressed air. Straighten
any bent fins using a small Phillips screwdriver. 14
13
Renew the hoses (3-6) if cracked or sheared.
Before refitting the radiator, wash it inside using
clean water only. 14
11

Release 00/2001 - 11 5 - 5 - 00
COOLING SYSTEM RST mille

5.3 REMOVING THE COOLING FANS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
NOTE The instructions provided below apply to both 1
cooling fans.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the side fairing to give access to the cooling
fan, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Disconnect the connector (1).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Release and remove the two screws (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 6 Nm 3


(0.6 kgm).
Š Collect the two nuts (3).
Š Tilt the cooling fan assembly (4) slightly backwards
while pulling in an outward direction until releasing the 2
lug on the inside face from its seat in the radiator (5).
Š Remove the cooling fan (4).
3 2
NOTE Change the rubber seal (6) if damaged.
If necessary:
Š Release and remove the three screws (7) and collect
the washers.

Torque wrench setting for screws (7): 1 Nm


(0.1 kgm).
Š Take off the guard (8) of the cooling fan motor (9).
NOTE Remove the other cooling fan, too, if needed. 6
See 6.9 (COOLING FANS) for more details of the cooling
fans.

5 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
COOLING SYSTEM

5.4 REMOVING THE COOLANT


THERMISTORS
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT)carefully.
NOTE The procedure described below applies to both
thermistors.
3
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
Š Slacken the two clips (1-2).
WARNING
The throttle body (3) is still connected to wires and 1 2
tubes, proceed carefully when removing it.
Š Grasp the throttle body (3) complete with airbox firmly,
ease it out in small alternating motions and lift until
releasing the throttle body from the intake flanges.
Š Slide the assembly aside, placing it on the left-hand
side of the motorcycle.
5
Š Disconnect the connector (4).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (4) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Release and remove the thermistor (5).
Š Collect a new thermistor and apply LOCTITE® 574 to
the thread.
Š Screw in the new thermistor (5) until finger tight then
tighten.
Š If any coolant has been spilled out during the process, 4
top up level when finished. See 2.14 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP COOLANT LEVEL).
NOTE Remove the other thermistor, if needed.
See 6.6.5 (COOLANT THERMISTOR TEST) for more
details of the thermistors.

Release 00/2001 - 11 5 - 7 - 00
COOLING SYSTEM RST mille

5.5 REMOVING THE THERMAL EXPANSION


VALVE 6

Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND


INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT) carefully. 4
Š Drainthe cooling system, see 2.15 (COOLANT
CHANGE). 3
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. On refitting, renew all clips
using the same type fitted originally. 7
2
Š Release the head of the hose clip (1).
Š Detach the hose (2) at the thermal expansion valve (3). 1
Š Loosen the clips (4-5). 5
Š Grasp the thermal expansion valve (3) and pull it clear
of the two hoses (6-7) in small motions.

WARNING
Block off the openings of the hoses to prevent the
ingress of dirt.

5.6 REMOVING THE FILLER 6


1
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT) carefully. 7
Š Drainthe cooling system, see 2.15 (COOLANT
CHANGE).
4
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. On refitting, renew all clips 8
using the same type fitted originally. 3
Š Release the heads of the hose clips (1-2).
Š Detach the hoses (3-5) from the filler (4). 2

WARNING 5
Block off the open ends of the hoses (3-5) to prevent
the ingress of dirt.
Š Slide the hose clip (6) out of the way.
Š Detach the hose (7) from the filler (4).
Š Release and remove the screw (8) and collect the
bush.
Š Remove the filler (4).

5 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
COOLING SYSTEM

5.7 REMOVING THE THREE-WAY MANIFOLD


5 6
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT) carefully.
3
Š Perform the first four steps of the procedure described 4
in subsection 5.4 (REMOVING THE COOLANT
THERMISTORS). 7
Š Drain the cooling system, see 2.15 (COOLANT 1 2
CHANGE).
8
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. On refitting, renew all clips
using the same type fitted originally. 9
Š Release the heads of the hose clips (1-2-3).
Š Detach the three hoses (4-5-6) from the manifold (7).
Š Loosen the hose clip (8) and push it downwards.
Š Grasp the manifold (7) and ease if off the hose (9) in
small motions.

WARNING
Block off the open ends of the hoses to prevent the
ingress of dirt.

5.8 REMOVING THE EXPANSION RESERVOIR


2
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 1.2.4 (COOLANT) carefully.
Š Remove the right-hand side fairing panel, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. On refitting, renew all clips
using the same type fitted originally. 1 3

Š Loosen the hose clip (1) and slide it out of the way.
Š Detach the hose (2) from the filler (3).
Š Bend the hose (2) over and secure it to the top of the
expansion reservoir using adhesive tape.
Š Release and remove the two retaining screws (4-5) and
collect the two bushes.
Š Remove the expansion reservoir (6) keeping it level.
Š Replace the inner and outer sponge elements if dam- 5
aged.

WARNING 6
Coolant is harmful to the human body.
Store the expansion reservoir (6) in a safe place.
KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN.

Release 00/2001 - 11 5 - 9 - 00
COOLING SYSTEM RST mille

NOTES

5 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
6

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 1 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 6.10 INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS 6-29-00


6.10.1 WIRING DIAGRAM .............................. 6-29-00
6.10.2 AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR........... 6-30-00
6.10.3 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR.... 6-31-00
CONTENTS 6.10.4 SPEED SENSOR ................................. 6-32-00
6.10.5 FUEL SENSOR.................................... 6-33-00
6.1 LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL 6.10.6 COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR 6-34-00

0
COMPONENTS................................. 6-3-00
6.11 LIGHT SYSTEM ............................. 6-35-00
6.2 FOREWORD ..................................... 6-5-00
6.11.1 WIRING DIAGRAM .............................. 6-35-00
6.2.1 WIRING COLOUR CODES.................... 6-5-00 6.11.2 LIGHT RELAY TEST ........................... 6-36-00
6.2.2 ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS .............. 6-5-00
6.12 VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING

1
6.3 CHARGE SYSTEM INSPECTION ..... 6-6-00 SYSTEM......................................... 6-37-00
6.3.1 CHECKING CHARGE VOLTAGE ......... 6-6-00 6.12.1 WIRING DIAGRAM.............................. 6-37-00
6.3.2 ALTERNATOR LOADLESS OPERATION 6.12.2 WARNING HORN TEST ...................... 6-38-00
TEST ...................................................... 6-6-00 6.12.3 FLASHER TEST .................................. 6-38-00
6.3.3 CHARGE SYSTEM LAYOUT ................ 6-7-00

2 6.3.4 ALTERNATOR CONTINUITY TEST ..... 6-7-00


6.3.5 RECTIFIER TEST .................................. 6-8-00
6.13 VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING
SYSTEM......................................... 6-39-00
6.13.1 WIRING DIAGRAM .............................. 6-39-00
6.4 INJECTION SYSTEM ....................... 6-9-00
6.13.2 SWITCHES .......................................... 6-40-00
6.4.1 INJECTION SUPPLY WIRING DIAGRAM 6-9-00

3 6.4.2 TROUBLESHOOTING........................... 6-9-00 6.14 BATTERY....................................... 6-41-00


6.4.3 INJECTION RELAY TEST................... 6-10-00 6.14.1 FIRST-TIME INSTALLATION.............. 6-41-00
6.4.4 BANK ANGLE SENSOR TEST ........... 6-10-00 6.14.2 MAINTENANCE................................... 6-43-00
6.14.3 INSPECTION ....................................... 6-43-00
6.5 IGNITION/INJECTION SYSTEM .... 6-11-00
6.14.4 RETURN UNDER WARRANTY........... 6-43-00

4
6.5.1 TROUBLESHOOTING......................... 6-12-00
6.5.2 IN THE EVENT OF A FAULT .............. 6-12-00 6.15 BULB REPLACEMENT ................... 6-44-00
6.5.3 FAULT CODES.................................... 6-12-00 6.15.1 HEADLIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT . 6-44-00
6.5.4 ELECTRONIC SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING 6.15.2 REPLACING THE FRONT DIRECTION
BASED ON DISPLAY INFORMATION .. 6-13-00 INDICATOR BULBS ............................ 6-46-00

5 6.6 HOOK-UP DIAGRAM OF ENGINE


CONTROL UNIT............................. 6-14-00
6.15.3 TAIL LIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT .. 6-46-00
6.15.4 REPLACING THE NUMBER PLATE
LIGHT BULBS ..................................... 6-47-00
6.6.1 INJECTOR TEST................................. 6-16-00
6.6.2 AUTOMATIC AIR ADJUSTMENT 6.16 REPLACING THE FUSES ............... 6-48-00

6
MOTOR ................................................ 6-16-00 6.17 BEAM HEIGHT SETTING ............... 6-49-00
6.6.3 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST. 6-17-00
6.6.4 AIR THERMISTOR TEST .................... 6-18-00 6.18 BEAM CENTRING ......................... 6-49-00
6.6.5 COOLANT THERMISTOR TEST......... 6-19-00
6.19 WIRING DIAGRAM - RST MILLE
6.6.6 IGNITION COIL TEST.......................... 6-20-00
FUTURA......................................... 6-50-00

7
6.6.7 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
TEST .................................................... 6-20-00
6.7 FUEL PUMP SYSTEM .................... 6-21-00
6.7.1 WIRING DIAGRAM.............................. 6-21-00

8
6.7.2 FUEL PUMP TEST .............................. 6-22-00
6.7.3 TEST OF FUEL PUMP RELAY AND ENGINE
CUTOUT RELAY ................................. 6-22-00
6.8 SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM ......... 6-23-00
6.8.1 WIRING DIAGRAM.............................. 6-23-00
9 6.8.2 SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM
OPERATION........................................ 6-24-00
6.8.3 STARTER RELAY TEST ..................... 6-24-00
6.8.4 DIODE TEST........................................ 6-25-00
6.8.5 SIDE STAND SWITCH TEST .............. 6-26-00
6.8.6 DIODE MODULE TEST ....................... 6-26-00
6.8.7 TESTING THE SAFETY LOCKOUT
SYSTEM SWITCHES........................... 6-27-00
6.9 COOLING FANS ............................. 6-28-00
6.9.1 WIRING DIAGRAM.............................. 6-28-00
6.9.2 COOLING FAN TEST .......................... 6-28-00

6 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.1 LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS

20 19
21 18 23 17 16
21
1 3
22
24

25
7 15
26 26

28 27

14
13
4 6 8 9 10 11 12
5 36
35 30
39 38 37 44 2
31

32
33

42 43 41 34

40 29

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 3 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

23

47 51 47 51
45

48

49

46 50

Key
1) Engine Control Unit 27) Low beam bulb
2) Front cylinder coils 28) Front parking light bulb
3) Rear cylinder coils 29) Right-hand cooling fan
4) Warning horn 30) Front right indicator
5) Left-hand cooling fan 31) Auxiliary fuses (15 A)
6) Diode 32) Flasher
7) Intake air thermistor 33) Bank angle sensor
8) Fuel pump relay 34) Ignition switch
9) Engine cutout relay 35) Right-hand light dip switch
10) Injection relay 36) Front brake light switch
11) Diode module 37) Fuel sensor /pump assembly
12) Rectifier 38) Test and diagnostics connector
13) ide stand switch 39) Main fuses (30 A)
14) Speed sensor 40) Rear brake light switch
15) Number plate light 41) Rear right indicator
16) Starter relay 42) Rear left indicator
17) Battery 43) Tail light
18) Left-hand light dip switch 44) Stepper motor (automatic air adjustment)
19) Clutch switch 45) Injector
20) Instrument panel 46) Oil pressure sensor
21) Front left indicator 47) Coolant thermistor
22) Air temperature sensor 48) Starter motor
23) Throttle sensor 49) Pick-up flywheel
24) Low beam relay 50) Neutral switch
25) High beam relay 51) Spark plugs
26) High beam bulbs

6 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.2 FOREWORD
Please read the following information before reading this
section.
NOTE For ease of reference, the same numbering is
used in the specific wiring diagrams and in the general
schematics.

6.2.1 WIRING COLOUR CODES


Ar Orange
Az Light blue
B Blue
Bi White
G Yellow
Gr Grey
M Brown
N Black
R Red
Ro Pink
V Green
Vi Purple

6.2.2 ELECTRICAL CONNECTORS


Disconnect the electrical connectors as follows:
Š Press down on the locking tab, where fitted.
WARNING
Never separate two connectors by pulling on the
wiring.
Š Grasp both connectors and pull them in opposite
directions until they become separated.
Š Remove any dirt, rust, moisture, etc. from inside the
connector blowing with compressed air.
Š Ensure that the wires are securely crimped to the
terminals inside each connector.
NOTE A connector will only locate properly into the
matching connector when it is inserted in the correct
mounting position.
Š When refitting, reconnect the two connectors and
ensure that they become fully engaged (where fitted,
the locking tab will click audibly into place).

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 5 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.3 CHARGE SYSTEM INSPECTION

6.3.1 CHECKING CHARGE VOLTAGE


Š Check battery voltage, see 2.4.2 (CHARGING THE
BATTERY).
Š Start the engine and rev it up to 4000 rpm.
Š Set the light switch to “ ” and the light dip switch to
“ ”.
Š Set the light dip switch to “ ”.
Š Measure DC voltage across the positive (+) and
negative (–) battery terminals using a multimeter.
If the reading found is less than 13 V or more than 15 V:
Š Test alternator operation under no-load conditions and
check for continuity, see 6.3.2 (ALTERNATOR
LOADLESS OPERATION TEST) and 6.3.4
(ALTERNATOR CONTINUITY TEST); and test the
rectifier, see 6.3.5 (RECTIFIER TEST). 5
Key to the diagram
4
NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the different
components. 3 2
1) Battery
2) Main fuses (30 A)
3) Generator
4) Rectifier
5) Ignition switch ( - - - )
Correct charge voltage: 1
13 - 15 V(DC) at 4000 rpm.

6.3.2 ALTERNATOR LOADLESS OPERATION TEST


Š Remove the left-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Disconnect the three-way connector (1) (coloured
brown) of the rectifier wiring.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to its matching
connector on assembly.
Š Start the engine and rev it up to 4000 rpm.
Š Measure DC voltage across the three inner male 1
terminals [yellow (G) wires] using a multimeter. Test 1
across all terminals alternately.
Any reading below 60 V indicates a faulty alternator.
Replace the alternator.
Correct loadless voltage:
over 60 DC Volts at 4000 rpm.

6 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.3.3 CHARGE SYSTEM LAYOUT

Rectifier
Flywheel

30 A Battery +
+
Main fuse

Auxiliary
A B fuses

Headlamp Fuel pump


Clock

6.3.4 ALTERNATOR CONTINUITY TEST


With the engine off:
Š Remove the left-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Disconnect the three-way connector (1) (coloured
brown) of the rectifier wiring.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
1
Š Set the multimeter to the Ω range and check for
1
continuity across stator wires [that is, across the inner
female terminals, yellow (G) wires].
Check stator mount insulation.
Correct resistance reading: 0.1 – 1Ω
Correct resistance reading between wires and stator
mount: ∞

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 7 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.3.5 RECTIFIER TEST


Š Remove the left-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33 2
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Disconnect the three-way connector (1) (coloured
brown).
Š Disconnect the six-way connector (2) (coloured white).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connectors (1-2) to the
matching connectors on assembly.
Š Set a multimeter to the x 1 MΩ range. Measure
resistance across the wires listed in the table below. 3
Measure at rectifier end (inner male terminals). 1
NOTE The green (V) and white/red (Bi/R) leads are
connected together. Measure across either one of them
when testing.

Connect meter (+) to:

G G G V R/Bi

G ∞ ∞ 2-∞ ∞
Connect meter (-) to:

G ∞ ∞ 2-∞ ∞

G ∞ ∞ 2-∞ ∞

V ∞ ∞ ∞ ∞

R/Bi 2 - ∞ 2-∞ 2-∞ 3-∞

WARNING
This test method provides an approximate measure
of resistance. Where possible, fit a substitute
rectifier known to be in good working order to test
the charge system.
If the reading found deviates from the specified value,
change the rectifier (3).

6 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.4 INJECTION SYSTEM

6.4.1 INJECTION SUPPLY WIRING DIAGRAM

30 A
R/Bi

– +
1
2

D
15 A

Az/Gr

4 6

N R/M

Ro/Bi 8

E1 F3 H4
(Grey) (Grey) (Black)
9

Key:
1) Battery 6) Injection relay
2) Key-operated switch 7) Bank angle sensor
3) Kill switch 8) Power supply to injectors, fans, coils, purge valve USA

4) Starter button 9) ECU


5) Engine cutout relay

6.4.2 TROUBLESHOOTING
Š Check that the 30-A main fuse and the 15-A fuse “D”
are in good condition.
Š Test kill switch device operation, see 6.8 (SAFETY
LOCKOUT SYSTEM). Test key-operated switch
operation, see 6.5 (IGNITION/INJECTION SYSTEM).
Š Test the engine cutout relay for proper operation,
see 6.7.3 (TEST OF FUEL PUMP RELAY AND
ENGINE CUTOUT RELAY).
Š Test the injection relay, see 6.4.3 (INJECTION RELAY
TEST).
Š Test the bank angle sensor, see 6.4.4 (BANK ANGLE
SENSOR TEST).

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 9 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.4.3 INJECTION RELAY TEST


Test the relay for proper operation as follows:
Š Remove the left-hand side fairing, see 7.1.28 - +
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS). 12V
Š Feed 12 Volts to the two male terminals (85-86).
Š Check continuity between the other two terminals (87- + -
30) using a multimeter set to the Ohm range. Ω
30
Correct reading when relay is fed: 0 Ω 87
Correct reading when relay is not fed: ∞ Ω
85 86
Change the relay if the reading found deviates from the
specified reading.

WARNING
The relay accommodates a diode. Observe polarity
when feeding the relay. Connect the terminal (86) to
“+” and the terminal (85) to “-”.

6.4.4 BANK ANGLE SENSOR TEST


A
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).

WARNING
Make sure to have a bulb rated 12V-2W maximum
ready at hand.
Š Set up a circuit as shown in the diagram. B
Š When you close the switch “A” with the sensor in a
horizontal position, the lamp “B” should illuminate.

Š Tilt the sensor at an angle greater than 60°. The lamp


should extinguish.
˚ 60˚
Š Repeat the process tilting the sensor in the opposite
direction.
60
Close and open the switch "A" to turn the lamp back on
again.
NOTE Replace the sensor when it does not operate as
described above. Fit a new sensor of the same type.

6 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.5 IGNITION/INJECTION SYSTEM

M/G B3(N) H1(Gr) Ar/Bi


M/Bi E3(N)
2 B/R 15
E4(N)

Ro/N H2(Gr) V/Az


B2(N)
3 14

R/N D1(N)
1 H3(Gr) Ar/Az
4
13
B/G A1(N)
5 Bi/G B1(N) H4(N) R/M
H4(Gr) G/B

Az
F1(N) 12
H3(N) Gr/R
G F2(N)
6 10
Vi E2(N)
Ro E1(N) V/Gr
H2(N)
9
D3(Gr) D4(N) A1(Gr)
M/Ro
Gr

Bi/Vi

7
8

7(12WAY) 9(12WAY) 10(12WAY)

EFI

WARNING
11
LIGHT DISPLAY

Key
1) Engine Control Unit (ECU) 9) Rear cylinder injector
2) Throttle sensor 10) Front cylinder injector
3) Coolant thermistor 11) Instrument panel
4) Injection air thermistor 12) Rear cylinder coil – centre spark plug
5) Rpm sensor 13) Rear cylinder coil – side spark plug
6) Automatic air adjustment motor 14) Front cylinder coil – side spark plug
7) Test connector 15) Front cylinder coil – centre spark plug
8) Injection relay

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 11 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.5.1 TROUBLESHOOTING
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š The wording " " will appear on the display for about
three seconds.
Š If the “ ” light goes out, it means that the Ecu has
detected no faults.

6.5.2 IN THE EVENT OF A FAULT


Š You have performed the operations described in
subsection 6.5.1 (TROUBLESHOOTING); the wording
" " stays on and the wording "Off" appears in the
clock field: the battery is likely to be flat.
Š You have performed the operations described in
subsection 6.5.1 (TROUBLESHOOTING); the wording
" " stays on: the starter motor operates, but the
engine will not start up.
Š You have performed the operations described in
subsection 6.5.1 (TROUBLESHOOTING); the wording
" " is flashing: check the sensors.

6.5.3 FAULT CODES


Š Lift the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Connect the two test connectors (1) located on the
right-hand side of the motorcycle.
Š Look at the fault code displayed in the clock field. One
of the following codes may appear. 1
Š Check with the fault code chart for possible causes of
the problem.

6 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

FAULT CODE CHART:

FAULT CODE AFFECTED COMPONENT CAUSE

12 Crankshaft position sensor (pick-up) – Sensor disconnected.


– Sensor broken.
15 Throttle position sensor (TPS) – Wiring fault.
21 Engine temperature sensor

22 Air temperature sensor

23 Atmospheric pressure sensor – Sensor fault.

33 Coil no. 1 – Coil fault; coil disconnected from


wiring.
34 Coil no. 2

35 Coil no. 3

36 Coil no. 4

42 Injector no. 1 – Injector fault; injector disconnected


from wiring.
43 Injector no. 2

6.5.4 ELECTRONIC SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING If the engine does not start and the vehicle diagnostic
BASED ON DISPLAY INFORMATION system indicates no faults, check the following
components in the order:
WARNING – check the fuel pump for proper operation, see 6.7.2
The ignition system produces high voltages. Be (FUEL PUMP TEST);
careful: shock hazard! – check the injectors for proper operation, see 6.6.1
Never disconnect the connectors while the engine is (INJECTOR TEST);
running. – ensure that the anti-theft system connector is properly
Unless expressly specified otherwise in the relevant connected (this will be the white connector under the
sections of the manual, always set the ignition switch passenger seat);
to “ ” and disconnect the battery (negative “–” lead – check the ignition switch for proper operation,
first) before servicing the ignition system. see 6.13.2 (SWITCHES);
– check the engine kill switch for proper operation,
WARNING see 6.13.2 (SWITCHES);
All measurements must be taken with the – check the condition of the 30-A main FUSES AND 15-A
components at 20°C (68°F). General troubleshooting AUXILIARY FUSES, see 6.16 (REPLACING THE
advice: locate fault and remove defective component FUSES);
immediately. – check the engine cutout relay for proper operation,
Perform the checks described in the subsections listed see 6.7.3 (TEST OF FUEL PUMP RELAY AND
below: ENGINE CUTOUT RELAY);
– 6.6.7 (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR TEST); – check for proper operation of the battery, see 2.4
– 6.6.3 (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST); (BATTERY) and 6.14 (BATTERY);
– 6.6.5 (COOLANT THERMISTOR TEST). – check for proper OPERATION OF THE SAFETY
LOCKOUT SYSTEM, see 6.8 (SAFETY LOCKOUT
SYSTEM);
– check the bank angle sensor for proper operation,
see 6.4.4 (BANK ANGLE SENSOR TEST).

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 13 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.6 HOOK-UP DIAGRAM OF ENGINE


CONTROL UNIT
NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the different
components.
Please read 4.7.4 (ENGINE CONTROL UNIT
CONNECTORS) for more detailed information.

45 39 40 43 43 41 42 52 51 50 49 16 2 33

P1H2 P1H3 P2H1 P2H2 P2H3 P2H4 P2E1 P1D4 P2A1 P2D3
P2G1
P1H4
P2G2

P1G1

P2F3
P1H1

P1F1 P1B4

P1F2 P1F4
54 P1E2 P2A2 P2G3 P2C3 P1A1 P1E3
P1G4 P2C4 P2G4 P2D2 P2C2 P1B1 P1D1 P1B2 P1B3 P1E4
P1E1 P2B2

36
25 9
46 47 48
63
27 26 28
30

H G F E D C B A H G F E D C B A

1 1 1 1

2 2 2 2

3 3 3 3

4 4 4 4
H G F E D C B A H G F E D C B A

NOTE The letters (y) and (z) used in the diagram


identify the terminals of the two connectors:
Y) Ecu connector (26-way).
Z) Ecu connector (16-way).

6 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

Position Component Connector Terminal # Rating Wiring colour


P1 D4 Bi/Vi
9 Instrument panel
P2 A1 M/Ro
15 Bank angle sensor P2 E1 Ro/Bi
16 Fuel pump relay P2 E1 – Ro/Bi
P2 C2 M/V
25 Diode module
P2 D2 M
26 Clutch switch P2 C2 M/V
27 Neutral switch P2 D2 M
28 Side stand P2 C2 M/V
30 Starter relay – – –
33 TEST connectors P2 D3 – Gr
Crankshaft position P1 B1 Bi/G
36 150 - 300 Ω
sensor P1 A1 B/G
P1 H4 M/R
39 Injection relay
P2 F3 N
Purge Valve P1 G1 M/Vi
40
(California only) P1 H4 M/R
Rear cylinder P1 H4 M/R
41 11 - 17 Ω
injector P1 H2 V/Gr
Front cylinder P1 H4 M/R
42 11 -17 Ω
injector P1 H3 Gr/R
P1 H4 M/R
43 Cooling fans P2 G2 G/N
P2 G1 G/N
45 Fuel pump P1 H1 B/Bi
P1 E4 B/R
46 Air thermistor –
P1 D1 R/N
P1 E4 B/R
47 Coolant thermistor 1.9 - 2.9 kΩ
P1 B2 Ro/N
P1 E4 B/R
Throttle position 2.8 - 3.4 kΩ
48 P1 E3 M/Bi
sensor (varies with angle)
P1 B3 M/G
P1 H4 M/R
49 Rear cylinder coil 4-5Ω
P2 H4 G/B
P1 H4 M/R
50 Rear cylinder coil 4-5Ω
P2 H3 Ar/Az
P1 H4 M/R
51 Front cylinder coil 4-5Ω
P2 H2 V/Az
P1 H4 M/R
52 Front cylinder coil 4-5Ω
P2 H1 Ar/Bi
P1 F1 Az
Idling adjustment P1 F2 G
54
motor P1 E2 Vi
P1 E1 Ro
P1 G4 B/V
P1 B4 B/N
Diagnostics
63 P1 F4 Vi/M
connector
P2 A2 B/Ar
P2 B2 Gr/Bi

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 15 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.6.1 INJECTOR TEST


1 2
With the engine off:
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
NOTE The procedure described below applies to both
injectors.
Š Disconnect the two-way connector (1) (coloured black)
and measure the resistance across the terminals at the
injector end.
Š Measure the resistance across injector terminals using
a multimeter set to the x 100 Ω range.
Correct reading: 11.5 – 13 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F). 2
Replace the injector (2) when detected reading
indicates infinite resistance (∞) or is below the
specified range.
Š Repeat the test with the other injector.

6.6.2 AUTOMATIC AIR ADJUSTMENT MOTOR


Š Lift the airbox, see 7.1.8 (AIRBOX REMOVAL).
NOTE This is a stepper motor that opens and closes
some particular air passages to make the air/fuel mixture
richer or leaner.
To test the stepper motor (2) for proper operation:
2
Š Release and remove the two screws (1) and remove
the motor from the airbox.
Š Set the ignition switch key to “ ” and then right away
to “ ”. When the key is set to “ ”, an automatic 1 1
set-up procedure takes place during which the small
white cylinder travels fully out (about 28.5 mm) and
then backs off by a few millimetres (about 19.6 mm).
Š When this is not the case, measure the resistance
between the two coils using a multimeter set to the
Ohm range:
– check across pins A and D, correct reading is:
50 Ω ± 10%;
– check across pins B and C, correct reading is:
50 Ω ± 10%;
– across the other pins: infinite resistance (∞).

6 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.6.3 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST


With the engine off: 1
2
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
Š Disconnect the three-way connector (coloured black)
(1).

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Measure the resistance across the terminals of the
potentiometer (2) (Tps) using a multimeter set to the
3
kΩ. range.
MEASUREMENT (A)
Resistance between terminals A and B, regardless of
throttle position:
Correct reading: 1.2 kΩ ± 10%.
MEASUREMENT (B)
Resistance between terminals A and C:
Begin with the throttles fully closed and open gradually
until the throttles are fully open; resistance should
increase as follows:
Correct reading: from 1.2 kΩ to 2.4 kΩ ± 10%.
NOTE The two screws (3) are retained with LOCTITE®
243. Heat up with hot air to facilitate removal.
Š Release and remove the screws (3).
Š Remove the potentiometer (2).
Replace the potentiometer (2) when resistance
readings are outside the specified range.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 17 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.6.4 AIR THERMISTOR TEST


Š Remove the left-hand fairing, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING 1
THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Disconnect the two-way connector (1) (coloured
green).

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Remove the thermistor (2).
Š Attach the leads of a multimeter (3) set to the Ohm
range to the thermistor (2) as shown in the diagram.
Š Suspend the thermistor in a container (4) filled with
water.
Š Suspend a thermometer (5) with a 0 -150°C (32 -
302°F) range in the container.
Š Place the container on a gas burner (6) and heat up the 5
water gradually.
Š Check the temperature reading of the thermometer (5)
and the thermistor output indicated by the multimeter.
Thermistor output should vary with temperature as
indicated in the table below. + -

Water temperature Correct reading 4


(°C) (°F) (W) (± 10%) 2
3
0 32 5457
6
20 68 2375
40 104 1111
60 140 563.8
80 176 306.4
100 212 176.7

Change the thermistor (2) when meter reading does


not vary with temperature, or when the readings
found deviate too much from the values indicated in
the table.

6 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.6.5 COOLANT THERMISTOR TEST


NOTE The temperature reading detected by the front
cylinder thermistor (on right-hand side) is sent to the
right-hand display; the temperature reading detected by
the rear cylinder thermistor (on left-hand side) is
transmitted to the Ecu.
Š Remove the thermistor (1), see 5.4 (REMOVING THE
COOLANT THERMISTORS).
Š Set a multimeter (2) to the Ohm range and attach the
multimeter leads to the thermistor (1) as shown in the 1
figure.
Š Suspend the thermistor (1) in a container (3) filled with
coolant.
Š Suspend a thermometer (4) with a 0 -150°C (32 -
302°F) range in the container.
Š Place the container on a gas burner (5) and heat up the
coolant gradually. 4
Š Check the temperature reading of the thermometer (4)
and the thermistor (1) output indicated by the
multimeter.
Thermistor output should vary with temperature as
indicated in the table below. + -

Coolant temperature Correct reading 3


(W) (± 10%) 1
(°C) (°F) 2
0 32 5896
5
20 68 2500
40 104 1175
60 140 595.5
80 176 322.5
100 212 186.6

Change the thermistor (1) when meter reading does


not vary with temperature, or when the readings
found deviate too much from the values indicated in
the table.
Š Repeat test with the other thermistor.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 19 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.6.6 IGNITION COIL TEST


Š Remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.6 (COMPLETE
REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK).
NOTE The procedure described below applies to all
ignition coils.
Š Disconnect the connector (1) at the ignition coil (2).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
2
connector on assembly. 1
Š Disconnect the wiring from the coil (2).
Š Check resistance using a multimeter. Observe the
layout (A) and (B) in the diagram for meter connection.
Check for continuity of the primary and secondary
windings.
The resistance readings found need not match standard
values exactly. If the windings are in good working order,
resistance readings should approximate the standard A B
values.
Standard values: - + - +
Ω Ω
layout (A): 0.6Ω ± 10%;
layout (B): 10 kΩ ± 10%.

WARNING
This test method provides an approximate indication.
When possible, fit a substitute coil known to be in
good working order to confirm proper operation.
Š Repeat test with the other coils.

6.6.7 CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR TEST


With the engine off:
Š Remove the left-hand side fairing, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Disconnect the two-way connector and attach the
multimeter leads direct to the sensor.
Š Set the multimeter to the x 1000 Ω range and measure
resistance across sensor terminals. Observe terminal - +
polarity (see diagram). Ω
Correct reading: 560 Ω ± 10%.
Š Replace sensor when infinite resistance is detected or
when the reading found is below the specified range.

6 - 20 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.7 FUEL PUMP SYSTEM

6.7.1 WIRING DIAGRAM


NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the components.

Ar/V

– + 7
1
4 5

V/N

Ro/Bi
3

E1 6
B/Bi (Grey)

H1
(Black)

Key:
1) Battery
2) Fuel pump relay
3) Pump
4) Bank angle sensor
5) Engine cutout relay
6) Ecu
7) Fuse

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 21 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.7.2 FUEL PUMP TEST


To test fuel pump operation:
1
Š Remove the cockpit bottom panel, see 7.1.20 (FRONT
FAIRING REMOVAL).
Š Take off the cover (3) of the auxiliary fuse box.
Š Check the fuse (1).
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).

Š Disconnect the four-way connector (2) located on the


left-hand side of the vehicle.
2
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (2) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Feed 12 (DC)V to the green (V) positive (+) lead and
the blue (B) negative (-) lead (at the pump assembly
end).
Š The pump should start running (it should give off a
typical whirring sound). Check pressure on the
pressure gauge. Delivery pressure should be at least
350 kPa (3.5 bar).

6.7.3 TEST OF FUEL PUMP RELAY AND ENGINE


CUTOUT RELAY 2
To test relay operation:
Š Disconnect the four-way connector (1) (coloured white)
from the relay (2).

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.

Š Feed 12 Volts to the two inner male terminals (A-B).


Š Check for continuity between the other two terminals
(C-D) using a multimeter set to the Ohm range.
Correct reading when relay is fed : 0 Ω.
Correct reading when relay is not fed: ∞ Ω
Replace the relay (2) if the readings obtained deviate
from those specified.
When all components are found to be operating properly,
perform these checks:
– Check bank angle sensor, see 6.4.4 (BANK ANGLE
SENSOR TEST).
– Ensure that wires are connected correctly.

6 - 22 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.8 SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM

6.8.1 WIRING DIAGRAM


NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the components.

V V

29
8

58 59

Gr Gr

M/Vi
Gr/B
Vi/N

Engine Kill
12 M/N
G/R G/R

Diode
16

M/V
M
70
10

B/V
9

18 17

Key to diagram
8) Diode module
9) Clutch lever switch
10) Neutral light switch
12) Starter button
16) Starter relay
17) Starter motor
18) Battery
29) Auxiliary fuses (15 A)
58) Side stand light (LED)
59) Neutral light (LED)
70) Side stand switch
A) To battery / ignition switch
B) To auxiliary fuses (15 A)

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 23 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.8.2SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM OPERATION


NOTE When the engine kill switch is set to “ ”, the
starter motor will not run.

CLUTCH IGNITION STARTER


TRANSMISSION SIDE STAND STAND LIGHT
LEVER ENGINE MOTOR

PULLED IN
UP OFF
NEUTRAL RELEASED
ENGAGED PULLED IN RUNS
DOWN ON OPERATES
RELEASED

PULLED IN
UP OFF
GEAR RELEASED
ENGAGED PULLED IN LOCKED OUT
DOWN ON LOCKED OUT
RELEASED

6.8.3 STARTER RELAY TEST


To test relay operation: 4
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the two-way connector (1) (coloured white). 2
1
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Lift the relay (2) until it is clear of its retainers.
Š Slide off the two rubber boots (3-4). 3
Š Disconnect the wiring from the terminals of the relay
(2).

Š Feed 12 Volts to the two inner terminals in the


connector (1) at the relay end.
Š Check for continuity between the two contact screws of
the relay (2) using a multimeter set to the Ohm range.
Correct reading when relay is fed: 0 Ω.
Correct reading when relay is not fed: ∞ Ω
Replace the relay (2) if the readings obtained deviate
from those specified.

6 - 24 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.8.4 DIODE TEST


To test diode operation:
Š Remove the left-hand side fairing, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Disconnect the two-way connector (1) (coloured white)
located under the left-hand fairing panel, near the
ECU.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Place a multimeter in the diode-test mode and measure
across the two male terminals accommodated inside the 1
diode as shown in the diagrams.

Correct reading (layout A): 0 – 1 Ω.


Correct reading (layout B): ∞
When there is no multimeter including a diode-test
feature available, feed 12 Volts to the diode, fit a 12 V - 2
W bulb to the positive lead and connect the leads to the
diode as shown in the diagrams.

WARNING
Do not use a bulb rated higher than 2 W or the diode
will damage.

Test (C): the bulb stays off.


Test (D): the bulb comes on.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 25 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.8.5 SIDE STAND SWITCH TEST


Ensure that there is no obstruction to side stand (1)
rotation.
Check for the following:
3
Š Inspect the springs (2) for any sign of damage, wear,
rust or weakening.
Š The side stand should rotate freely. Grease the joint if
needed, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
1
The side stand (1) is fitted with a safety switch (3) that
inhibits ignition or shuts down the engine whenever a
gear is engaged while the side stand (1) is down.
2
To test safety switch (3) operation:
Š Sit astride the motorcycle.
Š Raise the side stand (1).
Š Start the engine.
Š With the throttle twistgrip released and the engine
idling, pull the clutch lever all the way in. Push down on
gear shift lever to engage the first gear.
Š Lower the side stand (1). This should cause the safety
switch (3) to cut in.
This is what should happen next:
– the engine should stop;
– the side stand light “ ” on the instrument panel should
light up.
When this is not the case, replace the switch (3).

6.8.6 DIODE MODULE TEST


Š Remove the left-hand side fairing, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Disconnect the five-way connector (1) (coloured white)
from the module (2).

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Apply 12 Volts to the various terminals, with a 12 V - 2
W bulb fitted to the positive (+) lead as shown.

WARNING
Do not use a bulb rated higher than 2 W or the
module will damage.

+ 1 2 3 4 5

1
2
3
4 2
5

WARNING
The bulb should illuminate as indicated in the chart.
If not so, replace the module (2).

6 - 26 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.8.7 TESTING THE SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM


SWITCHES
Check for switch continuity using a multimeter. Please
refer to the relevant diagram.
Replace any switch found to deviate from the specified
mode of operation.

1) NEUTRAL SWITCH

Leads
Position
Screw 1
Neutral

2) SIDE STAND SWITCH

2
Leads
Stand position
M V N

Down

Up

3) CLUTCH LEVER SWITCH

Leads
Position
Gr M

Activated

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 27 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.9 COOLING FANS

6.9.1 WIRING DIAGRAM


NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the components.

G1(G) G/N
3
H4(N) R/M

G2(G) G/N
3

4
5
E4(N) B/R

B2(N) Ro/N

Key
1) Ecu
2) Injection relay
3) Fans
4) Throttle sensor
5) Coolant thermistor

6.9.2 COOLING FAN TEST


NOTE The procedure described below applies to both
cooling fans.
1
Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure
described in subsection 5.3 (REMOVING THE
COOLING FANS).
NOTE Make sure to have a 12-V battery ready at
hand.
Š Attach the black connector (1) to the battery.
Š Ensure that the fan turns freely.
If the fans are working properly, check the following:
– coolant thermistor, see 6.6.5 (COOLANT
THERMISTOR TEST);
– ignition system power supply;

6 - 28 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

– proper connection at Ecu end.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 29 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.10 INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS


1
6.10.1 WIRING DIAGRAM
NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the components.

16-WAY CONNECTOR 12-WAY CONNECTOR

2 9 11 16 1 2 5 4 3
Bi/Gr

Az/N
Bi/G

Bi/N
Bi/R
Ro

1
M

Bi/Gr

2 3 4
+ -

6

2
Key:
1) Instrument panel
2) Ambient temperature sensor
3) Oil pressure sensor
4) Fuel sensor
5) Speed sensor
6) Coolant temperature sensor

6 - 30 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.10.2 AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR


To test air temperature sensor operation:
2
Š Remove the cockpit left-hand facia panel, See 7.1.20
(FRONT FAIRING REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the two-way connector (1).
Š Test sensor in a controlled environment at an ambient
temperature of 20°C (68°F).
1

Š Measure resistance across the terminals of connector


(1) using an ohmmeter set to a 0-2kΩ range. 3
Correct reading: 12.200 kΩ − 12.700 kΩ.
If the air temperature sensor is operating properly, check
the instrument panel as follows:
Š Disconnect the sixteen-way connector (2), see 7.1.24
(REMOVING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL).
Š Apply 12.4 kΩ across terminals 2 and 9.
Š A properly working instrument panel will give a
temperature reading of 20 ± 1°C (68 ± 3°F).

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 31 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.10.3 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR


Š Remove the lower fairing, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Disconnect the terminal (1) from the sensor (2) and 1
connect it to ground.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š With the ignition switch set to “”, the red engine oil
LED “ ” should light up.
Š If the LED “ ” does not light up, check sensor for
proper operation.
Š Check for continuity between the terminal tab (3) and
sensor housing (2) using a multimeter set to a x 100Ω
range (see diagram).
Correct reading with the engine off: 0Ω
Correct reading with the engine running: ∞ Ω
If the readings found deviate from those specified,
ensure that engine oil is at the correct level, see 2.12
(CHECKING AND TOPPING UP ENGINE OIL LEVEL). If
the problem persists, replace the sensor (2). + -

+ -

6 - 32 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.10.4 SPEED SENSOR


In the event the speedometer is out of order, proceed as 1
follows:
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
Š Disconnect the two-way connector of the speed sensor
(1) on the right-hand side of the motorcycle.
Š Measure resistance across the two terminals of the
connector (1) at sensor end:
Correct reading: 3.83 MΩ ± 5%.

REVERSE POLARITY

Correct reading: ∞
NOTE Change the speed sensor if the readings
obtained deviate from those specified.
If the readings found are correct:
- Replace the instrument panel, see 7.1.24 (REMOVING
THE INSTRUMENT PANEL);
- Ensure that wiring is properly connected to the instru-
ment panel.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 33 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.10.5 FUEL SENSOR


Test sensor operation as follows: 1
Š Lift the fuel tank, see 2.8 (LIFTING THE FUEL TANK).
Š Disconnect the white four-way connector (1) placed
underneath the fuel tank (on the left-hand side).
Š Measure resistance across the orange and black wires
at sensor end:
Correct reading with a full tank: less than 14 Ω
Correct reading with empty tank: between 240 and
400 Ω
NOTE Replace the fuel sensor if the readings obtained
deviate from the specified limits.
If detected readings are correct, test instrument panel
operation by connecting a resistor across the orange/
black and white/yellow leads of the four-way connector
(1) at the main wiring harness.
- With 10 Ω resistor:
9 sectors light up and litre indication reads “F”.

- With 250 Ω resistor:


all sectors off, litre indication reads “- -” and is flashing,
low fuel light is on.

6 - 34 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.10.6 COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR


Š Test sensor operation, see 6.6.5 (COOLANT
THERMISTOR TEST).
Š Test instrument panel operation by connecting a
resistor across the white/black and white/red leads of
the two-way connector (1):

With 90 Ω resistor:
Panel indication: 9 sectors light up (the last two sectors
will be flashing).
Temperature indication in degrees:
- from 126°C to 135°C;
- from 258.8°F to 275°F.
With 1600 Ω resistor:
Panel indication: 1 sector on;
Temperature indication in degrees: “- - -”.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 35 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.11 LIGHT SYSTEM


1
6.11.1 WIRING DIAGRAM
IMPORTANTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF
ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS) for the location of the
components.

1 2 4 3
PASSING
G/V
V

G/Gr

V/Ar
Ar
G
G/N
V/R

B/N
Gr

Az

G/V
Bi

R
N

V
Bi/R
G/N

R/B
G/R
G/V
V/R
G
V

Bi/R
G/N

G/R
G/Gr

G/V
V/R

R/B
R/Bi
V/N

G
V
G
G/N

Bi
N

V
G/N
G
V

- +
7 12V
C + -
A Ω
30
87
5 6
85 86

14 13
1
8
10 15 11

12 - + 9

Key:
1) Right-hand light dip switch
2) Left-hand light dip switch
3) Right-hand light dip switch on version
4) Key-operated switch
5) Low beam relay
6) High beam relay
7) 15-A fuses

6 - 36 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

8) 30-A fuses
9) Battery
10) Number plate light
11) Low beam
12) High beam
13) Front parking light

PASSING
1

G/N
V/R

V/R

B/N
Gr

Az
Bi

R
B

V
V/R

B/N
7
Gr

Az
R

L B

C 3

12
5

8 11 10 9
13
- +
6

14) Rear parking light


15) Instrument panel lighting Leds

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 37 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.11.2 LIGHT RELAY TEST


To check for proper operation of the relays (1):
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).
Š Remove the relay to be tested.
Š Feed 12 Volts to the two male terminals (85-86).
Š Check for continuity between the other two terminals
(87-30) using a multimeter set to the Ohm range.
Correct reading when relay is fed: 0Ω
Correct reading when relay is not fed: ∞ Ω
Change the relay when detected readings deviate
from those specified.

6 - 38 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.12 VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING


SYSTEM

6.12.1 WIRING DIAGRAM


NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the components.
Key:
1) Left-hand light dip switch
2) Warning horn
3) 15-A fuse
4) 30-A fuse
5) Key-operated switch
6) Battery
7) Flasher
8) Rear right indicator bulb
9) Rear left indicator bulb
10) Front right indicator bulb
11) Front left indicator bulb
12) Instrument panel
13) Indicator repeater light (LED)

6.12.2 WARNING HORN TEST


To test warning horn operation:
Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure
described in subsection 7.1.27 (WARNING HORN
REMOVAL).
Š Feed 12 Volts to the two connectors of the waning
horn.
Š Adjust through the adjuster screw if needed.

6.12.3 FLASHER TEST


When none of the direction indicators is working, there
might be a problem with the flasher.
To test flasher operation:
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the two connectors (1) of the flasher (2).
Š Fit a jumper to both connectors (1).
Š Operate the direction indicator control (3).
If the indicator lights come on but do not flash, replace
the flasher (2).
Š It may also be necessary to check:
- the 30-A main fuses and the electrical system.
When the bulb of a direction indicator burns out, each
time the control (3) is operated the other indicator and the
repeater light on the instrument panel will come on but
will not flash.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 39 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.13 VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING


SYSTEM

6.13.1 WIRING DIAGRAM


NOTE See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL
COMPONENTS) for the location of the components.

G/V
2

V
Bi/R
G/N

R/B
G/R
G/V
V/R
G
V

G/V
V

C 3

4
7 8

- +
6

Key:
1) Front brake light switch
2) Rear brake light switch
3) 15-A fuse
4) 30-A fuse
5) Key-operated switch
6) Battery
7) Tail light
8) Brake lights

6 - 40 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.13.2 SWITCHES
Check switches for continuity using a multimeter. Please
refer to the relevant diagram.
Replace any switch found to deviate from the specified
mode of operation.

1) FRONT BRAKE LIGHT SWITCH


1
Wires
Position
V V/G

Activated

2) REAR BRAKE LIGHT SWITCH


2
Wires
Position
Gr M

Activated

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 41 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.14 BATTERY
2
NOTE This motorcycle is equipped with a
maintenance-free battery that only needs to be inspected
and charged from time to time.
In the event the battery needs replacing, install a battery
of the same type and rating.
Battery rating: 12V - 12 Ah
Read 2.4 (BATTERY) carefully.

6.14.1 FIRST-TIME INSTALLATION


Š Remove the battery from the motorcycle, see 7.1.9
(BATTERY REMOVAL).

CAUTION
Battery electrolyte fluid is toxic and caustic. It
contains sulphuric acid and can cause burns if
spilled on the skin.
Wear protective clothing, a face shield and/or
protective goggles when handling battery fluid.
If any battery fluid gets on your skin, rinse the
affected area with abundant fresh water.
If battery fluid is spilled into your eyes, flush with
abundant water for fifteen minutes and contact an
eye specialist immediately.
If battery fluid is swallowed accidentally, drink
abundant water or milk. Seek medical attention
immediately and keep drinking magnesia milk or
vegetable oil in the meantime. 3
The battery gives off explosive gases. Keep the
battery well away from any sources of ignition, such
as flames, sparks, or any heat sources. Do not
smoke near the battery.
Provide adequate ventilation when charging or using
the battery. Do not inhale the gases produced by the
battery under charging.
KEEP AWAY FROM CHILDREN.
Battery fluid is corrosive.
Avoid spillage. Take special care not to spill battery
fluid on plastic parts.

WARNING
Ensure that the electrolyte fluid you are using is the
suitable type for your battery.
Š Place the battery on a level surface.
Š Peel off the self-adhesive seal (1).
Š Take the electrolyte container out of the box. The
container has six cells (2) and is packed in a sealed bag.
Š Unpack the container (2).
NOTE The container caps (3) double as battery cell
caps. Be sure to retain them and keep them handy.
Š Take off the caps (3) from the top end of the container
(2).

6 - 42 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

WARNING
Do not cut or prick the sealed ends of the container
(2).
Š Turn over the container (2) and place the sealed ends
over the openings of the battery cells.
Š Press down on the container (2) to break the seals and
let the fluid flow into the battery cells.
NOTE Ensure that the container (2) is perfectly vertical
to facilitate drainage.
Š Leave the container (2) in place for about twenty
minutes and ensure that the fluid is flowing into to the
battery.

WARNING
Do not remove the container (2) unless all fluid has
drained out.
Š If there is still some fluid left in the container (2) after
twenty minutes, tap the uppermost end of the container
with your fingers to obtain complete drainage.
Š Lift the container (2) carefully to release it from the
battery.

Š Place the caps (3) over the battery cell openings.


Š Press down firmly until the underside (3) of the cap
strip contacts battery top face.

WARNING
Never remove the caps (3).
Š Connect the battery to a battery charger.
Š Charge the battery at normal charge rate (see chart).
Charge time
Charge rate Ampere rating
(hours)
Normal 1.2 8 -10
Fast 12 05
Š Refit the battery just before delivering the motorcycle to
end user.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 43 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.14.2 MAINTENANCE
Š If the motorcycle is left unridden for over fifteen days,
charge the battery at normal charge rate to avoid
sulphation, see 2.4.2 (CHARGING THE BATTERY).
Š Apply a light coat of neutral grease or vaseline to the
battery terminals.

6.14.3 INSPECTION
1 3 1
In the event of abnormal operation, check the charge
system first, see 6.3 (CHARGE SYSTEM INSPECTION).
In addition, check for the following:
Š Inspect the battery for any sign of damage (such as a
cracked housing) and check for fluid leaks.
Š Ensure that the battery leads are securely fixed to the
terminals.
Š Charge at normal charge rate for at least 10 hours.
WARNING
After charging, check loadless voltage. Replace the
battery when loadless voltage is less than 12 V. 2

6.14.4 RETURN UNDER WARRANTY


The warranty is invalidated when:
Š the battery is damaged (dented housing, bent
4 5
terminals, etc.);
Š the battery is affected by extensive sulphation
(normally due to improper installation procedure and/or
use).

7 1

6 - 44 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.15 BULB REPLACEMENT


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.

WARNING
Before proceeding to change a bulb, rotate the
ignition switch to “ ”.
Wear clean gloves or use a clean, dry cloth to handle
bulbs.
Do not put your fingerprints on a bulb, as this may
cause overheating leading to failure.
If you touch a bulb with your fingers, remove any 8
2
fingerprints with alcohol to avoid early failure.
DO NOT PULL ON THE WIRING.

6.15.1 HEADLIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT


Š Place the motorcycle on the stand. 3

NOTE Check the fuses, see 6.16 (REPLACING THE


FUSES) before changing a bulb.
The headlight accommodates:
- two high beam bulbs (1) (one on each side);
- one parking light bulb (2) (at the bottom);
- one low beam bulb (3) (at the bottom).
NOTE Both cockpit facia panels must be removed to
give access to the low beam and high beam bulbs.
The cockpit bottom panel must be removed to give
access to the parking light bulb. 9 10
Replacement:
HIGH BEAM BULBS
NOTE Work on the side where the burnt-out bulb is 12 3
located.
NOTE Disconnect one connector at a time to avoid
confusing the various connectors when refitting.
When two connectors must be removed at the same
time, mark them with their positions and make sure to
refit them in the correct positions on assembly.
Š Remove the cockpit bottom panel, see 7.1.20 (FRONT
FAIRING REMOVAL).

WARNING 11
Never pull on the wiring to disconnect a bulb
connector.
Š Grasp the connector of the bulb to be replaced (4) and
pull off the connector from the bulb (1).
Š Pull off the dust cover (5) with your fingers.
Š Release the retainer (6) at the rear of the bulb holder
(7).
Š Extract the bulb (1) from the holder and fit a new bulb
of equal rating.
NOTE Make sure the locating pegs locate properly into
the holder when fitting the bulb.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 45 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

PARKING LIGHT BULB


Š Remove the front fairing bottom panel, see 7.1.32 2
(REMOVING THE FRONT BOTTOM PANEL).

WARNING
Do not pull on the wiring to extract the bulb holder.
Š Grasp the parking light bulb holder (8) and pull to
extract.
Š Remove the bulb (2) and fit a new bulb of equal rating.

LOW BEAM BULB


NOTE Disconnect one connector at a time to avoid
confusing the various connectors when refitting.
When two connectors must be removed at the same
time, mark them with their positions and make sure to 3
refit them in their original positions on assembly.
Š Remove the cockpit right-hand facia panel, see 7.1.20
(FRONT FAIRING REMOVAL).

WARNING
Do not pull on the wiring to extract the bulb
connector.
Š Grasp the connector of the bulb (9) and pull to
separate connector from bulb (3).
Š Slip off the dust cover (10) with your fingers.
Š Release the retainer (11) at the rear of the bulb holder 1
(12). 2 2
Š Extract the bulb (3) from the holder and fit a new bulb
of equal rating.
NOTE Make sure the locating pegs locate properly into
the holder when fitting the bulb.

6 - 46 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.15.2 REPLACING THE FRONT DIRECTION


INDICATOR BULBS 4
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Release and remove the screw (1).
WARNING
The lens is retained by a locating peg. Remove 5
carefully or the locating peg might break off.
Š Remove the lens (2).
3
WARNING
Ensure that the lens locates properly to the housing
when refitting. Tighten the screw (1) carefully. Do not
overtighten or the lens will damage.
Š Push down the bulb (3) gently and twist anti-clockwise.
Š Extract the bulb (3) from the bulb holder.
WARNING
When fitting the bulb, ensure that the two locating
pegs locate properly into the slots in the bulb holder.
Š Install a new bulb of equal rating.
See 6.15.3 (TAIL LIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT) for
instructions on how to replace the rear direction indicator
bulbs.

6.15.3 TAIL LIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT


The tail light accommodates:
- two bulbs for parking / brake lights (1).
- two bulbs for the rear direction indicators (2).
To replace a bulb:
Before changing a bulb, check the BRAKE light switches 2
for proper operation, see 6.13.2 (SWITCHES).

CAUTION 1
Allow for the exhaust silencer to cool down
completely.

WARNING
Handle with care. Do not pull on the wiring.
Š Partially remove the tail light, see 7.1.36 (TAIL LIGHT
REMOVAL).
3
WARNING
Ensure the wiring harness of the tail light is properly
routed when refitting. The wiring harness should
never be in contact with the exhaust silencer.
4

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 47 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

PARKING LIGHT/BRAKE LIGHT BULBS


Š Release and remove the two screws (3).
Š Partially remove the bulb holder (4).
Š Push down on the bulb (1) lightly and twist anti-
clockwise.
Š Extract the bulb (1) from the bulb holder.
WARNING
When fitting the bulb, ensure that the two locating
pegs locate properly into the slots in the bulb holder.
Š Install a new bulb of equal rating.
REAR DIRECTION INDICATOR BULBS
NOTE Disconnect one connector at a time to avoid
confusing the various connectors when refitting.
When two connectors must be removed at the same
time, mark them with their positions and make sure to
refit them in the original positions on assembly.
Š Twist the bulb holder (5) anti-clockwise.
Š Push down on the bulb (2) lightly and twist anti-
clockwise.
Š Extract the bulb (2) from the bulb holder.
WARNING
When fitting the bulb, ensure that the two locating 2
pegs locate properly into the slots in the bulb holder.
Š Install a new bulb of equal rating.

6.15.4 REPLACING THE NUMBER PLATE LIGHT


BULBS
B C D
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand. A
Š Release and remove the screw (1) and collect the nut.
Š Remove the light unit (2). E

WARNING
Do not pull on the wiring to extract the bulb holder.

Š Grasp the bulb holder (3) and pull to extract.


Š Extract the bulb (4) and fit a new bulb of equal rating. F

6 - 48 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.16 REPLACING THE FUSES


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 10 m
WARNING
Never attempt to repair a defective fuse.
Never use a fuse of a rating other than specified.
This could damage the electrical system or cause a
short circuit, with the risk of fire.

9/10 H
NOTE When the fuses fitted in a particular position

H
keep blowing frequently, there might be a short circuit or
overloading.
Checking the fuses is recommended whenever an
electrical component fails to operate or is malfunctioning,
or when the engine does not start.
Check the 15-A auxiliary fuses first and then the 30-A
main fuses.
Inspection:
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”. This will prevent
accidental short circuits.
Š Remove the cockpit bottom panel, see 7.1.20 (FRONT
FAIRING REMOVAL).
Š Take off the cover of the auxiliary fuse box (1).
Š Extract all fuses one by one and check for blown fuses.
A blown fuse is identified by the link bar (2) in the
centre being divided.
Š When you find a blown fuse, determine and rectify the
cause (if possible) before fitting a new fuse.
1
Š Replace any failed fuses with a fuse of equal current
rating.
NOTE When you use one of the spare fuses,
remember to add a new fuse of equal rating to the fuse
box.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Repeat the process for the main fuses.
NOTE When the 30-A fuses are removed, the digital
clock and red line setting will be reset to zero. Please
read 2.3 (MULTIFUNCTION COMPUTER) for
instructions on how to set clock and red line again.
ARRANGEMENT OF 15-A AUXILIARY FUSES
A From rectifier to:
headlight, instrument panel.
B From rectifier to:
fuel pump.
C From ignition switch to:
parking lights, rear brake lights, warning horn, direction
indicators. USA 1
D From ignition switch to:
starter, safety lockout system.
E From ignition switch to:
free.
NOTE The fuse box accommodates three spare fuses.
ARRANGEMENT OF 30-A MAIN FUSES
F From battery to: rectifier, fuse A, fuse B and fuse C.
G From battery to: ignition switch, fuse C and fuse D.
NOTE There is one spare fuse.

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 49 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

6.17 BEAM HEIGHT SETTING


NOTE Beam inspection procedures may vary from
country to country. Observe the law in force in the
country of the user.
TO SET BEAM HEIGHT:
Š Remove the cockpit right-hand facia panel, see 7.1.20
(FRONT FAIRING REMOVAL).
Š Sit astride the motorcycle.
Š Working on the rear right-hand side of the front fairing,
rotate the adjuster wheel (1):
– rotate clockwise to lower the beam;
– rotate anti-clockwise to raise the beam.
When finished:

WARNING
Check for proper beam height setting.

6.18 BEAM CENTRING USA

NOTE Beam inspection procedures may vary from


country to country. Observe the law in force in the
country of the user.
Always set beam height before proceeding to beam
horizontal adjustment. See 6.17 (BEAM HEIGHT
SETTING).
TO CENTRE THE BEAM:
Š Remove the cockpit left-hand facia panel, see 7.1.20
(FRONT FAIRING REMOVAL).
Š Sit astride the motorcycle.
Š Working from the left-hand side of the front fairing,
rotate the adjuster wheel (2):
– rotate clockwise to move the beam to the left;
– rotate anti-clockwise to move the beam to the right.
When finished:

WARNING
Ensure that the beam is properly centred.

6 - 50 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

6.19 WIRING DIAGRAM - RST MILLE FUTURA

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 51 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

Key:
1) Multi-pin connectors
2) Speed sensor
3) High beam relay
4) Low beam relay
5) Warning horn
6) Left-hand light dip switch
7) Flasher
8) Air thermistor (instrument panel)
9) Instrument panel
10) Coolant temperature thermistor (instrument panel)
11) Engine oil pressure switch
12) Right-hand light dip switch
13) Ignition switch
14) Engine cutout relay
15) Bank angle sensor
16) Fuel pump relay
17) Rear direction indicator, right
18) Parking light/rear brake light bulb
19) Parking light/rear brake light bulb
20) Rear direction indicator, left
21) Tail light
22) Rear brake light switch
23) Front brake light switch
24) Number plate light bulb
25) Diode module
26) Clutch lever switch
27) Neutral switch
28) Side stand switch
29) Starter motor
30) Starter relay
31) Battery
32) Main fuses (30A) (ignition)
33) Test connectors
34) Auxiliary fuses (15A)
A – headlight, instrument panel
B – fuel pump
C – parking lights, rear brake lights, warning horn
and direction indicators
D – starter, safety lockout system
E – spare

6 - 52 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM

35) –
36) Pick-up
37) Generator
38) Rectifier
39) Injection relay
40) –
41) Rear cylinder injector
42) Front cylinder injector
43) Cooling fans
44) Low fuel sensor
45) Fuel pump
46) Air thermistor (Engine Control Unit)
47) Coolant temperature thermistor (Engine Control Unit)
48) Throttle position sensor
49) Rear cylinder coil
50) Rear cylinder coil
51) Front cylinder coil
52) Front cylinder coil
53) Spark plugs
54) Automatic air adjustment
55) Engine Control Unit
56) Front direction indicator, left
57) Front parking light
58) Low beam bulb
59) High beam bulbs
60) High beam bulb
61) Headlight
62) Front direction indicator, right
63) Low fuel Led warning light
64) Side stand down Led warning light
65) Neutral Led warning light
66) Indicator Led repeater light
67) Engine oil pressure Led warning light
68) High beam Led warning light
69) Diagnostics Led warning light
70) Rev. counter
71) Multifunction display (on right-hand side)
72) Multifunction display (on left-hand side)
73) Diagnostics connector

Release 00/2001 - 11 6 - 53 - 00
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM RST mille

NOTES

6 - 54 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

CHASSIS
7

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 1 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

CHASSIS 7.1.40 REMOVING THE SEAT END COVER. 7-33-00


7.1.41 REMOVING THE SEAT LOWER MOULDED
COVER................................................. 7-34-00
7.1.42 REMOVING THE NUMBER PLATE
CONTENTS BRACKET............................................ 7-36-00
7.1.43 REMOVING THE PASSENGER FOOTPEG
7.1 BODYWORK..................................... 7-4-00 BRACKETS ......................................... 7-36-00
7.1.44 PASSENGER FOOTPEG REMOVAL . 7-37-00
0
7.1.1 SEAT REMOVAL................................... 7-6-00
7.1.2 REMOVING THE REAR SIDE PANELS 7-6-00 7.1.45 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND RIDER
7.1.3 REMOVING THE FRONT SIDE PANELS 7-7-00 FOOTPEG BRACKET ......................... 7-37-00
7.1.4 REMOVING THE SIDEBAG MOUNTS.. 7-7-00 7.1.46 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND RIDER
7.1.5 PARTIAL REMOVAL OF THE FUEL FOOTPEG BRACKET ......................... 7-38-00

1
TANK ..................................................... 7-8-00 7.1.47 REMOVING THE RIDER FOOTPEG ... 7-38-00
7.1.6 COMPLETE REMOVAL OF THE FUEL 7.1.48 REMOVING THE GEAR SHIFT LEVER
TANK ..................................................... 7-9-00 ASSEMBLY ......................................... 7-39-00
7.1.7 FUEL TANK FILLER CAP REMOVAL 7-10-00 7.1.49 REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE LEVER 7-40-00
7.1.8 AIRBOX REMOVAL ............................ 7-11-00 7.1.50 EXHAUST SILENCER REMOVAL ...... 7-41-00

2 7.1.9 BATTERY REMOVAL ......................... 7-12-00 7.1.51 REMOVING THE EXHAUST PIPES .... 7-42-00
7.1.10 REMOVING THE ENGINE CONTROL 7.1.52 EXPANSION CHAMBER REMOVAL.. 7-42-00
UNIT ..................................................... 7-13-00 7.1.53 REMOVING THE EXHAUST
7.1.11 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND MANIFOLDS ........................................ 7-43-00
TWISTGRIP ......................................... 7-13-00 7.1.54 SIDE STAND REMOVAL..................... 7-44-00

3 7.1.12 REMOVING THE CLUTCH CONTROL.. 7-15-00


7.1.13 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND HANDLEBAR
SWITCHGEAR..................................... 7-16-00
7.1.55 REMOVING THE ENGINE OIL TANK . 7-45-00
7.1.56 OIL COOLER REMOVAL .................... 7-46-00
7.1.57 REMOVING THE DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER 7-47-00
7.1.14 REMOVING THE THROTTLE CONTROL.. 7-16-00 7.1.58 UPPER CHAIN GUARD REMOVAL ... 7-48-00
7.1.15 REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE 7.1.59 REAR SUBFRAME REMOVAL ........... 7-48-00

4 CONTROL............................................ 7-17-00
7.1.16 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND HANDLEBAR
SWITCHGEAR..................................... 7-18-00
7.1.60 FRAME REMOVAL.............................. 7-49-00
7.2 FRONT WHEEL .............................. 7-51-00
7.1.17 REMOVING THE IGNITION SWITCH/ 7.2.1 WHEEL REMOVAL ............................. 7-52-00
STEERING LOCK................................ 7-19-00 7.2.2 WHEEL HUB DISASSEMBLY............. 7-53-00

5 7.1.18 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND 7.2.3 WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION . 7-54-00


HANDLEBAR....................................... 7-20-00 7.2.4 REFITTING THE WHEEL .................... 7-55-00
7.1.19 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND 7.3 REAR WHEEL ................................ 7-56-00
HANDLEBAR....................................... 7-20-00 7.3.1 WHEEL REMOVAL ............................. 7-57-00
7.1.20 FRONT FAIRING REMOVAL .............. 7-21-00

6
7.3.2 REFITTING THE REAR WHEEL ......... 7-58-00
7.1.21 REMOVING THE REARVIEW MIRRORS 7-22-00
7.1.22 HEADLIGHT REMOVAL ..................... 7-22-00 7.4 FINAL DRIVE ASSEMBLY.............. 7-60-00
7.1.23 REMOVING THE COCKPIT TOP 7.4.1 FINAL DRIVE REMOVAL.................... 7-61-00
PROTECTION MOULDING ................. 7-23-00 7.4.2 COMPONENT INSPECTION ............... 7-63-00
7.1.24 REMOVING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL 7-23-00 7.4.3 ECCENTRIC HUB REMOVAL............. 7-64-00
7 7.1.25 REMOVING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL/
FRONT FAIRING SUBFRAME............ 7-24-00
7.4.4 REAR CHAIN SPROCKET REMOVAL 7-64-00
7.5 FRONT BRAKE .............................. 7-65-00
7.1.26 REMOVING THE FRONT MUDGUARD. 7-25-00
7.1.27 WARNING HORN REMOVAL ............. 7-25-00 7.5.1 REPLACING THE BRAKE PADS ....... 7-66-00
7.1.28 REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS ...... 7-26-00 7.5.2 BRAKE DISC INSPECTION ................ 7-67-00

8 7.1.29 REMOVING THE FRONT DIRECTION


INDICATORS ....................................... 7-26-00
7.5.3 BRAKE DISC REMOVAL .................... 7-67-00
7.5.4 REMOVING THE BRAKE MASTER
7.1.30 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND AIR CYLINDER ........................................... 7-67-00
SCOOP ................................................ 7-27-00 7.6 REAR BRAKE................................. 7-68-00

9
7.1.31 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND AIR
7.6.1 REPLACING THE BRAKE PADS ....... 7-69-00
SCOOP ................................................ 7-28-00
7.6.2 REAR BRAKE CALIPER REMOVAL.. 7-70-00
7.1.32 REMOVING THE FRONT BOTTOM
7.6.3 BRAKE DISC INSPECTION ................ 7-71-00
PANEL ................................................. 7-28-00
7.6.4 BRAKE DISC REMOVAL .................... 7-72-00
7.1.33 REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING ... 7-29-00
7.6.5 REMOVING THE BRAKE MASTER
7.1.34 REMOVING THE AIR SCOOP
CYLINDER ........................................... 7-73-00
HOUSINGS .......................................... 7-30-00
7.1.35 REMOVING THE RADIATOR SPOILER 7-30-00 7.7 STEERING ..................................... 7-74-00
7.1.36 TAIL LIGHT REMOVAL....................... 7-31-00 7.7.1 HEADSTOCK REMOVAL.................... 7-75-00
7.1.37 GRAB RAIL REMOVAL ...................... 7-32-00 7.7.2 COMPONENT INSPECTION ............... 7-75-00
7.1.38 REMOVING THE SEAT LATCH.......... 7-32-00 7.7.3 HEADSTOCK RE-ASSEMBLY ........... 7-76-00
7.1.39 COMPLETE SEAT RELEASING SWITCH
REMOVAL ........................................... 7-33-00 7.8 FRONT FORK................................. 7-77-00

7 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.8.1 CHANGING FRONT FORK OIL ........... 7-78-00


7.8.2 REMOVING THE STANCHION TUBES –
SLIDERS .............................................. 7-78-00
7.8.3 DISASSEMBLING THE STANCHION TUBES –
SLIDERS .............................................. 7-79-00
7.8.4 COMPONENT INSPECTION................ 7-84-00
7.8.5 STANCHION TUBE – SLIDER
ASSEMBLY .......................................... 7-85-00
7.8.6 INSTALLING STANCHIONS AND
SLIDERS .............................................. 7-90-00
7.9 REAR SWINGING ARM.................. 7-91-00
7.9.1 REMOVING THE REAR SWINGING
ARM ...................................................... 7-91-00
7.9.2 DISMANTLING THE SWINGING ARM 7-92-00
7.9.3 COMPONENT INSPECTION................ 7-93-00
7.9.4 INSTALLING THE SWINGING ARM ... 7-94-00
7.10 REAR SUSPENSION...................... 7-96-00
7.10.1 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL 7-96-00
7.10.2 REMOVING THE REAR SUSPENSION
LINKAGES ........................................... 7-97-00
7.10.3 DISMANTLING THE REAR SUSPENSION
LINKAGE SYSTEM .............................. 7-98-00
7.10.4 COMPONENT INSPECTION................ 7-99-00
7.11 DISMANTLING THE DRIVE CHAIN 7-100-00
7.11.1 CHAIN TOOL...................................... 7-100-00
7.11.2 BREAKING THE CHAIN .................... 7-101-00
7.11.3 FITTING THE CONNECTING LINK ... 7-102-00
7.11.4 RIVETING THE LINK ......................... 7-103-00

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 3 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1 BODYWORK

3 4
5
2
7 8
9 11 12
10

13

23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14

Key:
1) Headlight 13) Drive chain
2) Air temperature sensor 14) Swinging arm
3) Left-hand rearview mirror 15) Centre stand
4) Seat lock 16) Side stand
5) Ignition switch / steering lock / parking lights 17) Gear shift lever
6) Clutch fluid reservoir 18) Engine Control Unit
7) Engine oil tank filler cap 19) Engine oil filter
8) Left-hand rider footpeg 20) Engine oil tank
9) Battery 21) Left-hand lower fairing
10) Main fuse box (30-A fuses) 22) Engine oil sight glass
11) Seat 23) Left-hand side fairing
12) Left-hand passenger footpeg (spring-loaded, snaps
closed / open)

7 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

8 9 10
1 2 3 4 6 7
5

15 11
14 13 12
17 16

Key:
1) Tail light
2) Right-hand passenger footpeg (spring-loaded, snaps
closed / open)
3) Glove / tool kit compartment
4) Rear shock absorber
5) Fuel tank
6) Fuel filler cap
7) Airbox
8) Front brake fluid reservoir
9) Auxiliary fuse box (15-A fuses)
10) Right-hand rearview mirror
11) Warning horn
12) Coolant expansion reservoir
13) Coolant expansion reservoir cap
14) Rear brake lever
15) Right-hand rider footpeg
16) Rear brake master cylinder
17) Rear brake fluid reservoir

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 5 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.1 SEAT REMOVAL


Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Insert the key (2) into the lock (3) on the left-hand side 2
of the instrument panel.
Š Turn the key (2) anti-clockwise, raise the seat (1) and
pull backwards to remove the seat complete with side
panels.
NOTE Before lowering and locking the seat (1) in
3
position, ensure that the key (2) is not stored in the glove/
tool kit compartment.
When refitting the seat (1), the seat latch should click
audibly into the locked position.
If needed:
Š Remove the front side panels, see 7.1.3 (REMOVING
THE FRONT SIDE PANELS).

7.1.2 REMOVING THE REAR SIDE PANELS


NOTE The procedure described below applies to both
side panels.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Place the seat on a supporting surface. 1
Š Release and remove the four screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 1 Nm


(0.1 kgm).
1
Š Remove the rear side panel (2).
NOTE If needed, repeat the process for the other rear
side panel.

7 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.3 REMOVING THE FRONT SIDE PANELS


1
NOTE The procedure described below applies to both
side panels.
Š Remove both rear side panels, see 7.1.2 (REMOVING
THE REAR SIDE PANELS).
Š Release and remove the five screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 1 Nm


(0.1 kgm).
NOTE Renew the three adhesive pads (2) when 1
refitting.

7.1.4 REMOVING THE SIDEBAG MOUNTS


NOTE The procedure described below applies to both
sidebag mounts. 3
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the screw (1). Collect the washer
and the bush from the inside.
1

Torque wrench setting for screw (1): 10 Nm 4


(1.0 kgm).
Š Release and remove the screw (2) and collect the
bush.

Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 10 Nm


(1.0 kgm).
Š Release and remove the two screws (3) and collect the
washers.
Š Remove the sidebag mount (4).
NOTE The longer bush (5) is fitted at the lower end, to
the screw (2). 5

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 7 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.5 PARTIAL REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK


see 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION), 1.2.1 (FUEL) and 4.1 (FUEL TANK)
carefully.

CAUTION
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure that the room is well ventilated before pro-
ceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Do not smoke or use bare flames near fuel vapours.
Do not release fuel into the environment.
FIRE AND/OR EXPLOSION HAZARD!
Allow the engine to cool down completely.
1

NOTE The fuel tank can be removed partially when


there is still fuel inside.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the seat, 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the connector (1) of the fuel pump.
WARNING
Ensure that the connector (1) is fitted to the matching 2
connector on assembly.
Š Detach the two drain hoses (2) pulling upwards.
Š Release and remove the two screws (9).

Torque wrench setting for screws (9): 3 Nm


(0.3 kgm).
Š Remove the guard (3).
Š Release and remove the two securing screws (4) at the
front end of the fuel tank (5). Collect the two washers 5
and replace the seals if damaged.
9
4
Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 8 Nm
(0.8 kgm).

WARNING
Place a cloth under the quick-disconnect male fitting
(6) to collect any fuel spillage. 9
9
Š Press the button (8) to release and separate the quick- 4
disconnect male fitting (6) from the female quick
disconnect (7).

WARNING
Ensure that the quick-disconnect male fitting locates
properly into the female fitting (7) on assembly.
Š Place a support near the left-hand side of the 6
motorcycle. The support should be about 60-cm high
and large enough to hold the fuel tank (5).
8
WARNING 7
The fuel tank (5) is still attached to the fuel delivery
line, which should never be disturbed unless strictly
necessary, 7.1.6 (COMPLETE REMOVAL OF THE
FUEL TANK).
Handle paint-finished parts with care to avoid
scratching or damage.

7 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Grasp the fuel tank (5) firmly at the front or rear end.
Raise the tank and place it on the support with the filler
cap uppermost. 5

WARNING
Ensure that the fuel tank is correctly positioned on
assembly so that the fuel lines and wiring do not
become twisted and/or trapped.

7.1.6 COMPLETE REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK


See 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION), 1.2.1 (FUEL) and 4.1 (FUEL TANK)
carefully. 3
WARNING 4
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure that the room is well ventilated before
proceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Do not smoke or use bare flames near fuel vapours. 1
Do not release fuel into the environment. 2
FIRE AND/OR EXPLOSION HAZARD!
Š Drain the fuel tank, see 2.9 (DRAINING THE FUEL
TANK).
Š Partially remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.5 (PARTIAL
REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK).
Š Turn over the fuel tank.
WARNING
Place a cloth under the drilled screw (1) to collect any
fuel spillage.
Š Slacken the drilled screw (1) by about one half turn.
Allow a few seconds for the pressure in the system to
blow off.
Š Release and remove the drilled screw (1) and collect
the two seals (2).

Torque wrench setting for drilled screw (1):


22 Nm (2.2 kgm).

WARNING
Renew the two seals (2) when refitting. Tighten the
drilled screw (1) to the specified torque. This is
critical to ensuring perfect sealing, as fuel injection
pressure is about 450 kPa (4.5 bar). Any fuel leaking
past the screw might get into contact with hot engine
parts and cause a fire.
On assembly, refer to the seat (3) to arrange the hose
(4) in the proper direction.
The fuel delivery hose (4) must not be twisted or
routed in such a manner that it might become
trapped. Always replace the hose when damaged or
degraded.
Š Remove the fuel tank.
Š Replace the front lower sound-deadening panel and
the rear lower heat insulator if damaged.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 9 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.7 FUEL TANK FILLER CAP REMOVAL


2
Read 1.2.1 (FUEL) and 4.1 (FUEL TANK) carefully.

CAUTION 1
3
Fuel vapours are harmful to human health.
Ensure that the room is well ventilated before pro-
ceeding.
Do not inhale fuel vapours.
Do not smoke or use bare flames near fuel vapours.
Do not release fuel into the environment. 1
FIRE AND/OR EXPLOSION HAZARD!
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Release and remove the three screws (1). 1

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm).
NOTE The other three screws are there for aesthetic
purposes only and can be left in place.
Š Open the filler cap (2).
WARNING
Be careful when removing the screw (3). Take care
not to drop it into the fuel tank.
Š Release and remove the screw (3).

Torque wrench setting for the screw (3): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm).
Š Remove the filler cap (2) together with the ring nut (4).
WARNING
Block off the filler opening to prevent the ingress of
dirt.

7 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.8 AIRBOX REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 2
4
Š Remove the air cleaner, see 2.10 (Air cleaner). 1
Š Release the clip (1) and detach the hose (2). 7
Š Release the two clips (3) and detach the two hoses (4).
Š Release the six screws (8).

Torque wrench setting for screws (8): 7 Nm


(0.7 kgm).
Š Lift the airbox (9).
Š Release the clip (5) and detach the hose (6). 3
Š Disconnect the connector (7) from the stepper motor.
WARNING
Make sure the connector is properly fitted to the
matching connector on assembly. 5
Š Remove the airbox (9) together with the intake manifold
(10).

WARNING
Block off the openings with a clean cloth to prevent
the ingress of debris into the intake ducts.
The intake manifold (10) must be properly positioned
and must adhere to the intake holes in the frame
perfectly.
Ensure that the airbox (9) is fully home on the throttle
body and into the intake manifold (10). 6
Fasten the clip (11) securely to the airbox (9) before
tightening the screws (8).
If the two intake funnels (12) have been removed,
ensure that the two O-rings are correctly seated in 9
12 8
place to prevent the ingress of debris into the engine.

12

8 8

10

11

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 11 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.9 BATTERY REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.4 (BATTERY) carefully. 1
2
NOTE When the battery is removed, the digital clock
and red line setting will be reset to zero.
See 2.3 (MULTIFUNCTION COMPUTER) for instructions
on how to set clock and red line.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the negative (-) terminal screw
(1).
Š Slide the negative lead (2) aside.
Š Lift the red protective cap (3).
Š Release and remove the positive (+) terminal screw
(4).
Š Slide the positive lead (5) aside.
WARNING 3
Do not pull on the wiring.
Š Remove the starter relay (6).
ŠRelease and remove the screw (7). 4

Torque wrench setting for screw (7): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm).
Š Raise the battery retaining bracket (8).
Š Grasp the battery (9) firmly and lift it out of its mount. 5

CAUTION
Once removed, the battery must be stored in a safe
place out of the reach of children.
Š Place the battery on a level surface, in a cool, dry
place.

WARNING
On refitting, connect the positive (+) lead first, then
the negative (-) lead.
Š On assembly, refit the battery (9) into its mount with the
terminals pointing towards the tail end of the
motorcycle.
7

6
9

7 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.10 REMOVING THE ENGINE CONTROL UNIT


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 3
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Remove the left-hand fairing, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING
THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Disconnect the two connectors (1) from the Ecu (2). 3
WARNING 2 1
Make sure the two connectors (1) are properly fitted
to the matching connectors on assembly.
Š Release and remove the two screws (3).

Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
Š Remove the Ecu (2).
WARNING
Each time the Engine Control Unit (2) is replaced, the
throttle position sensor has to be set, see 4.10.3
(THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR).

7.1.11 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND TWISTGRIP


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 1
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Hold the counterweight (1) steady with a pair of
adjustable pliers. Tape over the jaws of the pliers to
avoid damaging the counterweight.
Š Release and remove the screw (2).

Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 12 Nm 2


(1.2 kgm).
Š Remove the counterweight (1).
Š Slide out and remove the pin (3).
Š Slide out and remove the O-ring (4).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 13 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

Š Release and remove the end nut (5).

Torque wrench setting for twistgrip end nut (5):


35 Nm (3.5 kgm).

Š Withdraw the shaft (6) and the rubber sleeve (7). 7

Š Fit the nozzle of an air gun between twistgrip (8) and


handlebar (9).
Š Blow while twisting the nozzle tip. At the same time,
grasp the twistgrip (8) with the other hand and pull
outwards to remove.

7 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.12 REMOVING THE CLUTCH CONTROL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 4
INFORMATION) carefully. 3
1
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Release and remove the two screws (1) securing the 2
clutch control (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 10 Nm 5


(1 kgm).
Š Remove the clamp (3) and slide the clutch control (2)
aside.
NOTE The clamp (3) has an arrow etched in the top
section. Refit the clamp with the arrow pointing upwards.
When the clutch control (2) has to be taken off the
handlebar: 2 4
Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure described
in subsection 2.21 (CHANGING THE FRONT BRAKE
FLUID).
Š When all fluid has drained out, release and remove the
screw (4) and collect the two sealing washers.

Torque wrench setting for screw (4): 20 Nm


(2.0 kgm). 1
3
WARNING
Renew the two sealing washers on assembly. Use
washers of the same type fitted originally.
Š Lever the clutch switch (5) with a small flat-blade
screwdriver until releasing it from the two retainers on
the clutch control (2). 2
Š Remove the clutch control (2).
If the clutch slave cylinder has to be removed, 3.2.1
(CLUTCH SLAVE CYLINDER REMOVAL).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 15 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.13 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND HANDLEBAR


SWITCHGEAR
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 3
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Release and remove the two screws (1) that retain the
housing halves (2-3) at the bottom end.
2
Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 2 Nm
(0.2 kgm).
1
Š Separate the housing halves (2-3).
WARNING
Refit the bottom housing half (2) first on assembly.
Ensure that the locating peg locates into the hole in
the handlebar.
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).
Š Release the wiring harness from the two clips (4).
NOTE Make sure to have enough spare clips ready at
hand to secure the harness properly on refitting.
Š Disconnect the connector (5) of the left-hand light dip
switch.
4
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (5) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Remove the two housing halves (2-3).

7.1.14 REMOVING THE THROTTLE CONTROL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Perform the first nine steps of the procedure described 1
in subsection 7.1.11 (REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND
TWISTGRIP).
Š Release and remove the two screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 2 Nm


(0.2 kgm).
Š Remove the rear housing half (2) of the throttle control. 2
Š Remove the airbox, see 7.1.8 (AIRBOX REMOVAL).

7 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Slacken the locknut (3).


Š Release the throttle cable adjuster (4) from the throttle 3
cable anchor point.
Š Disconnect the throttle cable.
Š Repeat the last three steps for the other throttle cable.
WARNING
On refitting, ensure that both throttle cable adjusters 4
are fastened securely to their anchor points. Check
free play and adjust if needed. See 2.11.3 (THROTTLE
CABLE PLAY ADJUSTMENT).
Š Slide the pulley (5) aside and disconnect the two
throttle cables.
Š Remove the throttle twistgrip (6).

7.1.15 REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE CONTROL


3
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Release and remove the two clamp screws (2)
securing the front brake control (3). 4

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
1 2
Š Remove the clamp (1) and slide the front brake control
(3) aside. The front brake control is still retained by the
hose.
NOTE The clamp (1) has an arrow etched in the top
section. Refit the clamp with the arrow pointing upwards.
When the front brake control (3) has to be taken off the
handlebar:
Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure described
in subsection 2.21 (CHANGING THE FRONT BRAKE
FLUID).
Š When all fluid has drained out, release and remove the
screw (4) and collect the two sealing washers.

Torque wrench setting for the screw (4): 20 Nm


(2.0 kgm).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 17 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

WARNING
Renew the two sealing washers on assembly. Use
washers of the same type fitted originally. 3
Š Lever the front brake light switch (5) with a small flat-
blade screwdriver until it is clear of the two retainers on
the front brake control (3).
Š Remove the front brake control (3).

7.1.16 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND HANDLEBAR


SWITCHGEAR 1
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 2

Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.


Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the connector (1) of the right-hand light dip
switch.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Disconnect the connector (2).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (2) to the matching
connector on assembly.
6
Š Release and remove the two screws (3-4) securing the
two housing halves (5-6) at the bottom end.
NOTE The shorter screw (3) is fitted at the front end.
Ensure it is correctly positioned on assembly.
3
Š Separate and remove the two housing halves (5-6).
4 5
WARNING
Refit the bottom housing half (5) first on assembly.
Ensure that the locating peg locates into the hole in
the handlebar.

7 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.17 REMOVING THE IGNITION SWITCH/STEERING


LOCK
1
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the top yoke, see 2.28.2 (ADJUSTING PLAY
IN THE BEARINGS).
Š Disconnect connector (1) of the ignition switch
assembly at the main wiring harness.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Release and remove the screw (2) and collect the bush
(3).
NOTE Ensure that the wire guide (4) is positioned
correctly on assembly.
Š Tap the head of the special screw (5) with a chisel to
rotate the head and work the screw loose.
Š Turn out and remove the screw (5) manually. 6

NOTE Renew the special screw on assembly. Use a


4
screw of the same type fitted originally and tighten until
the head comes off.
Š Withdraw the ignition switch/steering lock (6) from the 5 3
bottom.
2

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 19 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.18 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND HANDLEBAR


Š Remove the twistgrip, see 7.1.11 (REMOVING THE
LEFT-HAND TWISTGRIP).
Š Remove the electric control, see 7.1.13 (REMOVING
THE LEFT-HAND HANDLEBAR SWITCHGEAR).
Š Remove the clutch control, see 7.1.12 (REMOVING
THE CLUTCH CONTROL).
Š Release and remove the screw (1). 1

Torque wrench setting for screw (1): 12 Nm


(1.2 kgm). 3
Š Slacken the screw (2).

Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
NOTE Grease the underside of the screw head before
refitting the screw (2).
3
Š Take the handlebar (3) off the front fork.

7.1.19 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND HANDLEBAR


Š Remove the throttle control, see 7.1.14 (REMOVING
THE THROTTLE CONTROL).
Š Remove the brake control, see 7.1.15 (REMOVING
THE FRONT BRAKE CONTROL).
Š Perform the last three steps of the procedure described
in subsection 7.1.18 (REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND
HANDLEBAR).

7 - 20 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.20 FRONT FAIRING REMOVAL


Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 3
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
ŠRelease and remove the two screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 3 Nm


(0.3 kgm).
ŠRemove the panel (2).
NOTE Change the rubber pad (3) if damaged. 1
ŠRelease and remove the two screws (4). 2

Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 3 Nm


(0.3 kgm).
Š Remove the cockpit right-hand facia panel (5).
Š Lift the cockpit left-hand facia panel (6) and release the
seat latch actuating cable (7).
Š Remove the cockpit left-hand facia panel (6). 15
Š Release and remove the two screws (14).
Š Remove the cockpit bottom panel (15).
Š Remove the instrument panel, see 7.1.24 (REMOVING 4
THE INSTRUMENT PANEL).
ŠRelease and remove the three screws (8) and collect
the three nuts. 5
Š Remove the windshield (9).
Š Remove the cockpit top protection moulding, 14 14
see 7.1.23 (REMOVING THE COCKPIT TOP
PROTECTION MOULDING).

WARNING
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care 9
to avoid scratching or damage. 6

Š Disconnect the connectors of the headlight (11), front


direction indicators (12) and air temperature sensor
8
(13) at the main wiring harness (10).
7
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connectors (11-12-13) to the
matching connectors on assembly.
Š Take off the front fairing together with headlight and
rearview mirrors.
Š Place the front fairing on a supporting surface.
If needed:
Š Remove the headlight, see 7.1.22 (HEADLIGHT
REMOVAL).
Š Remove the rearview mirrors, see 7.1.21 (REMOVING
THE REARVIEW MIRRORS).
12

12
13

11 10

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 21 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.21 REMOVING THE REARVIEW MIRRORS


Š Remove the cockpit facia panel on the same side as
the rearview mirror to be removed, see 7.1.20 (FRONT 2
FAIRING REMOVAL).
NOTE The following operations are best done with the
instrument panel removed, see 7.1.24 (REMOVING THE
INSTRUMENT PANEL).
Š Disconnect the connector (1) of the front direction
indicators.
Š When removing the left-hand rearview mirror, the
connector (2) of the air temperature sensor has to be 1
removed as well.

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connectors (1-2) to the
matching connectors on assembly.
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care
to avoid scratching or damage.
Š Release and remove the two nuts (3).
Š Remove the rearview mirror. Let the wiring slide
through the slot (4).
Š Collect the gasket (5).
NOTE If needed, repeat the process for the other 5
rearview mirror.

WARNING 3
After refitting the rearview mirrors, adjust mirror
4
position and tighten the nuts (3) to hold the mirrors
securely in position.

7.1.22 HEADLIGHT REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 2
INFORMATION) carefully.
2
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the four screws (2) and collect the
washers. 2

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 2 Nm 2


(0.2 km).
Š Remove the headlight (1) together with the front fairing 1
panels and place it on a supporting surface.
NOTE If needed, release and remove two screws that
retain the two front fairing panels.

7 - 22 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.23 REMOVING THE COCKPIT TOP PROTECTION


MOULDING
Š Remove the windshield, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL). 2
Š Release and remove the two retaining screws (1). 1

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).
Š Pull the protection moulding (2) backwards to remove.
1

7.1.24 REMOVING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL 2


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove both cockpit facia panels, see 7.1.20 (FRONT
FAIRING REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the two screws (2). Collect the
bushes and vibration-damping rubbers.

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).

WARNING 3
Replace the vibration-damping rubbers if damaged.
Š Ease out the instrument panel (3).
Š Slide back the protection sleeve to expose the
connectors (1) and disconnect the connectors from the
instrument panel (3).

WARNING
Make sure to refit the connectors (1) to the matching
connectors on assembly.
Š Remove the instrument panel (3).
1

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 23 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.25 REMOVING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL/FRONT


FAIRING SUBFRAME 1
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove both side fairing panels, see 7.1.28
(REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Remove the front fairing, see 7.1.20 (FRONT FAIRING
REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the two screws (1) and collect the
two nuts. 1
2

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 2 Nm


(0.2 kgm).
Š Remove the fuse box (2).
Š Extract the two light relays (3), the flasher (4) and the
bank angle sensor (5) from their mounts but leave them
connected to the wiring. 4 5

WARNING
Change the rubbers if damaged.

Š Release and remove the two nuts (7).

Torque wrench setting for nuts (7): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
Š Remove the two screws (8). 8
7

Š Remove the instrument panel/front fairing subframe


(6).

7 - 24 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.26 REMOVING THE FRONT MUDGUARD


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
2
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
ŠRelease and remove the two screws (1).
1
Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 5 Nm
(0.5 kgm).

WARNING
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care
to avoid scratching or damage.
Š Withdraw the mudguard (2) from the front.

7.1.27 WARNING HORN REMOVAL


2
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Remove the radiator spoiler, see 7.1.35 (REMOVING
THE RADIATOR SPOILER).
Š Disconnect the two connectors (1) of the warning horn. 1
WARNING
Make sure to refit the two connectors (1) to the
matching connectors on assembly. 3
Š Release and remove the two screws (2) to remove the
warning horn (3) complete with bracket.

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 25 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.28 REMOVING THE SIDE FAIRINGS

WARNING
Allow for the engine and exhaust silencer to cool
down completely.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Release and remove the three inner screws (1). 1

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 5 Nm 1


(0.5 kgm).
1
Š Release and remove the five upper screws (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 3 Nm


(0.3 kgm).
Š Release and remove the four lower screws (3).

Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 2 Nm


(0.2 kgm). 2
WARNING
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care 3 2
to avoid scratching or damage.
Š Remove the side fairing (4).
WARNING 4
Replace the sound-deadening lining of the fairing if
damaged.
NOTE If needed, repeat the process for the other side
fairing.

7.1.29 REMOVING THE FRONT DIRECTION


INDICATORS
Š If the front direction indicator needs replacing, remove 2
the rearview mirror, see 7.1.21 (REMOVING THE
REARVIEW MIRRORS).
Š If you need to replace just the lens (2):
- Release and remove the screw (1).
Š If you need to remove the reflector:
- Release and remove the screw (1);
- Remove the bulb, see 6.15.2 (REPLACING THE
FRONT DIRECTION INDICATOR BULBS);
- Remove the reflector. 1

7 - 26 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.30 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND AIR SCOOP


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Set the ignition switch to " ”. 2
Š Remove the side fairing, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING THE
SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Remove the headlight together with the front fairing
panels, see 7.1.22 (HEADLIGHT REMOVAL). 2
Š Disconnect the connector (1) from the air thermistor.
2
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching 5
connector on assembly. 2
Š Release and remove the ten screws (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 2 Nm


5 1
(0.2 kgm).
Š Release and remove the screw (3) and collect the
washer.

Torque wrench setting for screw (3): 10 Nm 2


(1 kgm).
Š Partially remove the Ecu subframe (4). Collect the bush
if it has been displaced in the process.
Š Withdraw the left-hand air scoop (5) from the insert.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 27 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.31 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND AIR SCOOP


Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure described
in subsection 7.1.30 (REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND 1
AIR SCOOP).
1
2
Š Release and remove the ten screws (1). 3

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 2 Nm


(0.2 kgm).
Š Release and remove the screw (2). 1
1

Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm).
Š Remove the right-hand air scoop (3).

7.1.32 REMOVING THE FRONT BOTTOM PANEL 1


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 2
Š Release and remove the three screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm). 1

WARNING
Take care not to damage the brake lines. Ease out the
1
front bottom panel (1) in small motions, until finding
the ideal position for smooth removal.
Š Remove the front bottom panel (2).

7 - 28 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.33 REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 5

CAUTION
Allow for the engine and exhaust silencer to cool
down completely.
4 2
Š Remove the side fairing on the side of the motorcycle
you need to work on, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING THE 1
SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Release and remove the two lower screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).
Š Release and remove the screw (5).
Š Release and remove the rear screw (2) and collect the 3
bush.

WARNING 7
Ensure that the bush is refitted correctly on
assembly. 6
4
Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 4 Nm
(0.4 kgm).
Release and remove the screw (3).

Torque wrench setting for screw (3): 2 Nm


(0.2 kgm).
Release and remove the screw (6).

Torque wrench setting for screw (6): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).

WARNING
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care
to avoid scratching or damage.
Š Remove the lower fairing (4) complete with the guard
(7).
NOTE If needed, repeat the process for the other lower
fairing panel.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 29 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.34 REMOVING THE AIR SCOOP HOUSINGS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 4
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove the air scoop on the side of the motorcycle
you are working on, see 7.1.30 (REMOVING THE
LEFT-HAND AIR SCOOP) or 7.1.31 (REMOVING 4
3
THE RIGHT-HAND AIR SCOOP).
Š Release the two clips (1) that retain the wiring (2) to the
air scoop housing (3). 1
WARNING
Make sure to route the wiring in the clips on
assembly. 2
Š Release and remove the two screws (4).

Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm).
Š Remove the air scoop housing (3).
NOTE Repeat the process for the other air scoop
housing if needed.

7.1.35 REMOVING THE RADIATOR SPOILER


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 4

CAUTION
Allow for the engine and exhaust silencer to cool
down completely.
Š Release and remove the two upper retaining screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 5 Nm 1


(0.5 kgm).
ŠRelease and remove the side retaining screw (2).

Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 5 Nm


(0.5 kgm).
Š Release and remove the two lower retaining screws (3). 2
4
Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 5 Nm
(0.5 kgm). 4

WARNING
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care
to avoid scratching or damage.
3
Š Push the radiator spoiler (4) forward and withdraw from
the side.
Š Change the sound-deadening lining of the spoiler if
damaged.

7 - 30 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.36 TAIL LIGHT REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 1
Š Set the ignition switch to “ ”.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the tail light connector (1).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly.
Š Release the wiring from the two clips (2) and from the
clip placed underneath the grab rail.

Š Release and remove the three retaining screws (3).


Collect the vibration-damping rubbers and the bushes.

Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 7 Nm


(0.7 kgm).

WARNING
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care
to avoid scratching or damage. 3

Š Remove the tail light assembly (4).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 31 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.37 GRAB RAIL REMOVAL


2
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
3
Š Perform the first four steps of the procedure described
in subsection 7.1.36 (TAIL LIGHT REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the three retaining screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).

WARNING 1
Handle all plastic and paint-finished parts with care
to avoid scratching or damage.
Š Remove the grab rail (2) together with the tail light.
WARNING
Make sure to route the tail light wiring correctly on
assembly.
Š Place the complete grab rail on a supporting surface.
NOTE If needed, the tail light can be separated from
the grab rail by unscrewing the three screws (3).

7.1.38 REMOVING THE SEAT LATCH


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
3
INFORMATION) carefully.
4
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Prise the clip (2) open with a screwdriver to release the
seat releasing cable (1). 1
Š Release and remove the two screws (3) securing the
seat releasing mechanism (4) to the rear subframe.

Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
2
Š Remove the seat releasing mechanism (4).

3
4

7 - 32 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.39 COMPLETE SEAT RELEASING SWITCH


REMOVAL 3
Š Remove the seat releasing mechanism, see 7.1.38
(REMOVING THE SEAT LATCH).
Š Release and remove the two screws (1). 2
2 1

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 1 Nm


(0.1 kgm)
Š Release and remove the screw (9). 1
9 7
Torque wrench setting for screw (9): 2 Nm
(0.2 kgm)
Š Lift the left-hand plate (2).
Š Remove the seat releasing cable (3) from its anchor
point (4).
Š Extract the cable nipple from the switch. 7
Š Remove the switch retainer (5) and collect the switch
mounting plate (6).
Š Remove the seat releasing switch (7) from the left-hand
plate (2).

4
5

WARNING
Make sure that the locating tab (8) locates properly 6
into the recesses in the switch mounting plate (6) and
retainer (5) on assembly.

8
7

7.1.40 REMOVING THE SEAT END COVER


Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Remove the seat latch, see 7.1.38 (REMOVING THE
SEAT LATCH).
Š Disconnect the tail light connector (1).
WARNING
Make sure to refit the connector (1) to the matching
connector on assembly. 1

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 33 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

Š Release the wiring from the two clips (2).


Š Slide the wiring (4) aside. 4
Š Remove both sidebag mounts, see 7.1.4 (REMOVING
THE SIDEBAG MOUNTS). 2
Š Release and remove the two screws (3). 3
3
Torque wrench setting for screws (3): 3 Nm
(0.3 kgm)
Š Remove the seat end cover.
2

7.1.41 REMOVING THE SEAT LOWER MOULDED


COVER
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove the grab rail, see 7.1.37 (GRAB RAIL
REMOVAL). 1
Š Remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.5 (PARTIAL REMOVAL
OF THE FUEL TANK).
Š Take the tool kit and any personal belongings out of the
glove compartment.
Š Remove the battery,see 7.1.9 (BATTERY REMOVAL).
Š Remove the silencer, see 7.1.50 (EXHAUST
SILENCER REMOVAL).
Š Remove the seat end cover, see 7.1.40 (REMOVING
THE SEAT END COVER).
Š Slide the water drain hose (1) downwards.
WARNING
Ensure that the water drain hose is routed correctly
on assembly.
2
Š Release the starter relay housing (2) from its mount.
Š Release the fuse carrier (3) from its mount.
WARNING
Ensure that the electrical items are fitted in the
correct position and the wiring routed properly on
assembly.
3

7 - 34 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Release and remove the two front retaining screws (4).

Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 10 Nm


(1 kgm). 4
Š Release and remove the three screws (5) and collect
the three clips (6).

Torque wrench setting for screws (5): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).
ŠRelease and remove the screw (7).

Torque wrench setting for screw (7): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).
Š Push down on the moulded cover front while raising the 5
rear end of cover (8). 5
Š Pull seat moulded cover (8) backwards to extract. 9
WARNING 6
Replace the self-adhesive seal (9) if worn or
damaged.
6

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 35 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.42 REMOVING THE NUMBER PLATE BRACKET


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove both sidebag mounts, see 7.1.4 (REMOVING
THE SIDEBAG MOUNTS).
Š Disconnect the number plate light connector (1). 1
WARNING
Make sure to refit the number plate light connector
(1) to the matching connector on assembly.
Š Remove the complete number plate bracket (2).
NOTE If needed, the individual components can be
separated.

7.1.43 REMOVING THE PASSENGER FOOTPEG


BRACKETS
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 1
1
Š Remove the seat, see 7.1.1 (SEAT REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the two screws (1).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).

Š Remove footpeg bracket (2) complete with footpeg.


Š Separate footpeg (3) from bracket, if needed;
see 7.1.47 (REMOVING THE RIDER FOOTPEG). 2

NOTE Repeat process to remove the other passenger


footpeg bracket, if needed.

7 - 36 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.44 PASSENGER FOOTPEG REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
CAUTION
Allow for the engine and exhaust silencer to cool 2
down completely. 1
Š Remove the retaining ring (1). 4
Š Withdraw the spindle (2).
WARNING 3
6
The ball (5) sits on a spring (6) and might be thrown 5 7
out due to spring action on disassembly. Proceed
carefully and make sure to collect the ball.
Š Remove the footpeg (3) and collect the two shims (4-
7), the ball (5) and the spring (6).

WARNING
Do not confuse the two shims (4-7). Ensure that each
shim is refitted in the original position on assembly.
NOTE Repeat the process to remove the other footpeg
if needed.

7.1.45 REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND RIDER


FOOTPEG BRACKET 3
2
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
Š Remove the lower fairing, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING 2
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Release and remove the screw (1) securing the gear
shift lever to the left-hand footpeg bracket.
1
Torque wrench setting for screw (1): 15 Nm
(1.5 kgm).
Š Withdraw the lever. The lever is now retained by the
rod.
Š Release and remove the two screws (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
Š Remove the complete footpeg bracket (3).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 37 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.46 REMOVING THE RIGHT-HAND RIDER


FOOTPEG BRACKET 3
Š Perform the first two steps of the procedure described
in subsection 7.1.45 (REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND
RIDER FOOTPEG BRACKET).
Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure described
in subsection 7.1.49 (REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE 1
LEVER). 2
Š Release and remove the two screws (1) securing the
rear brake master cylinder (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
Š Collect the guard (3).
Š Release and remove the screw (4).

Torque wrench setting for screw (4): 10 Nm 5


(1 kgm). 4
Š Move aside the rear brake master cylinder (2) together
with the rear brake fluid reservoir (5). Keep the
reservoir level to avoid spilling brake fluid.
Š Release and remove the two screws (6). 7

Torque wrench setting for screws (6): 25 Nm 6


(2.5 kgm). 8
Š Remove the footpeg bracket (7) complete with brake
lever (8).
NOTE The brake lever (8) can be separated from the
footpeg bracket if needed.

7.1.47 REMOVING THE RIDER FOOTPEG


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 2
INFORMATION) carefully. 1
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand.
CAUTION
Allow for the engine and exhaust silencer to cool
down completely.
3

Š Remove the retaining ring (1).


Š Withdraw the spindle (2). 4
Š Collect footpeg (3) and spring (4).
NOTE Repeat the process to remove the other rider
footpeg if needed.

7 - 38 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.48 REMOVING THE GEAR SHIFT LEVER


ASSEMBLY 1 2
WARNING
Mark lever and spindle before removal to ensure they
are refitted in the correct position on assembly.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Remove the left-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Slacken the screw (1) and slide the clamp (2) off the
spindle.

Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
Š Release and remove the spindle (3) and collect the
washer (4).
Š Withdraw the gear shift pedal (5) from the side together
with the actuating rods.
NOTE Replace the individual components if needed. 3

4
3
2

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 39 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.49 REMOVING THE REAR BRAKE LEVER


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the stand. 6
Š Move the safety ring (1) aside.
Š Rotate the pin (2) of the clevis pin fork downwards.
Š Withdraw the pin (2) of the clevis pin fork.
Š Unhook the spring (3) from the lever (4).
Š Remove the rear brake light switch (5).
1
2
Torque wrench setting for rear brake light switch
(5): 10 Nm (1 kgm).
Š Release and remove the pivot bolt (6) and collect the
washer (7).
Š Remove the lever (4).
Š Remove the bush (8) if needed.
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the thread of the pivot 3
bolt (6) on assembly.

4
Torque wrench setting for pivot bolt (6): 15 Nm
(1.5 kgm).

6
7
8

7 - 40 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.50 EXHAUST SILENCER REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove the grab rail, see 7.1.37 (GRAB RAIL
REMOVAL).
Š Disconnect the number plate light/tail light connector
(9).
1
WARNING 3
Make sure to refit the number plate light/tail light
connector (9) to the matching connector on
9
assembly.
ŠSlacken the clamp (1) retaining the silencer (2) to the
exhaust pipes (3).

WARNING
On refitting, ensure that the silencer is up against the
clamp (1) that is secured to the exhaust pipe (3).
Apply black silicone between silencer (2) and 5
exhaust pipes when refitting; see 2.41 (FASTENERS).
Š Release and remove the screw (4) and collect the nut
(5).

Torque wrench setting for screw (4): 10 Nm


4
(1 kgm).
Š Remove the exhaust silencer (2) together with number
plate bracket (8).
Š Collect the two rubbers (6).
WARNING
Inspect the rubbers (6) and renew them if damaged. 2
Š If needed, release and remove the four screws (7) to
detach the number plate bracket complete with side 7
guards (8).

6 6

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 41 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.51 REMOVING THE EXHAUST PIPES


2
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
2
Š Remove the exhaust silencer, see 7.1.50 (EXHAUST
SILENCER REMOVAL).
Š Unhook the two springs (1) to release them from the 1
expansion chamber.
Š Inspect the two springs (1) and replace them if
damaged. 1
Š Twist the exhaust pipes (2) slightly in both directions to
eliminate any resistance due to scale accumulation.
Š Withdraw the exhaust pipes (2) pulling upwards.
NOTE Block off the outlet of the expansion chamber to
prevent the ingress of dirt.

7.1.52 EXPANSION CHAMBER REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 3
INFORMATION) carefully. 1 2
Š Remove both lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING 1
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Remove the exhaust pipes, see 7.1.51 (REMOVING
THE EXHAUST PIPES). 5
Š Slacken the three nuts (3) just enough to allow minor
movement of the rear cylinder exhaust manifold (2).

Torque wrench setting for nuts (3): 25 Nm 4


(2.5 kgm).
Š Unhook the two springs (1) to release them from the
expansion chamber (4).
Š Release and remove the screw (5).

Torque wrench setting for screw (5): 25 Nm 2


(2.5 kgm). 5
Š Rock the expansion chamber (4) gently to eliminate
any resistance due to scale accumulation.
1
Š Withdraw the expansion chamber (4).

7 - 42 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.53 REMOVING THE EXHAUST MANIFOLDS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 5
INFORMATION) carefully. 3
1
Š Remove the expansion chamber, see 7.1.52
1 4
(EXPANSION CHAMBER REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the three nuts (1) securing the 2
flange of the exhaust manifold (2) to the front cylinder.

Torque wrench setting for nuts (1): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
Š Release and remove the three nuts (3) securing the
flange of the exhaust manifold (4) to the rear cylinder.

Torque wrench setting for nuts (3): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).

WARNING
Use great care when removing the exhaust manifolds
(4-2) from the cylinders, or you might strip the
threads of the stud bolts.
Š Rotate the exhaust manifold (4) and extract as shown
in the picture. 4
Š Push the exhaust manifold (2) forward until the flange
is clear of the front cylinder stud bolts.
Š Rotate the exhaust manifold (2) and remove.
WARNING
Check the gaskets (5) and replace with new gaskets
of the same type fitted originally if needed.
NOTE Block off the engine outlets to prevent the
ingress of dirt.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 43 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.54 SIDE STAND REMOVAL


3
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 7
2
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
WARNING
Take care not to damage the switch (1).
The nut (2) should never be disturbed while the
switch (1) is in place.
Š Unhook the two springs (3).
Š Release and remove the screw (4) and collect the
4
washer (5). 5
6 1

Torque wrench setting for screw (4): 10 Nm


(1.0 kgm).
Š Withdraw the switch (1).
WARNING
Ensure that the switch (1) locates properly on the
special anti-rotation peg on assembly (the switch has
a suitable recess).
Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the switch (1) before
assembly.
These operations are best done with the side stand
folded up.
Š Undo and remove the nut (2).

Torque wrench setting for nut (2): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
Š Release and remove the pivot bolt (6).

Torque wrench setting for pivot bolt (6): 10 Nm


(1.0 kgm).
Š Remove the side stand (7).

7 - 44 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.55 REMOVING THE ENGINE OIL TANK


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 8
INFORMATION) and 1.2.2 (ENGINE OIL) carefully.
Š Remove the left-hand air scoop housing, see 7.1.34
(REMOVING THE AIR SCOOP HOUSINGS).
Š Drain all engine oil, see 2.13 (ENGINE OIL AND
FILTER CHANGE).
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part
no. 0277295) ready at hand. Renew all clips using new
clips of the same type fitted originally on assembly. 4
2
Š Release the clips (2-3).
Š Withdraw the hoses (4-5).
Š Release and remove the upper retaining screw (6).

Torque wrench setting for screw (6): 10 Nm


(1.0 kgm).
NOTE Change the seal if damaged.
Š Undo and remove the two nuts (7-8).
3
Torque wrench setting for nuts (7-8): 5 Nm 5
(0.5 kgm). 12
NOTE Change the two silent-blocks if damaged.
Š Ease the tank (9) off the two silent-blocks.
Š Release the clip (10).
Š Withdraw the oil tube (11).
Š Remove the complete tank (9).
Š Release and remove the engine oil tank filter (12) and
blow it with compressed air.
Š Check the seal of engine oil tank filter (9). Refit and 6
tighten the filter.
Š If needed, release and remove the two screws (13) to
extract the oil sight glass (1) and collect the seals.

Torque wrench setting for screws (13): 20 Nm


(2.0 kgm).
NOTE Replace oil sight glass and seals if damaged.

9 7

13 11

10

1
9

13

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 45 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.56 OIL COOLER REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 6
INFORMATION) and 1.2.2 (ENGINE OIL) carefully.
2

Š Drainall engine oil, see 2.13 (ENGINE OIL AND


FILTER CHANGE).
NOTE Make sure to have the special clip pliers (part 7
no. 0277295) ready at hand. Renew all clips using new
clips of the same type fitted originally on assembly. 4
Š Release the clips (2-3).
Š Withdraw the hoses (4-5).
Š Release and remove the three retaining screws (6-7-8). 9

Torque wrench setting for screws (6-7-8): 10 Nm


(1.0 kgm).
NOTE Replace the seals if damaged. 1
Š Remove the oil cooler (1).

8
3
5

7 - 46 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.1.57 REMOVING THE DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER


Š Remove the guide plate, see 2.35.4 (DRIVE CHAIN
GUIDE PLATE INSPECTION). 4
3
NOTE Engage the first gear to lock out sprocket (4) 2
movement while turning out the screw (1).
Š Release and remove the screw (1) and collect the two 5
washers (2-3).
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the thread of the screw
(1) on assembly. 1

Torque wrench setting for screw (1): 50 Nm


(5 kgm).
NOTE Slacken the drive chain a bit to facilitate removal
of the drive sprocket (4). See 2.35.3 (CHAIN SLACK
ADJUSTMENT).
Š Withdraw the drive sprocket (4) together with the chain
from the shaft. 7
Š Remove the drive sprocket (4). 8
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® Anti-Seize to the inner toothing
of the drive sprocket (4) on assembly.
Š Remove the upper chain guard, see 7.1.58 (UPPER
CHAIN GUARD REMOVAL).
Š Release and remove the screws (5-6).
6
Torque wrench setting for screws (5-6): 4 Nm
(0.4 kgm).
Š Pull the chain slider (7) from the front to remove.
NOTE Ensure that the slider recess (7) locates on the
seat (8) on the swinging arm on assembly. Apply
LOCTITE® 243.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 47 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.1.58 UPPER CHAIN GUARD REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Release and remove the screw (1). 1

Torque wrench setting for screw (1): 4 Nm 2


(0.4 kgm).
Š Release and remove the screw (2).

Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 4 Nm


3
(0.4 kgm).
Š Release and remove the screw (3).

Torque wrench setting for screw (3): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).
Š Release and remove the two screws (4). 5

Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 4 Nm


(0.4 kgm).
Š Lift and remove the cable guide (5).
Š Remove the outer guard (7). 3
Š Move the odometer cable and the rear brake line away
from the upper chain guard (6).
Š Pull the upper chain guard (6) from the rear to remove.

1 4

4
5

6
7

7.1.59 REAR SUBFRAME REMOVAL


5 4
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 4
INFORMATION) carefully. 5
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Remove seat lower moulded cover, see 7.1.41
(REMOVING THE SEAT LOWER MOULDED 3
COVER).
Š Release and remove the two screws (3). 1
Š Release and remove the four screws (1) securing the
rear subframe (2) to the frame. 2
1
Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 25 Nm
(2.5 kgm).
Š Pull the rear subframe (2) from the rear to remove.

7 - 48 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

NOTE If needed, remove the components attached to


the rear subframe (2) as follows: 5 4
4
Š Remove the two rubbers (4) at the fuel tank pivot points 5
and collect the two spacers (5);
Š Remove the passenger footpeg brackets, see 7.1.43
(REMOVING THE PASSENGER FOOTPEG
3
BRACKETS).
1

2
1

7.1.60 FRAME REMOVAL

WARNING 5
Frame (1) removal must be carried out at an Authorised
Service Centre or by Authorised aprilia Dealers.
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
4
WARNING
Frame (1) removal is a complex operation. Plan work
ahead and locate affected parts on the vehicle before 1
proceeding.
2
Removal procedures are listed in the proper sequence in
6 3
this section.
Each procedure is cross-referred to the relevant section
of the manual and some of the operations described
there may not be necessary for the job at hand. To avoid
redundant work, always make sure you really need to
remove a particular component before proceeding.
Be sure to perform just the operations strictly required to
give access to the component to be removed.
Š Remove the engine, see 3.3 (TAKING THE ENGINE
OUT OF THE FRAME).
Š Place the motorcycle on the special centre stand ,
see 1.9.2 (PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
CENTRE STAND).
Š Remove the front end complete with front wheel
assembly, see 7.7.1 (HEADSTOCK REMOVAL).
Š Remove the instrument panel subframe, see 7.1.25
(REMOVING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL/FRONT
FAIRING SUBFRAME).
Š Remove the air scoop housings, see 7.1.34
(REMOVING THE AIR SCOOP HOUSINGS).
Š Remove the complete rear subframe (4), see 7.1.59
(REAR SUBFRAME REMOVAL).
Š Remove the tail end complete with rear wheel
assembly, see 7.9.1 (REMOVING THE REAR
SWINGING ARM).
Š Remove the rear shock absorber, see 7.10.1 (REAR
SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL).
Š Remove the control unit mount (3).
ŠDisconnect the ignition coil terminals.
WARNING
Ensure the terminals are refitted to the matching
connectors on assembly.
Š Collect the fairing bracket (5).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 49 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

WARNING
Remove the control unit mount with great care to 5
avoid damaging the engine control unit.
Š Remove the radiator bracket (6).
Š Remove both rider footpeg brackets, see 7.1.45
(REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND RIDER FOOTPEG
BRACKET) and see 7.1.46 (REMOVING THE RIGHT- 4
HAND RIDER FOOTPEG BRACKET).

WARNING 1
Release all wiring clips along the whole length of the 2
wiring. 6 3
Make sure to have enough spare clips to secure the
wiring on assembly.
Š Disconnect the connector of the side stand switch.
WARNING 7
Make sure to refit the connector to the matching
connector on assembly.

WARNING
Use great care when removing the side stand bracket
(8) or you might damage the switch.
Š Release and remove the three screws (7) and remove
the side stand bracket (8) complete with side stand and 8
switch.

Torque wrench setting for screws (7): 40 Nm


(4.0 kgm).
Š Place the frame (1) in a sling and hook the slings to a
hoist to support the frame.

WARNING
Slings and hoist must have adequate carrying
capacity to support the frame (1) in full safety.
Frame weight: 9.9 Kg.
Š Lift
the frame (1) just enough to allow removal of the
centre stand .
Š Remove the centre stand.
After re-installing the frame, check the following:
Š Ensure that all components are fastened securely.
Š Check that wiring and cables are properly routed and
fastened.
Š Ensure that all connectors are properly fitted to the
matching connectors.
Š Turn the handlebars and check that cables and tubes
do not bind.

7 - 50 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.2 FRONT WHEEL

10 9
2
4

8
7 5
2

3
11
1

Key
1) Wheel spindle
2) Seal
3) Seal
4) Bearing
5) Inner spacer
6) Wheel assembly
7) Circlip
8) Right-hand spacer
9) Washer
10) Nut
11) Left-hand spacer
„ = GREASE, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 51 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.2.1 WHEEL REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.32 (FRONT WHEEL) carefully.
1
WARNING
Use great care when removing the wheel to avoid
damaging the brake lines, brake discs and brake 4
pads.
Š Place the motorcycle on the front wheel stand ,
see 1.9.1 (PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON THE
FRONT WHEEL STAND). 2

WARNING
Ensure that the motorcycle is safely supported and
stable.
Š Have an assistant hold the handlebars steady in
position as in forward travel so that the steering cannot
move.
ŠRelease and remove the two mounting bolts (1) of
the front brake caliper (2).
3
Torque wrench setting for caliper mounting
bolts (1): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
ŠRemove the brake caliper (2) from the brake disc, but 5
leave the caliper attached to the brake line.

WARNING
Do not operate the front brake lever when the
calipers are not in place, or the pistons might fall out
leading to brake fluid spillage.
Š Undo and remove the nut (4) and collect the washer.

Torque wrench setting for wheel hub nut (4):


80 Nm (8.0 kgm).
Š Slacken but do not remove the two wheel spindle 3
clamp bolts (5). 6

Torque wrench setting for wheel spindle clamp


bolts (5): 22 Nm (2.2 kgm).
5

Š Withdraw the wheel spindle (3) from the left-hand side.


Š Remove the wheel pulling from the front and collect the
left-hand spacer (6).
Š Remove the wheel hub if needed; see 7.2.2 (WHEEL
HUB DISASSEMBLY).

7 - 52 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.2.2 WHEEL HUB DISASSEMBLY


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 1
INFORMATION) carefully. 3
Š Remove the wheel, see 7.2.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
Š Clean the wheel hub at both ends with a cloth.
Š Remove the right-hand spacer (1).
NOTE The right-hand spacer (1) must be refitted with
the larger diameter end facing the right-hand fork leg.
2
ŠRemove the seal (2).
Š Remove the left-hand bearing (4) using a suitable 5
bearing extractor.
Š Remove the circlip (3).
Š Remove the right-hand bearing (5) using a suitable
bearing extractor.

WARNING
Inspect the bearings after each removal and replace 5
as required. See 7.2.3 (WHEEL COMPONENT
INSPECTION).
Š Collect the inner spacer (6). 6
Š Clean the hub bore thoroughly.
NOTE Wash all components using clean detergent. 2
WARNING
Refit the bearings using a drift with the same
diameter as the bearing outer ring.
Do not tap the balls or the inner ring. 4
Ensure that:
- the right-hand bearing (5) is fully home in the hub;
- the spacer (6) is fully home on the right-hand
bearing (5);
- the left-hand bearing (4) is fully home on the
spacer (6).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 53 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.2.3 WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION

WARNING
Check that all components are in perfect condition.
Inspect the following components with special care.
BEARINGS
1
Š Rotate the inner ring (1) manually. The ring should turn
smoothly, with no hardness or noise.
There should be no end float.
Replace any bearings that do not meet the above
requirements.
SEALS
Š Inspect the seals for damage or wear and replace as
required.
WHEEL SPINDLE
Š Check spindle (2) run-out using a dial gauge. Replace 60 70
80

the spindle (2) when run-out exceeds the maximum


50 90

40 100

limit allowed.
30 110

20 120

Wheel spindle run-out limit: 0.25 mm.


10

WHEEL RIM
Š Use a dial gauge to ensure that wheel rim (3) radial (A)
and axial (B) run-out does not exceed the maximum
limit allowed. 2
Exceeding run-out is normally due to worn or damaged
bearings.
Replace the bearings first, then re-check run-out.
Replace the wheel rim (3) if it still exceeds the
maximum limit allowed.
Wheel rim radial and axial run-out limit: 2 mm.
TYRE
Š Check tyre condition, see 2.36 (TYRES). 50

40
60 70
80

90

100

30 110

20 120

10

0
021

011
0

001
01

09
02

08
03

3
07
04

06
05

7 - 54 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.2.4 REFITTING THE WHEEL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.

WARNING
Use great care when refitting the wheel to avoid damaging
the brake lines, brake discs and brake pads. The arrow
mark on the hub points in the direction of rotation. Make
sure to refit the wheel in the correct direction.
Š Smear a light coat of grease over the total length of the
wheel spindle (1), see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
Š Position the left-hand spacer (7) to the wheel.
Š Place the wheel between the fork legs.
WARNING
Do not attempt to align the holes by putting your fingers
into the holes. This could result in severe personal injury.
Š Move the wheel until the wheel hub bore aligns with the
holes in the forks.
Š Slide the wheel spindle (1) fully home.
Š Fit the washer and screw the nut (3) hand-tight.
Š Tighten the two wheel spindle clamp bolts (4) to
prevent wheel spindle (1) rotation. 7

Torque wrench setting for wheel spindle clamp


bolts (4): 22 Nm (2.2 kgm).
Š Tighten the nut (3) to the specified torque.

Torque wrench setting for wheel hub nut (3):


80 Nm (8.0 kgm).
Š Tighten the two wheel spindle clamp bolts (5) to the
specified torque.

Torque wrench setting for wheel spindle clamp


bolts (5): 22 Nm (2.2 kgm).
1
WARNING
Use great care or you might damage the brake pads.
4
ŠFit the brake caliper (6) to the brake disc with the mount-
ing holes aligned with the holes in the caliper carrier.

WARNING
Replace both caliper mounting bolts (2) with new
bolts of the same type fitted originally.
ŠStart the two caliper mounting bolts (2) in their holes
and tighten to the specified torque.

Torque wrench setting for caliper mounting


bolts (2): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
Š Slacken the two wheel spindle clamp bolts (4). 2
Š Hold in the front brake lever and press down on the
handlebars repeatedly to pump the front fork up and down. 3
This will allow the fork legs to seat themselves properly.
Š Tighten the two wheel spindle clamp bolts (4).

Torque wrench setting for wheel spindle clamp 6


bolts (4): 22 Nm (2.2 kgm).
5
WARNING
After refitting the wheel, work the front brake lever
repeatedly and check for proper operation of the brake.
Ensure that the wheel is properly centred and balanced.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 55 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.3 REAR WHEEL

1
3
4 6

2
8
5 „

Key
1) Wheel bolt cap
2) O-ring
3) Circlip
4) Wheel bolt stop nut
5) Wheel bolt
6) Wheel cable
7) Wheel
8) Wheel spindle
„ = GREASE, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).

7 - 56 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.3.1 WHEEL REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.33 (REAR WHEEL)carefully.

CAUTION
Allow for the engine and exhaust silencer to cool 1
down completely.
Use great care when removing the wheel to avoid
damaging the brake lines, brake discs, brake pads
and speed sensor cable.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Release and remove the cap (1) using the compass
tool.
Š Remove the circlip (2).
Š Take out the wheel bolt stop nut (3).
Š Engage the first gear to prevent wheel rotation.
Š Insert the socket (5) supplied with the tool kit into the
wheel bolt hole (4).
Š Fit the torque wrench to the socket (5) hexagon.
4
2
Torque wrench setting for wheel bolt: 170 Nm
(17 kgm).

CAUTION
The drive shaft has a key (7).
Ensure that the key (7) does not fall out of the keyway
during wheel removal.
If the key is accidentally displaced: 3
Š Engage neutral.
Š Rotate the wheel until bringing the key (7) in the
lowermost position.
Š Remove the wheel (8).
Š Collect the centring bush (9).

8 9

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 57 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.3.2 REFITTING THE REAR WHEEL

CAUTION 3
Ensure that the key (1) is in place in the keyway and
is fitted in the proper mounting position before refit-
ting the wheel. Refit the key properly if it has been
displaced. Never omit to fit the key. 1
Š Rotate the drive shaft until bringing the key (1) in the
uppermost position.
Š Fit the wheel (2) to the drive shaft making sure that the 3
three driving pegs (3) locate properly into the wheel.
Š Engage the first gear to prevent wheel rotation. 3
Š Ensure that the key (1) is in place in the drive shaft
keyway.
Š Position the centring bush (4) taking care to align the
groove (5) with the key (1).
Š Apply a light coat of grease to the thread of the wheel 2
mounting bolt (6).
Š Screw the wheel mounting bolt (6) hand-tight.
Š Insert the socket (8) into the bolt hole (7).
Š Fit the torque wrench to the socket (8) hexagon.
CAUTION
Make sure to tighten the wheel mounting bolt (6) to
the specified torque. 4
5
Torque wrench setting for wheel mounting bolt
(6): 170 Nm (17 kgm).
Š Tighten the wheel mounting bolt (6).

Š Fitthe wheel bolt stop nut (9) into the bolt hole (7).
Rotate the nut to establish the position that allows full
engagement. 7

7 - 58 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Fit the circlip (10) in the correct position.

10

Š Refit and tighten the cap (11) using the compass tool
(12).

WARNING
After refitting the wheel, work the rear brake lever
repeatedly and check for proper operation of the
brake.
Ensure that the wheel is properly centred and 11 12
balanced.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 59 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.4 FINAL DRIVE ASSEMBLY

9
8
4
3
1

2 6 19
5
18
20
15
14

21
16 10
12
24 25 11
13
17
22
27
23
26

Key:
1) Eccentric hub 18) Belleville washer
2) Bearing 19) Roller cage
3) Needle cage 20) Thrust ring
4) Retaining ring 21) Ring
5) Circlip 22) O-ring
6) Thrust spacer 23) Cush drive housing
7) Circlip 24) Belleville washer
8) O-ring 25) Screw
9) O-ring 26) Screw
10) Needle cage 27) Screw
11) O-ring
12) Rear chain sprocket carrier
13) Rear chain sprocket
14) Screws
15) Shim
16) Self-locking castellated nuts
17) Cush drive rubbers

7 - 60 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.4.1 FINAL DRIVE REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
1
Š Remove the wheel, see 7.3.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL). 3
Š Remove lower chain slider, see 7.1.57 (REMOVING
THE DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER).
Š Slackenthe drive chain, see 2.35.3 (CHAIN SLACK
ADJUSTMENT). 4

NOTE See 7.4.4 (REAR CHAIN SPROCKET


REMOVAL) for instructions on how to remove the rear 2
chain sprocket (8).
Š Release and remove the three safety screws (1-2).

Torque wrench setting for safety screws (1-2):


150 Nm (15 kgm).

WARNING
The safety screw (1) is longer. Ensure that it goes
fully home into one of the three holes of the wheel
spindle bolt (3) on assembly.
5
Š Insert the socket (5) supplied with the tool kit into the
spindle bolt hole (4).
Š Fit the torque wrench to the socket (5) hexagon.

Š Release and remove the wheel spindle bolt (3). Collect


the Belleville washer (6) if it has been displaced in the
process.

Torque wrench setting for wheel spindle bolt


(3): 150 Nm (15 kgm).

6
3

Š Remove the hub (7) complete with sprocket (8) from


the wheel spindle (12).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 61 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

Š Collect the O-ring (9).

Š Release and remove the six screws (10).


NOTE The six screws (10) are retained with LOCTITE®
243 on assembly. Use of an air gun is recommended to 10
release these screws. 10

Š Release and remove the six brake disc screws (10). 12


WARNING
Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the screw threads on
assembly.
NOTE Screw in all screws hand-tight on assembly,
then tighten in a cross pattern.
10
Torque wrench setting for brake disc screws
(10): 30 Nm (3.0 kgm).
Š Lower the brake disc (11).
Š Withdraw the wheel spindle (12) together with the
brake disc (10) from the right-hand side.
Š Remove the circlip (13).
Š Remove the circlip (14). 13

WARNING
When refitting the circlips (13-14), an audible click
should be heard when they locate correctly.
Š Remove the brake caliper carrier (15) together with
brake caliper leaving them attached to the brake hose.
If needed:
Š Remove the eccentric hub, see 7.4.3 (ECCENTRIC
HUB REMOVAL).

15

14

7 - 62 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.4.2 COMPONENT INSPECTION

WARNING
Ensure that all components are in perfect condition.
Check the following components with special care. 1
Bearings, seals, wheel spindle and wheel rim, see 7.2.3
(WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION).
CUSH DRIVE
Š Inspect the cush drive rubbers (1) for damage or wear.
Replace as required. 2
REAR CHAIN SPROCKET
Š Check the toothing of front and rear (2) chain sprockets
for wear. In the event excess wear is found, replace
front and rear chain sprockets and drive chain as a set;
see 7.4.1 (FINAL DRIVE REMOVAL) and 7.1.57
(REMOVING THE DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER).

WARNING
Drive chain and front and rear chain sprockets must
always be replaced as a set. Failure to do so will lead
to early wear of the newly fitted component(s).
TYRE
Š Check tyre condition, see 2.36 (TYRES).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 63 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.4.3 ECCENTRIC HUB REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove the swinging arm spindle, see 7.4.1 (FINAL
DRIVE REMOVAL).
Š Slacken the two bolts (1).

Torque wrench setting for bolts (1): 35 Nm 1


(3.5 kgm).
Š Remove the circlip (2).
Š Withdraw the eccentric hub from the left-hand side.
NOTE If needed, disassemble the individual
components.

7.4.4 REAR CHAIN SPROCKET REMOVAL


Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 1
Š Slacken the drive chain, see 2.35.3 (CHAIN SLACK
ADJUSTMENT).
Š Release and remove the six nuts (1). 1

NOTE When refitting, screw in all nuts (1) until finger


tight and then tighten in a cross pattern.

Torque wrench setting for nuts (1): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
1
Š Withdraw the rear chain sprocket from the left-hand
side of the motorcycle.
1

7 - 64 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.5 FRONT BRAKE

2
1
5

8
6

4
8
3

Key: The front brake is discussed in further detail in the


following sections:
1) Brake lever
- see 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID);
2) Brake master cylinder
- see 2.16 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP FRONT
3) Brake pads
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL);
4) Brake discs
5) Brake light switch - see 2.19 (BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS);
- see 2.27 (CHECKING BRAKE PADS FOR WEAR));
6) Brake hoses, master cylinder to calipers
- see 8.4.5 (FRONT BRAKING SYSTEM).
7) Bleed nipples
8) Brake calipers
WARNING
The two caliper mounting bolts must be replaced
with new bolts of the same type each time the caliper
is removed.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 65 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.5.1 REPLACING THE BRAKE PADS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.27 (CHECKING BRAKE PADS
FOR WEAR) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
NOTE The operations described below apply to both
brake calipers. 1
Š Apply a pair of pliers to the head of one of the caliper
retaining pins and rotate to allow removal of the parallel
pins (1). Repeat the process for both caliper retaining
pins.
Š Remove the two parallel pins (1).
Š Remove the two retaining pins (2).
Š Collect the protective cover (3).
NOTE Push one brake pad in a side-to-side motion
using a pair of pliers to remove any pressure from the
pistons and facilitate brake pad extraction. Repeat with
the other brake pad.
Š Extract both brake pads (4). 3

WARNING 2
Do not operate the brake lever with the brake pads
removed, or the brake caliper pistons might fall out
leading to loss of brake fluid.
Š Fit new brake pads taking care to align the holes with
the caliper holes.

WARNING
The brake pads must always be replaced in pairs.
Ensure they become properly seated in the brake
caliper.
Š Refit the protective cover (3) with the arrow mark
pointing upwards.
Š Insert the two caliper retaining pins (2).
Š Insert the two parallel pins (1).
Š Check brake fluid level, see 2.16 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).

7 - 66 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.5.2 BRAKE DISC INSPECTION


NOTE The operations described below are to be
performed with the brake discs installed to the wheel and
apply to both brake discs.
Š Check for wear measuring disc thickness with a
micrometer gauge at different positions along the disc.
When a disc is worn beyond the service limit even at
just one position, the disc must be replaced.
Service limit: 4.5 mm.
Š Check for disc run-out using a dial gauge. Replace disc
when the maximum run-out measured exceeds the
disc run-out limit; see 7.5.3 (BRAKE DISC REMOVAL).
Disc run-out limit: 0.3 mm.

7.5.3 BRAKE DISC REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Remove the front wheel, 7.2.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
NOTE The operations described below apply to both
brake discs.
The screws (1) are retained with LOCTITE® 243. Use of
an air gun is recommended to release the screws.
Š Release and remove the six brake disc screws (1).
WARNING
Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the threads of the brake disc
screws (1) on assembly.
NOTE To refit, start all screws (1) manually in their
holes and tighten in a cross pattern observing this
sequence: A-B-C-D-E-F.

Torque wrench setting for brake disc screws


2
(1): 30 Nm (3.0 kgm).
Š Remove the brake disc (2).

7.5.4 REMOVING THE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER


7.1.15 (REMOVING THE FRONT BRAKE CONTROL). A

C
F

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 67 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.6 REAR BRAKE

10 1
2

9 3

Key: The rear brake is discussed in further detail in the


following sections:
1) Brake fluid reservoir
- see 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID);
2) Brake hose, reservoir to master cylinder
- see 2.17 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP REAR
3) Brake disc
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL);
4) Bleed nipple
- see 2.19 (BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS);
5) Brake caliper
- see 2.25 (ADJUSTING REAR BRAKE LEVER PLAY);
6) Brake pads
- see 2.27 (CHECKING BRAKE PADS FOR WEAR);
7) Brake hose, master cylinder to caliper
- see 8.4.6 (REAR BRAKING SYSTEM).
8) Rear brake light switch
9) Brake pedal WARNING
10) Brake master cylinder
The two caliper mounting bolts must be replaced
with new bolts of the same type each time the caliper
is removed.

7 - 68 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.6.1 REPLACING THE BRAKE PADS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 1
INFORMATION) and 2.27 (CHECKING BRAKE PADS
FOR WEAR) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand. 1
NOTE These operations are best done with the rear
wheel removed. See 7.3.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
2
Š Remove the two split pins (1).
Š Withdraw the pin (2) from the right-hand side.
Š Extract the brake pads (3).
Š Collect the safety clips (4).
3
WARNING
Do not operate the brake lever with the brake pads
removed, or the brake caliper pistons might fall out
leading to loss of brake fluid. 1
4 2
Š Fit two new brake pads taking care to align the holes
with the caliper holes.
1
WARNING
The brake pads must always be replaced in pairs.
Ensure they become properly seated in the brake
caliper.
Š Ensure that the two safety clips (4) are refitted properly 3
on assembly.
Š Check brake fluid level, see 2.17 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).
4

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 69 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.6.2 REAR BRAKE CALIPER REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
NOTE These operations are best done with the rear
wheel removed. See 7.3.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
Š Extract the safety clip (1).
Š Release and remove the screw (2).
2
1
Torque wrench setting for screw (2): 25 Nm
(2.5 kgm).
Š Rotate the brake caliper (3) upwards.
Š Withdraw the caliper (3) from the left-hand side.
Š The caliper (3) is still attached to the rear brake hose
(4). 4
Š Drain the rear braking system, if needed; see 2.22
(CHANGING THE REAR BRAKE FLUID). 5
Š Release and remove the screw (5) and collect the two
seals (6). 6

Torque wrench setting for screw (5): 20 Nm


(2 kgm).

7 - 70 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.6.3 BRAKE DISC INSPECTION


NOTE These operations are to be performed with the
brake disc installed to the wheel.
Š Check for wear measuring disc thickness with a
micrometer gauge at different positions along the disc.
NOTE Replace the disc if worn beyond the service limit
even at just one position. See 7.6.4 (BRAKE DISC
REMOVAL).
Service limit: 4.5 mm.
Š Check for disc run-out using a dial gauge. Replace disc
when the maximum run-out measured exceeds the
disc run-out limit; see 7.6.4 (BRAKE DISC REMOVAL).
Disc run-out limit: 0.3 mm.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 71 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.6.4 BRAKE DISC REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully.
3
Š Remove the final drive assembly, see 7.4.1 (FINAL
2
DRIVE REMOVAL).
Š Remove the brake caliper from the disc, see 7.6.2
(REAR BRAKE CALIPER REMOVAL).
Š Withdraw the brake caliper carrier (1).
Š Place the wheel spindle with the brake disc assembled
in a vice fitted with soft (aluminium) jaws.
NOTE The screws (2) are retained with LOCTITE®
243. Use of an air gun is recommended to release the 1 2
screws. 2
Š Release and remove the six screws (2).

WARNING
A
Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the threads of the brake disc
screws (2) on assembly.
C
NOTE To refit, start all screws manually in their holes
and tighten in a cross pattern observing this sequence:
A-B-C-D-E-F.
F
E
Torque wrench setting for brake disc screws
(2): 30 Nm (3.0 kgm).
Š Remove the brake disc (3). D
B

7 - 72 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.6.5 REMOVING THE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER


Š Remove the right-hand lower fairing, see 7.1.33 1
(REMOVING THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Perform the first three steps of the procedure described
in subsection 2.22 (CHANGING THE REAR BRAKE
FLUID).
Š When all fluid has drained out, release and remove the
screw (1) and collect the two sealing washers. 2

Torque wrench setting for screw (1): 20 Nm


(2.0 kgm).
Š Slacken the hose clips (2) and slide them aside. 3
Š Detach the hose (3) from the fitting at master cylinder
end.
Š Release and remove the two screws (4).
5
Torque wrench setting for screws (4): 10 Nm
(1.0 kgm).
Š Collect the guard (5).
Š Withdraw the master cylinder (6).
NOTE After re-assembly, top up brake fluid level,
see 2.17 (CHECKING AND TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE 4
FLUID LEVEL) and bleed the brake, see 2.19
(BLEEDING THE BRAKE CIRCUITS). 6
2 3

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 73 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.7 STEERING

3
5
7 4
9 6

8
9

8
„

10

Key: The steering is discussed in further detail in the


following sections:
1) Top bush
- see 2.28 (STEERING);
2) Washer
- see 2.29 (INSPECTING THE FRONT SUSPENSION).
3) Top yoke
4) Lockring
5) Locking washer
6) Adjusting ring
7) Protection cap
8) Dust seal
9) Bearings
10) Bottom yoke
„ = GREASE, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).

7 - 74 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.7.1 HEADSTOCK REMOVAL


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.28 (STEERING) carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on a lift and put it on the centre
stand.
Š Perform the first eleven steps of the procedure
described in subsection 2.28.2 (ADJUSTING PLAY IN
THE BEARINGS).
Š Release and remove the screw (1). 1
Š Collect the bracket (2). 2
Š Withdraw both fork legs, see 7.8.3 (DISASSEMBLING
THE STANCHION TUBES – SLIDERS).
Š Use the special socket to slacken and remove the
adjusting ring (3).

WARNING
The front end is heavy. An assistant will be required
to support it. 4 3
When working with an assistant, plan the whole
procedure carefully together. 6
Proceed with the utmost care when removing the 5
headstock.
Make sure the brake hose does not snag on any parts
during the process.
Š While the assistant holds the front end steady, raise the
lift gradually until the steering stem slides off the
headstock.
Š Collect the dust seal (4).
Š Remove the top dust seal (5).
Š Remove the bearing (6).
Š Extract the bottom bearing (7) and bottom dust ring (8)
using a suitable extractor.

WARNING
On assembly, refit the bearings using a drift with the
same diameter as the bearing outer ring.
Do not tap the balls and/or the inner ring.
Ensure that the bearings slide fully home.
Wash all components with clean detergent.
7

7.7.2 COMPONENT INSPECTION

WARNING
Check that all components are in perfect condition.
Pay special attention to the following components:
Bearings and seals, see 7.2.3 (WHEEL COMPONENT
INSPECTION).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 75 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.7.3 HEADSTOCK RE-ASSEMBLY


NOTE Place motorcycle and headstock in the same
position as for removal. Reverse the removal procedure
to assemble.
1
Š Smear a light coat of grease over the total length of the
stem (1), see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
Š Before finally tightening the adjusting ring (2), turn the
steering in both directions repeatedly. This will allow
the bearings to seat themselves properly.
Š Adjust play in the bearings, see 2.28.2 (ADJUSTING
PLAY IN THE BEARINGS).
Š Turn the handlebars to ensure that cables and hoses
do not bind. Ensure that cables and hoses are not
twisted or twisted around one another.
Š Top up brake fluid level, see 2.16 (CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL).

7 - 76 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.8 FRONT FORK

14
8 7

17 2
16
18 9 3

19
4

15 10

11 13

13

6
5

Key:
1) Damping cylinder bush
2) Washer
3) Ring
4) Top cap
5) Capscrew
6) Copper washer
7) Damping cylinder assembly
8) Bush
9) Spacer tube
10) Spring
11) Spring washer
12) Bottom collar
13) Slider
14) Slide bush
15) Stanchion tube
16) Ring
17) Bush
18) Retaining ring
19) Dust seal

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 77 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.8.1 CHANGING FRONT FORK OIL


Read 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) and 2.29.2 (FRONT FORK
ADJUSTMENT).
Š Perform the operations identified with the symbol “z”
described in subsection 7.8.3 (DISASSEMBLING THE
STANCHION TUBES – SLIDERS).
Š Perform the operations identified with the symbol “z”
described in subsection 7.8.5 (STANCHION TUBE –
SLIDER ASSEMBLY).

7.8.2 REMOVING THE STANCHION TUBES – SLIDERS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 1
INFORMATION) and 2.29 (INSPECTING THE FRONT
SUSPENSION) carefully.
NOTE The operations described below apply to both
fork legs.

WARNING
Service the fork legs one at a time. Always refit a fork
leg in the correct position before removing the other.
Š Place the motorcycle on a lift with the front wheel
protruding over the runway edge. Put the motorcycle on the 2
centre stand.
Š Secure the tail section to the runway with suitable belts so
to raise the front wheel.
Š Remove the front wheel, see 7.2.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL). It
is not necessary to use a front wheel stand in this case.
Š Remove the front mudguard, see 7.1.26 (REMOVING 7
THE FRONT MUDGUARD).
Š Release and remove the two caliper mounting bolts (1) and
withdraw both brake calipers (2) leaving them attached to
the brake hose.
6
Torque wrench setting for caliper mounting 4
bolts (1): 50 Nm (5 kgm). 5
Š Remove the front bottom panel, see 7.1.32
(REMOVING THE FRONT BOTTOM PANEL). 3
Š Slacken the top yoke clamp bolt (3) securing the top
yoke (4) to the fork slider (5).

Torque wrench setting for top yoke clamp bolt


(3): 25 Nm (2.5 kgm). 5
Š Slacken the bolt (6) securing the handlebar (7) to the
8
fork slider (5). 9

Torque wrench setting for bolt (6): 30 Nm (3 kgm). 10


Š Slacken the two bolts (8) securing the bottom yoke (9)
to the fork slider (5).

Torque wrench setting for bolts (8): 25 Nm (2.5 kgm).


Š Raise the lift to slide stanchion (10) and slider (5) off
the top (4) and bottom yokes (9).
NOTE Remove the other fork leg if needed.

7 - 78 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.8.3 DISASSEMBLING THE STANCHION TUBES –


SLIDERS
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION), 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) and 2.29
(INSPECTING THE FRONT SUSPENSION) carefully.
NOTE The same internal components are used in both 3
fork legs. The operations described below apply to both
fork legs. The operations identified with the symbol “z”
also apply to the front fork oil change procedure.
ŠzRemove the stanchion-and-slider assembly,
4
1
see 7.8.2 (REMOVING THE STANCHION TUBES –
SLIDERS).
ŠzClean stanchion and slider thoroughly. 2
NOTE Make sure to have the special tools (A), (B)
and (C) and a container having a capacity greater than
550 cu. cm. ready at hand before proceeding.
C
WARNING
Use utmost care during the disassembly procedure.
ŠzTurn the top adjuster screw (1) fully anti-clockwise to
reduce rebound damping force.
ŠzRemove the retaining ring (2).
ŠzRelease and remove the adjuster assembly (3).
ŠzExtract the spring pre-loading ring (4).
ŠzPlace the stanchion-and-slider assembly in a vice.
Position the two shells of the special tool (C) to the vice
jaws to protect the stanchion-and-slider assembly.
5
WARNING
The stanchion-and-slider assembly contains oil. Do
not turn it over or tilt it while it is removed from the
motorcycle.
ŠzSlacken the top cap (5).
ŠzRemove the stanchion-and-slider assembly from the
vice.
ŠzKeep the stanchion-and-slider assembly upright and
turn the top cap (5) fully out.
ŠzRelease and remove the threaded rod (A1) from the A 1
tool (A).
ŠzPosition the tool body (A) to the spacer tube (6) so A1
that the tab fits into the hole.
ŠzScrew the threaded rod (A1) into the hole in the tool
body (A). When fully turned in, the rod thread should
6
engage into the spacer tube (6) hole.

A1
A

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 79 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

WARNING
An assistant is required to perform the following
operations. When working with an assistant, plan the 7 B
whole procedure carefully together.
ŠzGrasp the tool (A) with both hands.
ŠzPress down and slide the tool (B) between locknut (7)
and washer (8).

8
A

ŠzFit a fork spanner to the suitable portion of the


damping cylinder (9) to prevent cylinder rotation and
release the top cap (5).

ŠzGrasp the tool (A) with both hands.


ŠzPush down and remove the tool (B).
ŠzRemove the tool (A).
B

ŠzRemove the washer (8).


ŠzRemove the slide bush (10).
8

10

7 - 80 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

NOTE When removing spacer tube (6) and spring (11),


withdraw partially from the slider and allow several
seconds to let oil drip back into the slider before
extracting completely.
6
ŠzRemove the spacer tube (6) complete with spring
guide and slide ring.
ŠzWithdraw and remove the spring (11). 11

ŠzTurn stanchion and slider over to drain oil into the


container (12) prepared previously.
1

9
3
12

4
1

NOTE “z” Pump the damping cylinder (9) up and down


slowly eight to ten times to drain all oil.
When finished, the slider will slide freely inside the
stanchion.
Š Unless they were displaced while draining oil, remove
in the order:
- spring washer (13);
- bottom collar (14).
13 14

Š Prise the dust seal (15) off the slider levering with a
flat-blade screwdriver at different positions.

15

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 81 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

Š Remove the retaining ring (16) using a flat-blade


screwdriver.

16

WARNING 22
Pull firmly to separate stanchion from slider. A
17 20
certain amount of force is needed to help the slide
bush (17) overcome the resistance offered by the oil 21
seal (18), the stop ring (19) and the guide bush (20).
Š Slide the stanchion (21) off the slider (22).

19 18

WARNING
Take care not to damage the slide bush (17) and its
sliding surface during removal.
Š Prise the two ends of the slide bush (17) slightly apart 17
with a flat-blade screwdriver and slide the bush off the
stanchion (21).
21

Š Withdraw and remove the following components from


the stanchion (21) in the order:
- guide bush (20);
- stop ring (19);
- oil seal (18);
- retaining ring (16);
- dust seal (15).

20
19
18
16
15

7 - 82 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Place the stanchion (21) in a vice fitted with soft


(aluminium) jaws. 21

Š Release and remove the capscrew (23) and collect the


copper washer (24).

24
23

Š Withdraw the damping cylinder assembly (9) from the


stanchion (21).

WARNING
Do not dismantle the damping cylinder assembly (9).

21

Š Collect the centring bush (25).


WARNING
Wash all components with clean detergent.

25

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 83 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.8.4 COMPONENT INSPECTION


STANCHION TUBE
Š Inspect the sliding surface for scoring and/or scratching. 60 70
80

Eliminate minor scoring with wet sand paper (grain size 1).
50 90

40 100

30 110

Replace the stanchion (1) if badly scored.


20 120

10

Š Check for stanchion buckling (1) using a dial gauge.


Replace the stanchion if buckled beyond the service
limit.
Service limit: 0.2 mm.
1
WARNING
Never attempt to straighten a buckled stanchion as
this would weaken the overall structure leading to a
dangerous riding condition.
SLIDER
Š Inspectfor damage and/or cracking. Replace if
damaged.
SPRING
Š Check spring condition (2) and length.
Š Replace the spring (2) if stretched beyond the service
limit.
Minimum length of the uncompressed spring: 284 mm. 2
Š Check the condition of the following components:
- slide bush (3);
- guide bush (4);
- damping cylinder (5).
Replace any component which shows excessive wear or
damage.

WARNING
4
Clean off any debris collected by the bushes taking
care not to scratch the bush surface.
Š Renew the following components on assembly:
- oil seal (6);
- dust seal (7); 5
- both O-rings fitted to the adjuster assembly (8).

16
8

6
7

7 - 84 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.8.5 STANCHION TUBE – SLIDER ASSEMBLY


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION), 1.2.3 (BRAKE FLUID) and 2.29
(INSPECTING THE FRONT SUSPENSION) carefully.
NOTE The operations identified by the symbol “z” also
apply to the fork oil change procedure.

WARNING
Take great care when reassembling stanchion and
slider. Inspect all sliding surfaces for signs of wear, 2
scoring, etc. Replace any damaged components.
Take care to prevent the ingress of dirt.
Never reuse the oil you have drained from the fork.
Always renew all seals.
Use utmost care during the re-assembly procedure.
NOTE Make sure to have the special tools (A), (B),
(C) and (D) ready at hand before proceeding. Apply a
light film of fork oil to the bushes and seals before
assembly. See 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART).
Š Place the stanchion (1) in a vice fitted with soft
(aluminium) jaws with the opening pointing upwards.
NOTE Smear the inside of the centring bush (2) with
grease, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART). 1
Š Locate the centring bush (2) to the bottom of the
damping cylinder (3). 3
Š Slide the damping cylinder (3) into the stanchion (1)
and ensure that the cylinder is fully home into the
stanchion base.
Š Fit the copper washer (5) to the capscrew (4).
Š Start the capscrew (4) in its hole and tighten to the
specified torque.

Torque wrench setting for capscrew (4): 35 Nm


(3.5 kgm).
5
Š Remove the stanchion (1) from the vice. 4
Š Tape over the end of the stanchion (1)to protect the
seals during assembly. Apply tape in smooth winds
without overlapping.

21
1

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 85 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

Š Fit the following components to the stanchion (1) in the


order:
- dust seal (6);
6
- retaining ring (7);
NOTE Fit the oil seal (8) with the marked side facing
the retaining ring (7).
- oil seal (8);
- stop ring (9);
- guide bush (10).
Š Push down the five components you have just installed
towards the fork lugs.
Š Remove the tape from the stanchion end (1).
1

Š Tape over the guide bush (10) to hold it in position.


Š Refit the slide bush (11) to the stanchion (1).
10

11

7 - 86 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Slide the stanchion (1) into the slider (12).


Š Remove the tape.
Š Fit the two shells of the tool (D) to the stanchion
(1),
just before the guide bush (10).
Š Grasp the tool (D) and drive the guide bush (10) in
place onto the slider (12).
Š Remove the tool (D).

1 9
10
12

Š Insert the stop ring (9) and make sure it locates fully
home.
Š Fit the two shells of the tool (D) to the stanchion (1),
just before the seal (8).
Š Grasp the tool (D) and push the seal (8) firmly to drive
it fully home onto the slider (12). D
Š Remove the tool (D).
2
8

12

Š Fit the retaining ring (7) into its groove in the slider (12).
Š Fit the two shells of the tool (D) to the stanchion (1),
just before the dust seal (6).
Š Grasp the tool (D) and drive the dust seal (15) fully D
home onto the slider (12). Ensure that the dust seal
becomes properly seated in place.
ŠzGrasp the stanchion (1) and pump it up and down
slowly several times. 6
1
WARNING
The stanchion (1) must slide in the slider (12) freely.
Hardness in stanchion movement is probably due to 12
a damaged guide bush (10), slide bush (11) or seal 6
(8).
ŠzKeep the slider (22) upright.
ŠzPush down the slider (22) until the assembly is fully
compressed.
ŠzPour front fork fluid into the stanchion up to correct
level. See 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART) for specifications. 13
Measure level fitting a graduated rod (13) into the
stanchion.
Oil quantity: 520 ± 2.5 cu. cm. 12
Oil level: 118 ± 2 mm (from slider edge).
1
NOTE The slider (12) must be perfectly vertical to
ensure accurate measurement. Oil level must be the
same in both fork legs. 11
25

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 87 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

ŠzGrasp the slider (12) and pump it up and down over a


150-mm stroke a dozen times to expel air.
ŠzPush the slider (12) to fully compress the assembly.
ŠzAllow several minutes, then check level and top up as 14
required. 15
ŠzFit the following components into the stanchion (1) in
the order:
- bottom collar (14);
- spring washer (15);
- spring (16);
1
- spacer tube (17) together with spring guide and slide
ring;
- slide bush (18);
- washer (19).
ŠzRelease and remove the threaded rod (A1) from the
tool (A).
ŠzPosition the tool body (A) to the spacer tube (17) so
that the tab fits into the hole.
ŠzScrew the threaded rod (A1) into the hole in the tool
body (A). When fully turned in, the rod thread should
17
engage in the spacer tube (17) hole.

16

19

10

17

A
A1
A

7 - 88 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

WARNING
An assistant is required to perform the following
operations. 20 B
When working with an assistant, plan the whole
procedure carefully together.
ŠzGrasp the tool (A) with both hands.
ŠzPress down and slide the tool (B) between locknut
(20) and washer (19).
ŠzFit a fork spanner to the suitable portion of the 19
damping cylinder (3) to prevent cylinder rotation and
tighten the top cap (21) to the damping cylinder (3). A

Top cap (5) to damping cylinder (9) torque:


35 Nm (3.5 kgm).
ŠzGrasp the tool (A) with both hands.
ŠzPush down and remove the tool (B).
ŠzRemove the tool (A).
ŠzFit the shells of the special tool (C) to the jaws of a
vice and place the stanchion-and-slider assembly in
the vice.
ŠzTighten the top cap (5) to the slider.
21
Top cap (5) to slider torque: 35 Nm (3.5 kgm).
ŠzInsert the spring pre-loading ring (22). 3
ŠzTighten the adjuster assembly (23).
ŠzFit the retaining ring (24) in its groove.
ŠzWork adjuster assembly (23) and adjuster screw (25)
to obtain the same setting as the other fork leg,
see 2.29.2 (FRONT FORK ADJUSTMENT).

23

22
25

21
24

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 89 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.8.6 INSTALLING STANCHIONS AND SLIDERS


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.29 (INSPECTING THE FRONT
SUSPENSION) carefully.
Š Insert the slider (1) complete with stanchion (2) through 4
the bottom yoke (3) and the top yoke (4).
Š Insert the wheel spindle (5) into both fork legs to keep
the holes in the stanchions (2) aligned.
Š Ensure that the sliders (1) are properly seated in the
top (4) and bottom yokes (3).
Š Tighten the two bolts (6) securing the bottom yoke (3)
to the slider (1).
3

Torque wrench setting for bolts (6): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
ŠLubricate the thread of the bolt (7) and tighten. 1

Torque wrench setting for bolt (7): 30 Nm


(3 kgm).
Š Tighten the bolt (8) securing the top yoke (4) to the
slider (1). 2

Torque wrench setting for bolt (8): 25 Nm


(2.5 kgm).
Š Lower the lift.
Š Withdraw the wheel spindle (5).
Š Refit the wheel, see 7.2.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
Š Remove the belts holding the tail section to the lift
runway.

WARNING
When finished, operate the front brake and press
down on the fork repeatedly.
Fork operation should smooth and progressive.
There must be no traces of oil on the fork legs.

CAUTION
Check front suspension setting before riding the
motorcycle, see 2.29.2 (FRONT FORK
ADJUSTMENT).
5

1 7 4

1
8
3

7 - 90 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.9 REAR SWINGING ARM

7.9.1 REMOVING THE REAR SWINGING ARM 2


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.30 (REAR SWINGING ARM)
carefully.
Š Place the motorcycle on the centre stand.
Š Remove the rear wheel, see 7.3.1 (WHEEL
REMOVAL). 1
Š Remove both side fairings, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING
THE SIDE FAIRINGS).
Š Remove both lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING). 3
Š Remove the sprocket cover,see 2.35.4 (DRIVE CHAIN
GUIDE PLATE INSPECTION).
Š Release and remove the nut (1) and withdraw the pivot
bolt (2). 7

Torque wrench setting for nut (1): 50 Nm 4


(5 kgm). 6
9
Š Slide the double connecting link (3) off the swinging
arm. The link is still connected to the frame.
Š Remove the rear sprocket hub performing the first ten
operations described in subsection 7.4.1 (FINAL
DRIVE REMOVAL). 5
NOTE Engage the first gear to prevent sprocket (4)
rotation and release the screw (5).
Š Release and remove the screw (5), collect the two
washers (6-7) and withdraw the sprocket (4).

Torque wrench setting for screw (5): 50 Nm (5 kgm).


Š Remove the expansion chamber, see 7.1.52
(EXPANSION CHAMBER REMOVAL).
Š Remove the rear shock absorber, see 7.10.1 (REAR
SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL). 8
Š Remove both rider footpeg brackets, see 7.1.45
(REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND RIDER FOOTPEG
BRACKET) and 7.1.46 (REMOVING THE RIGHT-
HAND RIDER FOOTPEG BRACKET).
Š Remove the rear brake master cylinder and the rear
brake fluid reservoir, see 7.6.5 (REMOVING THE
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER).
Š Disconnect the odometer sensor connector (8) from
the main wiring harness.
NOTE Make sure to refit the connector (8) to the
matching connector on assembly.
Š Release and remove the nut (9) and collect the washer. 10

Torque wrench setting for nut (9): 90 Nm (9 kgm).


NOTE Make sure to have the special tool part no. 11
8140203 (socket for swinging arm-engine fixings adjustment)
ready at hand.
Š Use the special tool (socket) to release and remove the
lockring (10).
Š Working from the right-hand side of the motorcycle,
12
rotate the swinging arm spindle (11) anti-clockwise.
The spindle will draw the adjusting ring (12) until it
works itself loose.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 91 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

WARNING
12
The tail section is heavy. An assistant will be
required to perform the following operations.
When working with an assistant, plan the whole
procedure carefully together.
Use utmost care when removing the swinging arm.
11
Support the swinging arm at the front end or it might
fall to the ground.
Š Support the swinging at the front end. At the same
time, withdraw the swinging arm spindle (11) from the
right-hand side.
Š Slide the adjusting ring (12) off the spindle (11).
WARNING
Ensure that the drive chain does not snag on any
parts while removing the tail section.
Š Remove the swinging arm complete with wheel spindle
in a rearward motion.
NOTE Remove the rear wheel spindle if needed.
See 7.4.1 (FINAL DRIVE REMOVAL).

7.9.2 DISMANTLING THE SWINGING ARM


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) carefully. 8
Š Remove the swinging arm, see 7.9.1 (REMOVING
THE REAR SWINGING ARM).
Š Clean both sides of the bearing housings using a cloth. 1
Š Withdraw the bush (1).
Š Remove the seal (2).
Š Remove the seal (3).
Š Remove the snap ring (4). 6
Š Remove the two bearings (5) and the roller bearing (6)
using a suitable extractor. 2

WARNING
Inspect the bearings after each removal. Replace as
required.
3
Š Remove the inner spacer (7) and collect the two O-
5
rings (8).

WARNING
7
Inspect the bearings after each removal. Replace as
required.
Š Clean the inside of the bearing housings thoroughly. 4
NOTE Wash all components with clean detergent. 8

7 - 92 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

WARNING
On assembly, fit the bearings using a drift with the
same diameter as the bearing outer ring.
Do not tap the balls or the inner ring. 1

7.9.3 COMPONENT INSPECTION

WARNING 60 70
80

Visually inspect all components for distortion,


50 90

40 100

damage, cracking and denting.


30 110

20 120

Replace any damaged components.


10

BEARINGS
Š Rotate the inner ring (1) of each ball bearing manually.
Rotate the bearing needle rollers. Inner ring and rollers
must rotate smoothly, with no hardness or noise.
There should be no end float.
Replace any bearings that do not meet these 2
requirements.

WARNING
Apply grease to the bearing balls (on the sides of
each bearing) and needle rollers, see 1.6
(LUBRICANT CHART).
SEALS
Š Check the condition of the seals. Replace any
damaged or worn seals.
SWINGING ARM SPINDLE
Š Check spindle (2) run-out using a dial gauge.
Replace spindle (2) when run-out exceeds the allowed
limit.
Spindle run-out limit: 0.3 mm.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 93 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.9.4 INSTALLING THE SWINGING ARM


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.30.1 (SWINGING ARM
ADJUSTMENT) carefully. 4
Š Apply a light coat of grease over the total length of the
swinging arm spindle (1), see 1.6 (LUBRICANT
CHART). 1
Š Fit the adjusting bush (2) and screw it hand-tight.
NOTE The adjusting bush (2) must not protrude over
the inner edge of its location in the frame.
Š Position the drive chain (3) to the front (left-hand) end 2
of the swinging arm and secure it in place with
adhesive tape.

WARNING
The tail section is heavy. An assistant will be
9
required to perform the following operations.
When working with an assistant, plan the whole 10 5
procedure carefully together. 8 7
Š Support the swinging arm at the front end, position it 6
properly to align the holes and slide the spindle (1) fully
home.
NOTE Ensure that the hexagon of the spindle head (1)
locates correctly into the adjusting bush (2). 3
Š Fit the lockring (4) and turn in manually by a few turns.
Š Fit the washer (5) and nut (6) to the spindle. Screw the
nut hand-tight.
Š Adjust the swinging arm, see 2.30.1 (SWINGING ARM
ADJUSTMENT).
Š Remove the adhesive tape to release the drive chain
(3)
Š Wrap the chain (3) around the drive sprocket (7).
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® Anti-Seize to the inner toothing
of the drive sprocket (7).
Š Fit the sprocket (7) with the chain (3) to the spindle.
13
NOTE Apply LOCTITE® 243 to the thread of the screw
(8)
Š Fit the washer (9) and the washer (10) to the screw (8).
Š Start the screw (8) into its hole and tighten to the
specified torque.

Torque wrench setting for screw (8): 50 Nm


(5.0 kgm).
Š Refit the rectifier, see 2.35.1 (CHAIN SLACK
INSPECTION).
Š Check and adjust slack in the drive chain, see 2.35.3
(CHAIN SLACK ADJUSTMENT).
Š Connect the odometer sensor connector (13) to the
main wiring harness.
Š Refit the rear brake master cylinder and the brake fluid
reservoir, see 7.6.5 (REMOVING THE BRAKE
MASTER CYLINDER).

7 - 94 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Refit both rider footpeg brackets, see 7.1.45


(REMOVING THE LEFT-HAND RIDER FOOTPEG
BRACKET) and 7.1.46 (REMOVING THE RIGHT- 16
HAND RIDER FOOTPEG BRACKET).
Š Refit the rear shock absorber, see 7.10.1 (REAR
SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL).
Š Refit the expansion chamber, see 7.1.52 (EXPANSION
CHAMBER REMOVAL).
Š Refit the rear sprocket hub, see 7.4.1 (FINAL DRIVE
REMOVAL). 15
Š Install the rear wheel, see 7.3.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
Š Refit the double connecting link (14). Screw the nut
(15) to the spindle (16) and tighten to the specified
torque. 14

Torque wrench setting for nut (15): 50 Nm


(5 kgm). 11
Š Refit the clamp (11) to the gear shift lever spindle.
Š Tighten the bolt (12).

Torque wrench setting for bolt (12): 10 Nm


(1 kgm).
12
Š Refit both lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING THE
LOWER FAIRING).
Š Refit
both side fairings, see 7.1.28 (REMOVING THE
SIDE FAIRINGS).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 95 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.10 REAR SUSPENSION

7.10.1 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER REMOVAL


1
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.31.1 (REAR SUSPENSION)
carefully.
Š Remove both lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING 3
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Remove the fuel tank, see 7.1.6 (COMPLETE
REMOVAL OF THE FUEL TANK).
Š Remove the exhaust pipes, see 7.1.51 (REMOVING
THE EXHAUST PIPES). 2
NOTE These operations are best done with the rear
wheel removed, see 7.3.1 (WHEEL REMOVAL).
Š Remove both passenger footpeg brackets, SEE 7.1.43
(REMOVING THE PASSENGER FOOTPEG
BRACKETS) 10
Š Slacken the two upper screws (1). 4
5 10
Torque wrench setting for screws (1): 50 Nm
(5.0 kgm). 7
Frame
Š Release and remove the two lower screws (2).

Torque wrench setting for screws (2): 50 Nm 11


(5.0 kgm).
12
Š Remove the drain hose (3) from its seat. 6

12 11
WARNING
Ensure that the drain hose (3) is refitted in the correct
position on assembly.
Š Lift the rear subframe.
Š Working from the left-hand side of the motorcycle,
release and remove the nut (4). Push the bolt (5) out
but not quite all the way.
NOTE Replace the nut (4) if damaged. 4

Torque wrench setting for nut (4): 50 Nm (5.0


kgm).
5 6
Š Withdraw the bolt (5) from the opposite side.
Š Working from the right-hand side of the motorcycle,
release and remove the nut (6).

Torque wrench setting for nut (6): 50 Nm (5.0


kgm).
Š Withdraw the bolt (7) from the opposite side.
WARNING
The shock absorber contains pressurised nitrogen.
Keep it well away from flames and/or heat sources to
avoid a risk of explosion.
In the event the shock absorber needs replacing,
press down the core pin of the valve hidden beneath 8
the capscrew (8) to release the nitrogen.
Š Grasp the shock absorber (9). Lift while rotating 9
backwards to remove.
Š Remove the spacer (10) fitted at the shock absorber
top mounting point. Withdraw from the inside to
remove.
Š Withdraw the two bushes (11) and the two O-rings (12)
fitted at the bottom mounting point.
NOTE Wash all components with clean detergent.
7 - 96 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

Š Inspectall components, see 7.10.4 (COMPONENT


INSPECTION).

7.10.2 REMOVING THE REAR SUSPENSION


LINKAGES
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
3
INFORMATION) and 2.31.1 (REAR SUSPENSION)
2
carefully. 6
Š Remove both lower fairings, see 7.1.33 (REMOVING
THE LOWER FAIRING).
Š Working from the right-hand side of the motorcycle,
release and remove the nut (1).
1
Torque wrench setting for nut (1): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm). 5
Š Withdraw the bolt (2) from the opposite side.
Š Release and remove the nut (3).

Torque wrench setting for nut (3): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).


Š Withdraw the bolt (4) from the opposite side.
Š Release and remove the nut (5). 2

Torque wrench setting for nut (5): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).


Š Withdraw the bolt (6) from the opposite side. 4
Š Remove the complete linkage system (7) of the rear 7
suspension.
NOTE Grease all pivot points of the linkages when
refitting, see 1.6 (LUBRICANT CHART). Take care to
refit all parts in the correct position and test all joints for
smooth operation several times.
Š Inspect the linkage system after assembly, see 2.31.3
(INSPECTING THE REAR SUSPENSION LINKAGE
SYSTEM).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 97 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.10.3 DISMANTLING THE REAR SUSPENSION


LINKAGE SYSTEM
Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND 2
INFORMATION) carefully.
5
Š Release and remove the nut (1).
7
8
Torque wrench setting for nut (1): 50 Nm (5.0 kgm).
6
Š Withdraw the bolt (2). 1
Š Remove the two double connecting links (3-4).
Š Remove the two seals (5). 8
Š Remove the two roller bearings (6) using a suitable 10
9
extractor. 10 6 5
Š Collect the inner spacer (7).
Š Remove the two seals (8).
Š Remove the inner spacer (9).
Š Remove the two roller bearings (10) using a suitable 3
extractor.
NOTE Wash all components using clean detergent.
NOTE On refitting, connect the linkage (11) to the
double connecting links (3-4) as shown in the diagram. 4
The arrow marks on the double connecting links (arrowed
in the diagram) must be placed uppermost, facing outside
and pointing in the direction of travel.

11

7 - 98 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
CHASSIS

7.10.4 COMPONENT INSPECTION

WARNING
Visually inspect all components for distortion,
damage, cracking and denting.
Replace any damaged components.
BEARINGS
Š Rotate the bearing needle rollers manually. They must
rotate smoothly, with no hardness or noise. 1
There should be no end float.
Replace any bearings that do not meet these
requirements.

WARNING
Apply grease to the bearing needle rollers, see 1.6
(LUBRICANT CHART).
SEALS
Š Check the condition of the seals. Replace any
damaged or worn seals.
SHOCK ABSORBER
Š Inspect the shock absorber for oil leaks. Shock
absorber travel should be smooth and progressive.
Replace the shock absorber if does not meet these
requirements.

CAUTION
The shock absorber contains pressurised nitrogen.
Keep it well away from flames and/or heat sources to
avoid a risk of explosion.
In the event the shock absorber needs replacing,
press down the core pin of the valve hidden beneath
the capscrew (1) to release the nitrogen.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 99 - 00
CHASSIS RST mille

7.11 DISMANTLING THE DRIVE CHAIN

7.11.1 CHAIN TOOL


NOTE This special tool (part no. 8140192) doubles as
rivet extractor and chain tool and is specific for rivet-type
chains.

WARNING
Use only rivet-type chains on this motorcycle.

4
6
7

2
5
1 3

12 14
9 13

11
10
15

14

Key to tool diagram: Key to chain diagram:


1) Tool main body 13) Connecting link plate
2) Hex nut (width across flats: 27 mm) 14) O-rings
3) Hexagon head screw (width across flats: 19 mm) 15) Outer link plate
4) Locating peg
5) Rivet tool
6) Reference marks “A” and “B”
7) Rivet holes
8) Rivet exit hole
9) Driving pin
10) Extractor end
11) Driving end
12) Supporting plate

7 - 100 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11


RST mille
CHASSIS

7.11.2 BREAKING THE CHAIN


Read 0.5.1 (GENERAL PRECAUTIONS AND
INFORMATION) and 2.35 (DRIVE CHAIN) carefully.
Š Remove the front sprocket cover, see 2.35.4 (DRIVE 1 3
CHAIN GUIDE PLATE INSPECTION).
Š Slacken the chain, see 2.35.3 (CHAIN SLACK
ADJUSTMENT).
NOTE Make sure that the chain tool is suitable for the 2
type of chain installed to the motorcycle and is the
adequate size for the chain links.
Š Fit the rivet tool (1) to the lower portion of the chain,
midway between front and rear sprocket.
Š Move the rivet tool (1) until that the (centre) exit hole
aligns with the rivet you wish to extract.
Š Fit the driving pin (2) to the tool body (3), with the larger
diameter end facing into the tool body.
Š Fit the tool body (3) to the rivet tool (1). 1 1
Š Move the tool body (3) until the locating peg (4) lines up 4 3
with the mark “A” on the rivet tool (1).
Š Turn in the screw (5) manually until the driving pin (2)
contacts the rivet to be extracted. 5

NOTE Make sure that the driving pin (2) is perfectly


centred to the rivet to be pushed out.
Š Fit a 27-mm spanner to the hex nut on the tool body (3)
to hold the body steady. 3
5
Š Tighten the screw (5) using a 19-mm spanner until
pushing the rivet clear of the chain.
Š Slacken the screw (5).
Š Repeat the process for the adjacent rivet on the same
link.
Š Remove the components of the dismantled link and
collect the four O-rings.
Š Remove the chain.
WARNING
When the chain is worn, replace chain and front and
rear sprockets as a set. See 7.4.1 (FINAL DRIVE
REMOVAL).

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 101 - 00


CHASSIS RST mille

7.11.3 FITTING THE CONNECTING LINK

WARNING
Make sure that the connecting link is the same type 6
as the chain.
Š Wrap the chain around the sprockets. The chain open
ends should be lowermost midway between the front
and rear sprockets.
Š Fit the two O-rings to the pins of the connecting link.
Grease the two pins of the connecting link, see 1.6 1
(LUBRICANT CHART). 2
Š Join the two ends of the chain and slide the pins of the
connecting link in place. Fit the two O-rings at the end 3
of the pins.
Š Fit the outer link plate to the pins.
Š Fit the supporting plate (6) to the outer link plate.
Š Fit the rivet tool (1) to the chain.
Š Move the rivet tool (1) until the tool side holes align with
the heads of the connecting link pins. 1
Š Fit the driving pin (2) to the tool body (3) with the 4
1
smaller diameter end facing into the body.
Š Fit the tool body (3) to the rivet tool (1). 3
Š Move the tool body (3) until the locating peg (4) lines up
with the mark “A”.
Š Tighten the screw (5) manually until the driving pin (2) 5
contacts the supporting plate (6).
Š Fit a 27-mm spanner to the hex nut of the tool body (3) 3
to hold the tool body steady. 5
Š Turn the screw (5) all the way in using a 19-mm
spanner.

7 - 102 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11


RST mille
CHASSIS

7.11.4 RIVETING THE LINK


With the tool in position on the chain: 4
Š Slacken the screw (1). 3
Š Remove the tool body (2) from the rivet tool (3). 2
Š Remove the supporting plate (4).
Š Refit the tool body (2) to the rivet tool (3).
Š Move the tool body (2) until the locating peg (5) lines up
with the mark “B” on the rivet tool (3).
Š Tighten the screw (1) manually until the driving pin (6)
contacts the rivet. 6

NOTE Make sure that the driving pin (6) is perfectly


aligned with the rivet.

WARNING
Wear protective goggles or a face shield.
Š Fit a 27-mm spanner to the hex nut on the tool body (2)
to hold the tool body steady.
Š Tighten the screw (1) using a 19-mm spanner until 3 3
squeezing the rivet end. 5
2
WARNING
Ensure that the rivet is fastened securely. The
1
closing head of the rivet must be evenly in contact
with the outer link plate and its maximum diameter
must be 5.65 ± 0.15 mm.
Š Turn out the screw (1). 2
1
Š Repeat process for the next rivet on the same link.

Release 00/2001 - 11 7 - 103 - 00


CHASSIS RST mille

NOTES

7 - 104 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11


RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

REPAIR INFORMATION
8

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 1 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

REPAIR INFORMATION

CONTENTS
8.1 TROUBLESHOOTING ...................... 8-3-00

0
8.1.1 ENGINE.................................................. 8-3-00
8.1.2 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM ........................ 8-8-00
8.1.3 BATTERY .............................................. 8-8-00
8.1.4 BRAKES ................................................ 8-9-00
8.1.5 CHASSIS ............................................... 8-9-00

1 8.2 ROUTING AND CONNECTIONS OF


WIRING, CABLES AND HOSES...... 8-11-00
8.2.1 FRONT BRAKE HOSES...................... 8-11-00
8.2.2 REAR BRAKE HOSES........................ 8-11-00

2
8.2.3 FUEL SYSTEM HOSES....................... 8-12-00
8.2.4 CLUTCH HOSE ................................... 8-13-00
8.2.5 PRESSURE TUBES FOR PPC DEVICE 8-13-00
8.2.6 COOLING SYSTEM TUBES................ 8-14-00
8.2.7 ENGINE OIL TUBES ........................... 8-16-00

3
8.2.8 BREATHER AND DRAIN HOSES....... 8-17-00
8.2.9 THROTTLE BOWDEN CABLES ......... 8-18-00
8.2.10 WIRING ................................................ 8-19-00
8.3 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INSPECTION 8-25-00
8.3.1 SPARK PLUGS (NO SPARK) ............. 8-25-00
4 8.3.2 PROBLEMS WITH BATTERY
CHARGING.......................................... 8-25-00
8.3.3 PROBLEMS WITH IGNITION AND/OR
STARTING ........................................... 8-25-00

5
8.3.4 PROBLEMS WITH THE AUXILIARY
SYSTEMS ............................................ 8-25-00
8.4 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INSPECTION 8-26-00
8.4.1 ENGINE................................................ 8-26-00
8.4.2 THROTTLE BODY COMPONENTS .... 8-26-00
6 8.4.3 FUEL SYSTEM .................................... 8-26-00
8.4.4 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM....................... 8-26-00
8.4.5 FRONT BRAKING SYSTEM ............... 8-26-00
8.4.6 REAR BRAKING SYSTEM.................. 8-26-00
8.4.7 COOLING SYSTEM............................. 8-26-00
7

8 - 2 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.1 TROUBLESHOOTING

WARNING
Any faults in the ignition coils, crankshaft position
sensor, camshaft sensor, pressure sensors and
THERMISTORS are automatically detected by the
Engine Control Unit, which turns on a flashing "EFI"
message on the multifunction display.
Troubleshooting of these components is covered in
section 4 (FUEL SYSTEM) and section 6 (ELECTRI-
CAL SYSTEM). For this reason, these components
are omitted from the troubleshooting charts in the
following pages.
NOTE Some of the operations listed in the chart below
are marked with an asterisk (*). Please refer to the rele-
vant Engine Workshop Manual before performing these
operations. See 0.4.1 (ENGINE WORKSHOP MANU-
ALS).

8.1.1 ENGINE

TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Engine does not start or is Set the engine kill switch to Set to and press
difficult to start
Safety lockout system has cut in Check and rectify as required
Bank angle sensor faulty Replace
Breather hole in fuel filler cap obstructed Clean
Battery low Charge the battery
Battery damaged Replace
Freewheeling clutch or freewheeling clutch gear worn
Replace (*)
or defective
Compound gear or starter motor idler gear worn or
Replace (*)
defective
Starter motor toothing broken Replace (*)
Foul spark plugs Replace
Wet spark plugs Clean or replace
Loose spark plugs Tighten
Spark plugs do not meet specification Replace
Fuel filters or fuel delivery hose clogged Clean or replace
Fuel pump, relay or wiring fault Replace
Fuel pressure regulator fault Replace
Faulty injectors Replace
Incorrect valve clearance Adjust (*)
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 3 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Engine does not hold Idling speed setting too low Adjust
idling speed
Air cleaner clogged Clean
Intake hose leaking Replace
Cylinders incorrectly synchronised Synchronise the cylinders
Throttle spindle/housing worn Replace
See also "Engine does not start or is difficult to start " for other possible causes
Erratic engine speed at A clogged fuel outlet fitting causes poor fuel delivery to
Clean fuel system and refuel
high rpm injector
Air scoops and intake ducts obstructed Check
Air flows past throttle body or intake hose Replace
Clean fuel system or replace
Fuel pressure too low
pump
Fuel pump faulty Replace
Camshafts worn Replace (*)
See also "Engine does not start or is difficult to start " for other possible causes
Loss of power Foul spark plugs Clean or replace
Spark plugs do not meet specification Replace
Valve clearance too tight Adjust (*)
Exhaust system defective Replace
Valve timing incorrectly adjusted Adjust (*)
Valve springs defective Replace (*)
Valve seats leaking Re-cut valve seats (*)
Intake hose or intake system leaking Replace
Replace clutch plates and
Clutch slips
springs (*)
Engine oil does not meet specification Use the specified engine oil
Air cleaner clogged Replace
Fuel pump defective Replace
Replace fuel pressure
Fuel pressure too low
regulator or check pump
Dirty injector Replace
Piston rings worn Replace (*)
See also "Engine produces exceeding exhaust fumes/blue smoke" and "Clutch slips"
for other possible causes
CONTINUED ➤

8 - 4 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Engine overheats Top up coolant level,
Coolant level too low, cooling system leaking
pressure-test the system
Coolant does not meet specification Use the specified coolant
Radiator clogged or coolant hose clogged Clean
Air in the cooling system Bleed the system
Cooling fan motor faulty Repair or replace
Coolant pump or coolant pump control faulty Replace (*)
Insufficient oil in the system Top up engine oil level
Oil pump or oil pump control faulty; oil circuit
Replace or clean (*)
obstructed
Engine oil does not meet specification Use the specified engine oil
Intake hose or intake system leaking Replace
Faulty injector Replace
Cylinder head gasket defective Replace (*)
Engine produces Clutch membrane leaking Replace (*)
exceeding exhaust fumes/
Valve stem seals worn Replace (*)
blue smoke
Valve stems or valve guides worn Replace (*)
Cylinder barrel scratched or scored Replace (*)
Piston rings or cylinder worn Replace (*)
Cylinder head gasket leaking Replace (*)
Engine vibration Engine fixings loose Tighten
Bearing or bearing housing worn Replace
Balancing shafts incorrectly timed Adjust (*)
Low engine oil pressure Insufficient oil in the system Top up with engine oil
(Led light on)
Oil does not meet specification Replace
Oil pressure sensor faulty Replace (*)
Oil pressure relief valve clogged or defective (valve
Clean or replace (*)
stays open)
Oil pump control faulty Replace (*)
Oil pump worn Replace (*)
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 5 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Engine is noisy Noise seems to come from the timing system
Chain slider worn Replace (*)
Valve clearance too loose Adjust (*)
Valve springs worn or broken Replace (*)
Valve buckets or camshaft worn Replace (*)
Timing chain worn Replace (*)
Timing gears worn Replace (*)
Timing chain tension adjuster defective Replace (*)
Noise seems to come from the piston
Piston pin, bore or connecting rod worn Replace (*)
Piston rings or grooves worn or broken Replace (*)
Noise seems to come from the clutch or clutch housing
Clutch plates worn Replace (*)
Clutch housing worn Replace (*)
Too much play in the clutch housing cush drive Replace (*)
Noise occurs when clutch is operated – grooved ball
Replace (*)
bearings in the supporting plate faulty
Primary drive worn or broken Replace (*)
Noise seems to come from the flywheel casing
Timing gears worn or broken Replace (*)
Noise seems to come from the crankpin/con-rod assembly
Connecting rod bearings worn Replace (*)
Crankshaft bearing sleeves or balancing shaft
Replace (*)
bearings worn
Noise seems to come from the transmission
Transmission gears or shafts worn or broken Replace (*)
Primary gear set worn Replace (*)
Transmission bearings worn Replace (*)
Noise upon engine starting
Freewheeling clutch gear or housing worn or defective Replace (*)
Compound gear or starter motor idler gear worn Replace (*)
Starter motor toothing broken Replace (*)
Clutch slips Clutch plates worn or warped Replace (*)
Clutch springs worn Replace (*)
Supporting plate worn or warped Replace (*)
Engine oil does not meet specification Use the specified engine oil
Clutch hydraulic control faulty Replace
CONTINUED ➤

8 - 6 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Clutch does not disengage Fluid level in the reservoir Check
Engine oil does not meet specification Use the specified engine oil
Clutch plates stick Clean or replace (*)
Clutch plates or supporting plate warped Replace (*)
Clutch hydraulic control faulty Replace
Clutch housing worn Replace (*)
Clutch jams during Clutch plates worn or warped Replace (*)
engagement
Lined plates enlarged the housing grooves Replace clutch housing (*)
Clutch plates enlarged the driving plate grooves Replace driving plate (*)
Thrust face of clutch housing or supporting plate worn Replace (*)
Gears do not engage or are Transmission gear dogs worn Replace (*)
hard to engage
Transmission shafts worn Replace (*)
Selector shaft mechanism faulty Repair or replace (*)
Selector forks worn or distorted Replace (*)
See also "Clutch does not disengage" for other possible causes
Gears slip out upon Selector gears worn Replace (*)
starting or under harsh
Selector forks worn or distorted Replace (*)
acceleration
Guide springs worn or broken Replace (*)
Push down gear shift pedal
Up/downshift is rough or gear does not engage fully; all the way when changing
gear shift lever distorted or improperly adjusted gears; replace gear shift
lever (*)
Spark plugs overheated, Spark plugs do not meet specification Replace
burnt out or foul
Spark plugs loose Tighten
Intake hose or intake system leaking Replace
Fuel system faulty Repair or replace
Alternator does not charge Battery faulty Replace battery
battery or charges battery
Rectifier faulty Replace
improperly
Power failure, short circuit or alternator windings
Replace
discharging to ground
Wiring interrupted or shorted, loose connections Repair, replace or tighten

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 7 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8.1.2 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM


TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY
Spark plugs collect carbon Incorrect engine oil level Check
build-up soon after fitment
Fuel not adequate Use the specified fuel
Air cleaner dirty Clean
Spark plugs foul soon after Incorrect engine oil level Check
fitment
Piston rings worn Replace (*)
Piston(s) or cylinder(s) worn Replace (*)
Spark plug electrodes Engine overheating Adjust
overheated or burnt out
Loose spark plugs Tighten
Alternator provides no Connection terminals interrupted, shorted or loose Repair, replace or tighten
charge current
Alternator coils shorted, discharging to ground or
Replace
interrupted
Regulator/rectifier shorted or faulty Replace
Alternator output current Terminals prone to short-circuiting, interrupting or
Repair or tighten
below specified value moving apart
Alternator stator coils discharging to ground or
Replace
interrupted
Regulator/rectifier faulty Replace
Battery faulty Replace
Alternator is overcharging Short-circuit inside battery Repair or replace
the battery
Regulator/rectifier damaged or faulty Replace
Ground of regulator/rectifier erratic Replace
Erratic charge Terminal insulator worn due to vibration causes
Repair or replace
transient short-circuits
Short-circuits inside generator Replace (*)
Regulator/rectifier faulty Replace

8.1.3 BATTERY
TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY
Battery runs flat too fast Check alternator, regulator/
rectifier, circuit connections
Charge system faulty
and rectify to obtain proper
charge
Overcharging destroyed a large part of the active Replace battery and repair
material in the battery cells charge system
Exceeding deposit build-up leads to short-circuits in
Replace battery
the battery
Battery is due for replacement Replace battery
Replace battery; make sure
Battery polarity reversal Battery improperly connected to electrical system
to connect it properly

8 - 8 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.1.4 BRAKES
TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY
Loss of braking Brake hydraulic system leaking Repair or replace
Brake pads worn Replace brake pads
Contact surfaces of brake pads contaminated with oil,
Replace brake pads
grease or brake fluid
Brake discs worn Replace disc
Air in the hydraulic circuit Bleed the circuit
Brake discs contaminated with oil, grease or brake
Clean
fluid
Foreign matter suspended in brake fluid Change brake fluid
Dismantle and clean brake
Return hole of brake master cylinder obstructed
master cylinder
Brake squeals Contact surfaces of brake pads vitrified Sand brake pads
Brake pads incorrectly installed Install brake pads correctly
Wheel hub bearing damaged Replace
Tighten to the specified
Front or rear wheel spindle loose
torque
Brake pads worn Replace
Brake lever has exceeding Air in the hydraulic circuit Bleed the circuit
travel
Brake fluid level low Replace
Brake fluid does not meet specification Replace
Brake caliper pistons jammed Dismantle and clean
Brake fluid leakage Fittings loose Tighten to the specified torque
Hoses cracked Replace
Piston and/or body damaged Replace piston and/or body

8.1.5 CHASSIS
TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY
Steering is tight Adjusting ring overtightened Adjust
Steering bearings damaged Replace
Steering stem distorted Replace
Front tyre underinflated Rectify
Hardness in steering damper Replace
Steering is not smooth Steering bearings damaged Replace
Handlebars shake Uneven front fork settings Adjust
Front fork buckled Replace
Front wheel rim and/or tyre warped Replace
Front/rear wheel imbalanced Balance
CONTINUED ➤

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 9 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

TROUBLE SYMPTOM AND POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY


Front wheel wobbles Wheel rim warped Replace
Wheel hub bearings worn Replace
Tyre defective or does not meet specification Replace
Wheel spindle nut loose Tighten
Front fork oil does not meet specification Change
Front fork too soft Fork incorrectly adjusted Adjust
Springs yielded Replace
Front fork oil level low Top up
Front fork oil spent Change
Front fork too stiff Front fork incorrectly adjusted Adjust
Front fork oil does not meet specification (viscosity too high) Change
Front fork overfilled Remove excess oil
Front fork is noisy Low oil level Top up
Bolts and nuts of suspension mountings loose Tighten
Rear wheel wobbles Wheel rim warped Replace
Wheel hub bearings worn Replace
Tyre defective or does not meet specification Replace
Swinging arm bearings worn Replace
Suspension bolts and nuts loose Replace
Rear wheel nut loose Tighten
Rear suspension too soft Shock absorber spring yielded Replace
Adjusters incorrectly set Adjust
Shock absorber is leaking oil Replace
Shock absorber is leaking nitrogen Replace
Rear suspension too stiff Adjusters incorrectly set Adjust
Shock absorber pivot bolt distorted Replace
Swinging arm distorted Replace
Swinging arm bearings worn Replace
Suspension roller bearings worn Replace
Rear suspension noisy Suspension bolts and nuts loose Tighten
Swinging arm bearings worn Replace
Suspension roller bearings worn Replace

8 - 10 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.2 ROUTING AND CONNECTIONS OF WIRING, CABLES AND HOSES

8.2.1 FRONT BRAKE HOSES 8.2.2 REAR BRAKE HOSES

F G

C D

A
A B E F

C D G

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 11 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8.2.3 FUEL SYSTEM HOSES

A
B
A
C

A C

B D

8 - 12 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.2.4 CLUTCH HOSE 8.2.5 PRESSURE TUBES FOR PPC DEVICE

E
B

A C

B D E

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 13 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8.2.6 COOLING SYSTEM TUBES

B
C

A E

A C

B D

8 - 14 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

F G

E G

F H

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 15 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8.2.7 ENGINE OIL TUBES

A C
B

A C

B D

8 - 16 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.2.8 BREATHER AND DRAIN HOSES

A C
B

A C

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 17 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8.2.9 THROTTLE BOWDEN CABLES

A
B

8 - 18 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.2.10 WIRING

6
4 8
1

4 10
5

7
11

Key
1) Flasher
2) Headlight wiring
3) Bank angle sensor
4) Light relay
5) Connector of front indicator, right
6) Auxiliary fuse box
7) Right-hand light dip switch connector
8) Instrument panel connectors
9) Connector of front indicator, left
10) Air temperature sensor
11) Left-hand light dip switch connector

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 19 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8 7

9 6
10

11

12 2

1
4
3

Key
7) Tail light
1) Warning horn
8) Battery positive terminal
2) Oil pressure sensor
3) Rectifier 9) Rear brake light
10) Speed sensor connector
4) Engine ground
11) Coolant temperature sensor
5) Main fuses
12) Fuel injection connectors
6) Starter relay

8 - 20 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

12

13 7

5
11
18

22

16
19
2 15

14

10
1
6
9
4
3
8 20 21
17

Key
12) Front cylinder coil no. “1”
1) Air thermistor
13) Front cylinder coil no. “2”
2) Engine Control Unit
14) Rear cylinder coil no. “1”
3) Fuel pump connector
15) Rear cylinder coil no. “2”
4) Side stand switch
16) Front cylinder injector
5) Test connectors
17) Rear cylinder injector
6) Left-hand cooling fan connector
18) Throttle position sensor
7) Right-hand cooling fan connector
19) Relays
8) Diode
20) Fuel injection relay
9) Pick-up
21) Diode module
10) Coolant thermistor
22) Automatic air adjustment motor
11) Clutch switch

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 21 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8 - 22 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 23 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

8.3 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INSPECTION 8.3.4 PROBLEMS WITH THE AUXILIARY SYSTEMS
- See 6.11.2 (LIGHT RELAY TEST).
See 6.1 (LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS)
- See 6.8.4 (DIODE TEST).
for the location of the various components.
- See 6.9.2 (COOLING FAN TEST).
See 8.2.10 (WIRING).
- See 6.6.5 (COOLANT THERMISTOR TEST).
- See 6.5.4 (ELECTRONIC SYSTEM TROUBLE-
8.3.1 SPARK PLUGS (NO SPARK)
SHOOTING BASED ON DISPLAY INFORMATION).
Firstly: - See 6.10.3 (ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SENSOR).
- Check the 15-A auxiliary fuses. - See 6.10 (INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS).
- Check the spark plugs.
Secondly:
- Check 30-A main fuses.
- See 6.6.6 (IGNITION COIL TEST).
Thirdly:
See 6.6.7 (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR TEST).

8.3.2 PROBLEMS WITH BATTERY CHARGING


- See 6.3.1 (CHECKING CHARGE VOLTAGE).
- See 6.3.2 (ALTERNATOR LOADLESS OPERATION
TEST).
- See 6.3.4 (ALTERNATOR CONTINUITY TEST).
- See 6.3.5 (RECTIFIER TEST).
- See 6.14 (BATTERY).

8.3.3 PROBLEMS WITH IGNITION AND/OR


STARTING
Check the on-board diagnostics system, see 6.4.2
(TROUBLESHOOTING) (IF THE ENGINE DOES NOT
START).
In addition:
- See 6.6.6 (IGNITION COIL TEST).
- See 6.6.7 (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
TEST).
- See 6.4.4 (BANK ANGLE SENSOR TEST).
- See 6.6.4 (AIR THERMISTOR TEST).
- See 6.6.5 (COOLANT THERMISTOR TEST).
- See 6.6.3 (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST).
- See 6.6.1 (INJECTOR TEST).
- See 6.7.2 (FUEL PUMP TEST).
- See 6.7.3 (TEST OF FUEL PUMP RELAY AND
ENGINE CUTOUT RELAY).
- See 6.8.2 (SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM OPERATION).
- See 6.8.3 (STARTER RELAY TEST).
- See 6.8.5 (SIDE STAND SWITCH TEST).
- See 6.8.6 (DIODE MODULE TEST).
- See 6.8 (SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM).
- See 6.14 (BATTERY).

8 - 24 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
RST mille
REPAIR INFORMATION

8.4 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INSPECTION 8.4.8 WHEELS


Wheel rims:
8.4.1 ENGINE
See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS).
See Section 3 (ENGINE) for technical information on and
Wheel rim run-out limit:
specifications of engine components.
See 7.2.3 (WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION).
8.4.2 THROTTLE BODY COMPONENTS Wheel spindle run-out limit:
See 7.2.3 (WHEEL COMPONENT INSPECTION).
See 4.8 (THROTTLE BODY) for technical information on
and specifications of engine components. Tyres:
See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS).
8.4.3 FUEL SYSTEM
- Inlet/outlet hoses of pressure filter (ID = 7.5 mm; OD = 8.4.9 FRONT SUSPENSION
14.5 mm) are made from NBR-SF-NBR to DIN 73379 See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS); 2.29.1 (FRONT SUSPEN-
specification. SION); and 7.8 (FRONT FORK).
- High-pressure delivery hose is made from TEFLON,
with inlaid metal braiding and eyelet terminals. 8.4.10 REAR SUSPENSION
- Low-pressure return hose (ID = 6 mm; OD = 12 mm) is See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS); 2.29.1 (FRONT
made from NBR-SF-NEOPRENE to DIN 73379 specifi- SUSPENSION); 7.9 (REAR SWINGING ARM); and 7.10
cation. (REAR SUSPENSION).

8.4.4 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 8.4.11 STEERING


See 2.28.1 (CHECKING PLAY IN THE BEARINGS) and
See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS). See also Section 6 (ELEC-
7.7 (STEERING).
TRICAL SYSTEM).
8.4.12 CAPACITIES – FLUID SPECIFICATIONS
8.4.5 FRONT BRAKING SYSTEM
See 1.5 (SPECIFICATIONS) and 1.6 (LUBRICANT
- Brake discs = steel.
CHART).
- Disc thickness = 5 mm (service limit: 4.5 mm).
- Disc diameter = 300 mm.
8.4.13 CHASSIS (FRAME / SEAT SUBFRAME /
- Number of caliper pistons = 4 opposite pistons.
INSTRUMENT PANEL MOUNT)
- Diameter of caliper pistons = 30 mm (lower pistons) +
- Frame / Seat subframe / Instrument panel mount mate-
34 mm (upper pistons).
rial = light alloy
- Brake pads = sintered.
- Frame weight = 9.9 kg.
- Brake pad lining (standard) = TOSHIBA TT 2802.
- Frame torsional rigidity = 6,500 Nm/° (650 kgm/°).
- Brake pad lining (option) = FERIT/FERODO ID 450.
- Rake = 26°.
- Brake pad surface = 23.68 sq. cm.
- Trail = 97 mm.
- Rubber hose diameter (standard) = OD 10 mm;
- Seat subframe weight = 2.3 kg.
ID 3.2 mm.
Instrument panel mount weight = 0.750 kg.
- Diameter of metal-braided hoses (option) = OD 7 mm;
ID 3.2 mm.
- Master cylinder diameter = 16 mm.

8.4.6 REAR BRAKING SYSTEM


- Brake disc = steel.
- Disc thickness = 5 mm (service limit: 4.5 mm).
- Disc diameter = 255 mm.
- Number of caliper pistons = 2 opposite pistons.
- Diameter of caliper pistons = 28 mm.
- Brake pad lining (standard) = FERIT/FERODO ID 450.
- Brake pad lining (option) = TOSHIBA TTH38GF FERIT/
FERODO ID 450/452/459.
- Brake pad surface = 16 sq. cm.
- Rubber hose diameter (standard) = OD 10 mm;
ID 3.2 mm.
- Diameter of metal-braided hoses (option) = OD 7 mm;
ID 3.2 mm.
- Master cylinder diameter = 11 mm.

8.4.7 COOLING SYSTEM


See Section 5 (COOLING SYSTEM).
- Operating pressure 90-120 kPa (0.9-1.2 bar).

Release 00/2001 - 11 8 - 25 - 00
REPAIR INFORMATION RST mille

NOTES

8 - 26 - 00 Release 00/2001 - 11
ETV mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

GENERAL INFORMATION
i

Release 00/2002 - 01 i - 1 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION EVT mille

A See Page BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER


FRONT BRAKE, REMOVAL 7.5.4 7-73
ADJUSTMENT REAR BRAKE, REMOVAL 7.4.4 7-69
BEAM HORIZONTAL ADJUSTMENT 6.18 6-54
BRAKE PADS,
BEAM VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT 6.17 6-53
FRONT BRAKE, REPLACEMENT 7.4.1 7-68
BEARING PLAY 2.27.2 1-45
REAR BRAKE, REPLACEMENT 7.5.1 7-71
CO RATE 4.10.5 4-19
WEAR INSPECTION 2.26 1-44
DRIVE CHAIN 2.35.3 1-55
FREE TRAVEL OF REAR BRAKE LEVER 2.24 1-43 BRAKES
FRONT BRAKE LEVER AND CLUTCH BRAKE FLUID 1.2.4 1-4
LEVER 2.23 1-42 FRONT BRAKE 7.4 7-67
GEAR SHIFT LEVER 2.25 1-43 REAR BRAKE 7.5 7-70
IDLE SPEED 2.10.2 1-22
BREAKING THE CHAIN 7.10.2 7-97
INSTRUMENT PANEL LIGHT INTENSITY 2.3.3 1-8
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER 2.30.2 1-49 BULBS
THROTTLE CONTROL 2.10.3 1-23 FRONT DIRECTION INDICATORS,
WHEEL SPOKE TENSION 7.2.1 7-54 REPLACEMENT 6.15.2 6-49
7.3.1 7-60 HEADLIGHT, REPLACEMENT 6.15.1 6-47
WHEEL SPOKE TENSION 2.33 1-52 NUMBER PLATE LIGHT, REPLACEMENT 6.15.5 6-51
REAR DIRECTION INDICATORS,
AIR CLEANER 2.9 1-20
REPLACEMENT 6.15 6-50
AIR THERMISTOR, TEST 6.6.4 6-18 REPLACEMENT 6.15 6-47
TAIL LIGHT, REPLACEMENT 6.15.4 6-51
AIRBOX REMOVAL 7.1.6 7-11
BUTTONS, PROGRAMMING 2.3.2 1-8
ALTERNATOR,
CONTINUITY CHECK 6.3.4 6-7
LOADLESS OPERATION TEST 6.3.2 6-6 C See Page
AUTOMATIC AIR ADJUSTMENT MOTOR 6.6.2 6-16
CABLES
AUTOMATIC OPERATION TEST 4.7.5 4-13 JUMPER CABLES, JUMP-START 2.6 1-16
THROTTLE CABLE 8.2.7 8-15

B See Page CABLES AND HOSES 8.2 8-11


FASTENERS 8.2 8-11
BATTERY 2.4 1-13 ROUTING 8.2 8-11
6.14 6-44
CAPACITIES – FLUID SPECIFICATIONS 8.4.12 8-25
CHARGING THE BATTERY 2.4.2 1-15
FIRST-TIME INSTALLATION 6.14.1 6-44 CARBON OXIDE 1.2.7 1-6
INSPECTION 6.14.3 6-46
CHANGE
LONG INACTIVITY 2.4.3 1-15
CLUTCH FLUID 2.22 1-42
MAINTENANCE 6.14.2 6-46
COOLANT 2.14 1-28
REMOVAL 7.1.7 7-12
ENGINE OIL AND FILTER 2.12 1-25
RETURN UNDER WARRANTY 6.14.4 6-46
FRONT BRAKE FLUID 2.20 1-40
BEAM SETTING FRONT FORK OIL 7.7.1 7-78
HORIZONTAL ADJUSTMENT 6.18 6-54 REAR BRAKE FLUID 2.21 1-41
BEAM SETTING CHARGING
VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT 6.17 6-53 THE BATTERY 2.4.2 1-15
PROBLEMS WITH 8.3.2 8-23
BEARINGS,
ADJUSTING PLAY 2.27.2 1-45 CHARGING VOLTAGE, CHECK 6.3. 1 6-6
CHECKING FOR PLAY 2.27.1 1-45
CHECKING
BLEEDING, AND CLEANING BATTERY TERMINALS
BRAKING SYSTEMS 2.18 1-35 AND LEAD CONNECTIONS 2.4.1 1-14
CLUTCH CONTROL 2.19 1-39 AND TOPPING UP CLUTCH FLUID 2.17 1-33
AND TOPPING UP COOLANT 2.13 1-27
BODYWORK 7.1 7-4
AND TOPPING UP FRONT BRAKE FLUID 2.15 1-29
BRACKET, AND TOPPING UP REAR BRAKE FLUID 2.16 1-31
PASSENGER FOOTPEG, REMOVAL 7.1.37 7-41 BRAKE PADS FOR WEAR 2.26 1-44
RIDER LEFT-HAND FOOTPEG, REMOVAL 7.1.38 7-42 CHARGE VOLTAGE 6.3.1 6-6
RIDER RIGHT-HAND FOOTPEG, REMOVAL 7.1.39 7-42 PLAY IN THE BEARINGS 2.27.1 1-45
THROTTLE OPERATION 2.10.1 1-22
BRAKE & CLUTCH LINES 2.38 1-59
CHECKING AND TOPPING UP ENGINE
BRAKE DISCS
OIL LEVEL 2.12 2-24
FRONT BRAKE DISCS,
CHECK 7.4.2 7-69 CLEANING AND LUBRICATION 2.41.1 1-66
REMOVAL 7.4.3 7-69
CLOCK SETTING (HOURS AND MINUTES) 2.3.6 1-10
REAR BRAKE DISC,
CHECK 7.5.2 7-72 CLUTCH FLUID 1.2.6 1-5
REMOVAL 7.5.3 7-72
CLUTCH CONTROL SYSTEM BLEEDING 2.19 1-39

i - 2 - 00 Release 00/2002 - 01
ETV mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

CLUTCH HOSE 8.2.4 8-13 DISMANTLING


SUSPENSION LINKAGES 7.9.3 7-94
CLUTCH SLAVE CYLINDER,
DRIVE CHAIN 7.10 7-96
REMOVAL 3.2.1 3-6
REAR SWINGING ARM 7.8.2 7-88
CO, SETTING 4.10.5 4-19 THROTTLE BODY 4.9 4-16
WHEEL 7.2.3 7-56
COCKPIT BOTTOM PANEL, REMOVAL 7.1.20 7-24
7.3.5 7-64
COCKPIT SIDE PROTECTION MOULDING 7.1.19 7-23 STANCHIONS AND SLIDERS 7.7.3 7-79
REMOVAL 7.1.19 7-23 STEERING 7.6.1 7-75
CODES, FAULT 6.5.3 6-12 DRAINING THE FUEL TANK 4.2 4-5
2.8 1-19
COLOUR-CODING, WIRES 6.2.1 6-5
DRIVE CHAIN 2.35 1-53
COMPONENT INSPECTION CHECKING FOR WEAR 2.35.2 1-55
7.2.4 7-57 DISMANTLING 7.10 7-96
7.3.6 7-65 SLACK ADJUSTMENT 2.35.3 1-55
7.6.2 7-76 BREAKAGE 7. 10.2 7-97
7.7.4 7-82
DRIVE CHAIN GUIDE PLATE, INSPECTION 2.35.5 1-57
7.8.3 7-89
7.9.4 7-95
COMPONENTS E See Page
ELECTRICAL 2.5 1-15 ENGINE CONTROL UNIT,
ELECTRICAL, LAYOUT 6.1 6-3
CONNECTIONS 6.6 6-14
ENGINE COMPONENTS THAT CAN
CONNECTORS 4.7.4 4-12
BE REMOVED WITH THE ENGINE REMOVAL 7.1.8 7-13
INSTALLED IN THE FRAME 3.2 3-4
HOT COMPONENTS 1.2.8 1-6 ENGINE 8.4.1 8-24
THROTTLE BODY 8.4.2 8-24 ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER 1.1.2 1-3
INSTALLING THE ENGINE IN THE FRAME 3.4 3-15
CONSUMABLES 1.7 1-11
OIL 1.2.2 1-4
CONNECTING LINK POSITIONING 7.10.3 7-98 TAKING THE ENGINE OUT OF THE FRAME 3.3 3-7

CONNECTIONS TO ENGINE CONTROL UNIT 6.6 6-14 ENGINE MANAGEMENT 4.7 4-8

CONNECTORS ENGINE OIL COOLER, REMOVAL 7.1.47 7-49


ENGINE CONTROL UNIT 4.7.4 4-12
EXHAUST MANIFOLD NUTS 2.34 1-53
ELECTRICAL 6.2.2 6-5
EXHAUST SILENCER, REMOVAL 7.1.43 7-45
CONSUMABLES 1.7 1-11
EXPANSION RESERVOIR, REMOVAL 5.6 5-9
CONTROL
THROTTLE CONTROL, REMOVAL 7.1.12 7-17
THROTTLE CONTROL, TESTING F See Page
OPERATION OF 2.10.1 1-22
CLUTCH CONTROL, FLUID 1.2.6 1-5 FASTENERS 2.41 1-61
CLUTCH CONTROL, REMOVAL 7.1.10 7-15 FAULT, IN THE EVENT OF 6.5.2 6-12
COOLANT 1.2.5 1-5 FAULT CODES 6.5.3 6-12
COOLANT THERMISTORS, FILTER
TEST 6.6.5 6-19 AIR (CLEANER) 2.10 2-21
REMOVAL 5.4 5-7 ENGINE OIL FILTER, REPLACEMENT 2.12 1-25
COOLING FANS 6.9 6-31 FUEL DELIVERY FILTER, REMOVAL 4.5 4-6
REMOVAL 5.3 5-6 FINAL DRIVE REMOVAL 7.3.4 7-63
TEST OPERATION 6.9.2 6-31
WIRING DIAGRAM 6.9.1 6-31 FIRST-TIME INSTALLATION, BATTERY 6.14.1 6-44

COOLING SYSTEM DESCRIPTION 5.1 5-3 FLUID


BRAKE FLUID 1.2.4 1-4
CYLINDERS, SYNCHRONISATION 4.10.4 4-18 FRONT BRAKE, CHECKING AND
TOPPING UP LEVEL 2.15 1-29
D See Page FRONT BRAKE, CHANGE 2.20 1-40
REAR BRAKE, CHECKING AND
DECALS, HOW TO APPLY 1.10 1-19 TOPPING UP LEVEL 2.16 1-31
REAR BRAKE, CHANGE 2.21 1-41
DIAGRAMS
CLUTCH FLUID 1.2.6 1-5
CHARGE SYSTEM 6.3.3 6-7 CLUTCH, CHECKING AND TOPPING UP
FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM 4.7.3 4-11
LEVEL 2.17 1-33
DIODE, TEST 6.8.4 6-27 CLUTCH, CHANGE 2.22 1-42
COOLANT 1.2.5 1-5
DIODE MODULE, TEST 6.8.6 6-29
COOLANT, WARNINGS 1.2 1-3
DIRECTION INDICATORS 7.1.24 7-28 COOLANT, CHECKING AND TOPPING
CHART 2.3.7 1-10 UP LEVEL 2.13 1-27
REAR DIRECTION INDICATOR, REMOVAL 7.1.34 7-37 COOLANT, CHANGE 2.14 1-28

Release 00/2002 - 01 i - 3 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION EVT mille

FOOTPEGS IGNITION AND/OR STARTING,


PASSENGER, REMOVAL 7.1.37 7-41 PROBLEMS 8.3.3 8-25
RIDER, REMOVAL 7.1.40 7-43
IGNITION COILS, TEST 6.6.6 6-20
FOREWORD 6.2 6-5
IGNITION SWITCH/STEERING LOCK,
FRAME REMOVAL 7.1.51 7-52 REMOVAL 7.1.15 7-20
FRAME SERIAL NO. 1.1.1 1-3 INJECTION, DIAGRAM 4.7.3 4-11
FRONT AND REAR CHAIN SPROCKETS, INJECTION SUPPLY DIAGRAM 6.4.1 6-9
WEAR INSPECTION 2.35.2 1-55
INJECTORS,
FRONT FAIRING, TEST 6.6.1 6-16
REMOVAL 7.1.18 7-22 REMOVAL 4.8.2 4-15
LOWER LOCKUP 7.1.29 7-33 OPERATING TEST 4.10.1 4-17
LOWER LOCKUP, REMOVAL 7.1.29 7-33
INSPECTION 6.14.3 6-46
FRONT FORK 7.7 7-77
CHAIN AND FRONT/REAR SPROCKETS,
OIL 1.2.3 1-4
WEAR 2.35.2 1-55
FRONT MUDGUARD, REMOVAL 7.1.23 7-27 CHAIN SLACK 2.35.1 1-54
CHARGE SYSTEM 6.3 6-6
FUEL 1.2.1 1-3
COMPONENT INSPECTION
DRAINING 2.8 1-19
7.2.4 7-57
HOSES 2.37 1-59
7.3.6 7-65
WARNINGS 1.2 1-3
7.6.2 7-76
FUEL FILLER CAP, REMOVAL 7.1.5 7-10 7.7.4 7-82
7.8.3 7-89
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR REMOVAL 4.4 4-6
7.9.4 7-95
FUEL SYSTEM, DRIVE CHAIN GUIDE PLATE 2.35.5 1-57
INSPECTION 4.1.2 4-4 DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER 2.35.6 1-57
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 8.3 8-23
FUEL INJECTION SUPPLY,
8.4 8-24
WIRING DIAGRAM 6.4.1 6-9
FRONT BRAKE DISCS 7.4.2 7-69
FUSES, REPLACEMENT 6.16 6-52 FRONT SUSPENSION 2.28 1-47
FUEL LINES 4.1.2 4-4
REAR BRAKE DISC 7.5.2 7-72
G See Page REAR SUSPENSION 2.30 1-49
REAR SUSPENSION LINKAGE SYSTEM 2.30.3 1-50
GENERAL INFORMATION 4.7.1 4-8
THROTTLE BODY 4.10 4-17
GENERAL INFORMATION ON TORQUE
INSTALLATION
FIGURES 1.11 1-21
ENGINE IN THE FRAME 3.4 3-15
GENERAL MAINTENANCE AND REAR SWINGING ARM 7.8.4 7-90
REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS 3.1.9 3-3 STANCHIONS - SLIDERS 7.7.6 7-85
GRAB RAIL, REMOVAL 7.1.31 7-34 WHEEL 7.2.5 7-58
INSTRUMENT PANEL,
LIGHT INTENSITY 2.3.3 1-8
H See Page REMOVAL 7.1.21 7-25
HANDLEBAR, REMOVAL 7.1.16 7-21 INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS 6.10 6-32
HEADLIGHT, REMOVAL 7.1.22 7-26 INSTRUMENTS, CHART 2.3.7 1-10
HORN, REMOVAL 7.1.27 7-31
HOSES AND PIPES K See Page
FUEL 2.37 1-59
KEY 2.3.1 1-8
BRAKE AND CLUTCH LINES 2.38 1-59
COOLANT 2.39 1-59
BREATHER AND DRAIN HOSES 8.2.9 8-17 L See Page
FRONT BRAKE HOSES 8.2.1 8-11
REAR BRAKE HOSES 8.2.2 8-11 LAYOUT OF ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 6.1 6-3
FUEL SYSTEM HOSES 8.2.3 8-12
LEFT HANDLEBAR TWISTGRIP, REMOVAL 7.1.11 7-16
COOLING SYSTEM 8.2.6 8-14
ENGINE OIL 8.2.8 8-16 LEVER
PPC DEVICE, PRESSURE TUBES 8.2.5 8-13 CLUTCH LEVER, ADJUSTMENT 2.23 1-42
EXHAUST PIPES, REMOVAL 7.1.44 7-46 FRONT BRAKE LEVER, ADJUSTMENT 2.23 1-42
GEAR SHIFT LEVER, ADJUSTMENT 2.25 1-43
HOT, COMPONENTS 1.2.8 1-6
GEAR SHIFT LEVER, REMOVAL 7.1.41 7-43
HOW TO APPLY THE DECALS 1.10 1-19 REAR BRAKE LEVER, FREE TRAVEL
ADJUSTMENT 2.24 1-43
REAR BRAKE LEVER, REMOVAL 7.1.42 7-44
I See Page
LIGHT, SETTING INSTRUMENT PANEL
IDLE SPEED, ADJUSTMENT 2.10.2 1-22 LIGHT INTENSITY 2.3.3 1-8
LOCATION OF SERIAL NUMBERS 1.1 1-3

0i - 4 - 00 Release 00/2002 - 01
ETV mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

LONG INACTIVITY OF THE BATTERY 2.4.3 1-15 R See Page


LUBRICANTS 3.1.5 3-3
RADIATOR SPOILER, REMOVAL 7.1.26 7-30
WARNINGS 1.2 1-3
CHART 1.6 1-10 RADIATOR, REMOVAL 5.2 5-5
LUBRICATION POINTS 2.2 1-7 REAR SHOCK ABSORBER 2.30.2 1-49
REMOVAL 7.9.1 7-91

M See Page REAR SUSPENSION LINKAGE SYSTEM 7.9.2 7-93

MAINTENANCE 4.1.1 4-4 REAR SWINGING ARM 2.29 1-48


7.8 7-86
6.14.2 6-46
ADJUSTMENT 2.29.1 1-48
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE 2.1 1-4
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE SHEET 2.1.1 1-5 DISMANTLING 7.8.2 7-88
INSTALLATION 7.8.4 7-90
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART 2.1 1-4
REMOVAL 7.8.1 7-86
MAINTENANCE AND REPAIR WORK,
REAR SWINGING ARM ADJUSTMENT 2.29.1 1-48
GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS 3.1.9 3-3
PRECONDITIONS FOR 3.1.8 3-3 RE-ASSEMBLY
MAINTENANCE INTERVALS 3.1.2 3-3 STANCHION AND SLIDER 7.7.5 7-83
STEERING 7.6.3 7-76
MIRRORS, REMOVAL 7.1.17 7-21
RECOMMENDATIONS, RUNNING-IN 1.3 1-6
MULTIFUNCTION COMPUTER 2.3 1-8
RECTIFIER, TEST 6.3.5 6-8
RELAY
N See Page INJECTION RELAY, TEST 6.4.3 6-10
NUMBER PLATE BRACKET, REMOVAL 7.1.36 7-40 LIGHT RELAY, TEST 6.11.2 6-39
FUEL PUMP RELAY, TEST 6.7.3 6-23
STARTER RELAY, TEST 6.8.3 6-26
O See Page
RELEASING/LOCKING THE PASSENGER SEAT 7.1.1 7-6
OIL REMOVAL
ENGINE 1.2.2 1-4 AIRBOX 7.1.6 7-11
ENGINE, CHANGE 2.12 1-25 BATTERY 7.1.7 7-12
ENGINE, LEVEL AND TOPPING-UP 2.11 1-24 CHAIN UPPER GUARD 7.1.48 7-49
FRONT FORK 1.2.3 1-4 CLUTCH CONTROL 7.1.10 7-15
FRONT FORK, CHANGE 7.7.1 7-78 CLUTCH SLAVE CYLINDER 3.2.1 3-6
OTHER COMPONENTS, WARNINGS 1.2 1-3 COCKPIT TOP PROTECTION MOULDING 7.1.20 7-24
COOLANT THERMISTORS 5.4 5-7
OXIDE, CARBON 1.2.7 1-6 COOLING FAN 5.3 5-6
DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER 7.1.49 7-50
P See Page ENGINE, OUT OF THE FRAME 3.3 3-7
ENGINE CONTROL UNIT 7.1.8 7-13
PARTS, SPARE 1.4 1-7 ENGINE OIL COOLER 7.1.47 7-49
ENGINE OIL TANK 7.1.46 7-48
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART 2.1 1-4
EXHAUST PIPES 7.1.44 7-46
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE SHEET 2.1.1 1-5 EXHAUST SILENCER 7.1.43 7-45
EXPANSION RESERVOIR 5.6 5-9
PLACING
FRAME 7.1.51 7-52
MOTORCYCLE ON CENTRE STAND 1.9.2 1-18 FINAL DRIVE ASSEMBLY 7.3.4 7-63
MOTORCYCLE ON FRONT WHEEL STAND 1.9.1 1-17
FRONT FAIRING 7.1.18 7-22
MOTORCYCLE ON SERVICE STANDS 1.9 1-17
FRONT BOTTOM PANEL 7.1.29 7-33
POSITIONING THE CONNECTING LINK 7.10.3 7-98 FRONT BRAKE CONTROL 7.1.13 7-18
FRONT BRAKE DISCS 7.5.3 7-72
PRECONDITIONS FOR MAINTENANCE
FRONT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER 7.5.4 7-73
AND REPAIR WORK 3.1.8 3-3 FRONT DIRECTION INDICATORS 7.1.24 7-28
PROBLEMS FRONT MUDGUARD 7.1.49 7-50
WITH AUXILIARY SYSTEMS 8.3.4 8-23 FRONT WHEEL 7.2.2 7-55
WITH BATTERY CHARGING 8.3.2 8-23 FUEL DELIVERY FILTER 4.5 4-6
WITH IGNITION AND/OR STARTING 8.3.3 8-23 FUEL FILLER CAP 7.1.5 7-10
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR 4.4 4-6
PRODUCT, FUEL PUMP 4.6 4-7
APPLICATIONS 1.7.2 1-12
FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY 4.3 4-5
FEATURES 1.7.1 1-11
FUEL TANK 7.1.4 7-8
PROGRAMMING BUTTONS 2.3.2 1-8 GEAR SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY 7.1.41 7-43
GRAB RAIL 7.1.31 7-34
PUMP
HANDLEBAR 7.1.16 7-21
FUEL PUMP, REMOVAL 4.6 4-7 HEADLIGHT 7.1.22 7-26
FUEL PUMP ASSEMBLY, REMOVAL 4.3 4-5
IGNITION SWITCH / STEERING LOCK 7.1.15 7-20
FUEL PUMP, TEST 6.7.2 6-23
INJECTORS 4.8.2 4-15
INSTRUMENT PANEL 7.1.21 7-25

Release 00/2002 - 01 i - 5 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION EVT mille

INSTRUMENT PANEL/FRONT SEAT LATCH,


FAIRING SUBFRAME 7.1.28 7-32 REMOVAL 7.1.32 7-35
MIRRORS 7.1.17 7-21 PASSENGER SEAT LATCH, REMOVAL 7.1.32 7-35
NUMBER PLATE BRACKET 7.1.36 7-40
SEAT LOWER MOULDED COVER, REMOVAL 7.1.33 7-36
PASSENGER FOOTPEG 7.1.37 7-41
PASSENGER FOOTPEG BRACKETS 7.1.37 7-41 SEAT,
PASSENGER SEAT LATCH 7.1.32 7-35 RIDER SEAT REMOVAL 7.1.2 7-6
RADIATOR SPOILER 7.1.26 7-30 PASSENGER SEAT, RELEASING/LOCKING 7.1.1 7-6
RADIATOR 5.2 5-5
SENSOR
REAR BRAKE DISC 7.4.3 7-69
AIR TEMPERATURE 6.10.2 6-33
REAR BRAKE LEVER 7.1.42 7-44
COOLANT TEMPERATURE 6.10.6 6-37
REAR BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER 7.4.4 7-69
CRANKSHAFT POSITION, TEST 6.6.7 6-21
REAR DIRECTION INDICATORS 7.1.34 7-37
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE 6.10.3 6-34
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER 7.9.1 7-91
BANK ANGLE SENSOR, TEST 6.4.4 6-10
REAR SUBFRAME 7.1.50 7-51
FUEL LEVEL 6.10.5 6-36
REAR SUSPENSION LINKAGE SYSTEM 7.9.2 7-93
SPEED 6.10.4 6-35
REAR SWINGING ARM 7.8.1 7-86
REAR WHEEL 7.3.3 7-62 SENSORS 4.7.2 4-9
RIDER FOOTPEG 7.1.40 7-43
SERIAL NUMBER,
RIDER FOOTPEG BRACKET,
LOCATION OF 1.1 1-3
RIGHT-HAND 7.1.39 7-42
ENGINE 1.1.2 1-3
LEFT-HAND 7.1.38 7-42
FRAME 1.1.1 1-3
RIDER SEAT 7.1.2 7-6
SEAT END COVER 7.1.35 7-38 SETTING, CLOCK (HOURS AND MINUTES) 2.3.6 1-10
SEAT LATCH 7.1.32 7-35
SIDE FAIRING, REMOVAL 7.1.25 7-29
SEAT LOWER MOULDED COVER 7.1.33 7-36
SIDE FAIRINGS 7.1.25 7-29 SIDE PANELS, REMOVAL 7.1.3 7-7
SIDE PANELS 7.1.3 7-7
SIDE STAND SWITCH, TEST 6.8.5 6-28
SIDE STAND 7.1.45 7-47
STANCHIONS AND SLIDERS 7.7.2 7-78 SLIDER
SWITCHGEAR ON LEFT-HAND HANDLEBAR7.1.11 7-16 DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER, INSPECTION 2.35.6 1-57
SWITCHGEAR ON RIGHT-HAND DRIVE CHAIN SLIDER, REMOVAL 7.1.49 7-50
HANDLEBAR 7.1.14 7-19
SPARE PARTS 1.4 1-7
TAIL LIGHT 7.1.30 7-34
THERMAL EXPANSION VALVE 5.5 5-8 SPARK PLUGS 2.7 1-17
THROTTLE BODY 4.8.1 4-14
NO SPARK 8.3.1 8-23
THROTTLE CONTROL 7.1.12 7-17
TWISTGRIP ON LEFT HANDLEBAR 7.1.9 7-14 SPECIAL TOOLS 1.8 1-15
WARNING HORN 7.1.27 7-31 3.1.6 3-3
WINDSCREEN 7.1.18 7-22
SPECIFICATIONS AND TECHNICAL
REPLACEMENT INFORMATION 3.1 3-3
BULBS 6.15 6-47
STANCHIONS AND SLIDERS,
FRONT BRAKE PADS 7.5.1 7-71
DISMANTLING 7.7.3 7-79
FRONT DIRECTION INDICATOR BULBS 6.15.2 6-49
INSTALLATION 7.7.6 7-85
FUSES 6.16 6-52
RE-ASSEMBLY 7.7.5 7-83
HEADLIGHT BULBS 6.15.1 6-47
REMOVAL 7.7.2 7-78
NUMBER PLATE LIGHT BULBS 6.15.5 6-51
REAR BRAKE PADS 7.4.1 7-68 STAND
REAR DIRECTION INDICATORS 6.15.3 6-50 FRONT WHEEL STAND,
TAIL LIGHT BULBS 6.15.4 6-51 PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON 1.9.1 1-17
SERVICE STANDS,
RETURN UNDER WARRANTY 6.14.4 6-46
PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON 1.9 1-17
RIGHT HANDLEBAR SWITCHGEAR, REMOVAL 7.1.14 7-19 CENTRE STAND,
PLACING THE MOTORCYCLE ON 1.9.2 1-18
RIVETING THE LINK 7.10.4 7-99
SIDE STAND, REMOVAL 7.1.45 7-47
ETV MILLE, WIRING DIAGRAM 6.19 6-55
STARTING
ROUTING AND CONNECTIONS OF JUMP START 2.6 1-16
WIRING, CABLES AND HOSES 8.2 8-11 SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM 6.8 6-24
RUNNING-IN RECOMMENDATIONS 1.3 1-6 STEERING 2.27 1-45
8.4.11 8-25
7.6 7-74
S See Page DISMANTLING 7.6.1 7-75
RE-ASSEMBLY 7.6.3 7-76
SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM OPERATION 6.8.2 6-25
STRUCTURE (FRAME / SEAT SUBFRAME /
SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM SWITCHES, TEST 6.8.7 6-30
INSTRUMENT PANEL SUBFRAME) 8.4.13 8-25
SEALANTS 3.1.4 3-3
SUBFRAME,
SEAT END COVER, REMOVAL 7.1.35 7-38 INSTRUMENT PANEL/FRONT FAIRING,
REMOVAL 7.1.28 7-32

0i - 6 - 00 Release 00/2002 - 01
ETV mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

REAR, REMOVAL 7.1.50 7-51 FLASHER 6.12.3 6-41


FUEL PUMP 6.7.2 6-23
SUNDRY TOOLS 1.8.1 1-15
FUEL PUMP RELAY 6.7.3 6-23
SUSPENSION IGNITION COILS 6.6.6 6-20
FRONT 2.28.1 1-47 INJECTION RELAY 6.4.3 6-10
8.4.9 8-25 INJECTORS 6.6.1 6-16
FRONT, INSPECTION 2.28 1-47 INJECTORS OPERATING TEST 4.10.1 4-17
LINKAGES DISMANTLING 7.9.3 7-94 LIGHT RELAY 6.11.2 6-39
REAR 8.4.10 8-25 RECTIFIER 6.3.5 6-8
2.30.1 1-49 SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM SWITCHES 6.8.7 6-30
7.9 7-92 SIDE STAND SWITCH 6.8.5 6-28
REAR, INSPECTION 2.30 1-49 STARTER RELAY 6.8.3 6-26
REAR, LINKAGE SYSTEM INSPECTION 2.30.3 1-50 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 6.6.3 6-17
WARNING HORN 6.12.2 6-41
SWITCHES 6.13.2 6-43
THROTTLE BODY 4.10.2 4-17
SWITCHGEAR,
ON LEFT-HAND THROTTLE BODY 4.8 4-14
HANDLEBAR, REMOVAL 7.1.9 7-14 COMPONENTS 8.4.2 8-24
DISASSEMBLY 4.9 4-16
SYNCHRONISATION, CYLINDERS 4.10.4 4-18
INSPECTION 4.10 4-17
SYSTEM REMOVAL 4.8.1 4-14
BRAKING SYSTEM, FRONT 8.4.5 8-24
THROTTLE CONTROL 2.10 1-22
BRAKING SYSTEM, REAR 8.4.6 8-24
CHARGE, INSPECTION 6.3 6-6 ADJUSTMENT 2.10.3 1-23
CHARGE SYSTEM, DIAGRAM 6.3.3 6-7
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR,
COOLING SYSTEM 8.4.7 8-25
COOLING SYSTEM HOSES 2.39 1-59 SETTING 4.10.6 4-21
CLUTCH CONTROL SYSTEM, BLEEDING 2.20 2-38
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR 4.10.3 4-17
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 8.4.4 8-24
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM TEST 8.3 8-23 TEST 6.6.3 6-17
8.4 8-24
THROTTLE VALVE, SENSOR SETTING 4.10.6 4-21
ELECTRONIC SYSTEM,
TROUBLESHOOTING 6.5.4 6-13 TIGHTENING TORQUE, MAINTAINING
FUEL INJECTION 6.4 6-9 FASTENERS AT THE CORRECT 2.40 1-60
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM 6.7 6-22
TOGGLING BETWEEN
FUEL SYSTEM 8.4.3 8-24
KM/MI, L /GAL, °C/°F 2.3.5 1-9
IGNITION / INJECTION 6.5 6-11
ODOMETER (KM/MI) TRIP METER 2.3.4 1-9
LIGHT SYSTEM 6.11 6-38
SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM 6.8 6-24 TOOLS
VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING RIVET EXTRACTOR AND CHAIN TOOL 7.10.1 7-96
SYSTEM 6.13 6-42 ENGINE TOOLS 1.8.2 1-16
VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING
TORQUE FIGURES 3.1.7 3-3
SYSTEM 6.12 6-40
TORQUE FIGURES, GENERAL 1.11 1-21
SYSTEMS
AUXILIARY SYSTEMS, PROBLEMS 8.3.4 8-23 TROUBLESHOOTING 3.1.3 3-3
BRAKING SYSTEMS, BLEEDING 2.18 1-35 6.4.2 6-9
6.5.1 6-12
8.1 8-3
T See Page BATTERY 8.1.3 8-8
BRAKES 8.1.4 8-9
TAIL LIGHT, REMOVAL 7.1.30 7-34
CHASSIS 8.1.5 8-9
TANK ELECTRICAL SYSTEM 8.1.2 8-8
ENGINE OIL TANK, REMOVAL 7.1.46 7-48 ENGINE 8.1.1 8-3
FUEL TANK 4.1 4-3
FUEL TANK, REMOVAL 7.1.4 7-8 TROUBLESHOOTING THE ELECTRONIC
SYSTEM BASED ON DISPLAY INFORMATION 4.7.6 4-13
FUEL TANK, DRAINING 4.2 4-5
TECHNICAL DATA 3.1.1 3-3 TYRES 2.36 1-58

TERMINALS AND LEAD CONNECTIONS,


INSPECTION AND CLEANING 2.4.1 1-14 V See Page
TEST VALVE 5.5 5-8
AIR THERMISTOR 6.6.4 6-18
ALTERNATOR CONTINUITY 6.3.4 6-7
ALTERNATOR LOADLESS OPERATION 6.3.2 6-6 W See Page
BANK ANGLE SENSOR 6.4.4 6-10 WARNINGS CONCERNING FUEL,
COOLANT THERMISTOR 6.6.5 6-19
LUBRICANTS, COOLANT AND OTHER
COOLING FANS 6.9.2 6-31
COMPONENTS 1.2 1-3
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR 6.6.7 6-21
DIODE 6.8.4 6-27
DIODE MODULE 6.8.6 6-29

Release 00/2002 - 01 i - 7 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION EVT mille

WHEEL
FRONT WHEEL 2.31 1-51
FRONT WHEEL 7.2 7-54
WHEEL REMOVAL 7.2.2 7-55
REAR WHEEL 2.32 1-51
REAR WHEEL 7.3 7-60
WHEEL HUB DISASSEMBLY 7.2.3 7-56
7.3.5 7-64
WHEEL, REFITTING 7.2.5 7-58
7.3.7 7-66
WHEELS 8.4.8 8-25
WHEEL SPOKE TENSION, ADJUSTMENT 7.2.1 7-54
2.33 1-52
WINDSHIELD, REMOVAL 7.1.18 7-22
WIRING 8.2 8-11
WIRING DIAGRAM - ETV MILLE 6.19 6-55
LIGHTS 6.11.1 6-38
FUEL PUMP SYSTEM 6.7.1 6-22
VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING
SYSTEM 6.13.1 6-42
VISUAL AND ACOUSTIC SIGNALLING
SYSTEM 6.12.1 6-40
INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS 6.10.1 6-32
SAFETY LOCKOUT SYSTEM 6.8.1 6-24

0i - 8 - 00 Release 00/2002 - 01
ETV mille
GENERAL INFORMATION

NOTES

Release 00/2002 - 01 i - 9 - 00
GENERAL INFORMATION EVT mille

NOTES

i - 10 - 00 Release 00/2002 - 01

You might also like